Wetlands
Wetlands
Wetlands
Richard C. Smardon
13
Richard C. Smardon
College of Environmental Science
and Forestry
State University of New York
Syracuse, NY 13210
USA
[email protected]
ISBN 978-0-387-49428-9
e-ISBN 978-0-387-49429-6
DOI 10.1007/978-0-387-49429-6
Springer Dordrecht Heidelberg London New York
Library of Congress Control Number: 2009926981
# Springer ScienceBusiness Media, LLC 2009
All rights reserved. This work may not be translated or copied in whole or in part without the written
permission of the publisher (Springer ScienceBusiness Media, LLC, 233 Spring Street, New York,
NY 10013, USA), except for brief excerpts in connection with reviews or scholarly analysis. Use in
connection with any form of information storage and retrieval, electronic adaptation, computer
software, or by similar or dissimilar methodology now known or hereafter developed is forbidden.
The use in this publication of trade names, trademarks, service marks, and similar terms, even if they
are not identified as such, is not to be taken as an expression of opinion as to whether or not they are
subject to proprietary rights.
Printed on acid-free paper
Springer is part of Springer ScienceBusiness Media (www.springer.com)
Foreword
Wetlands throughout the world, including those described in this book are
among the most sensitive and vulnerable ecosystems. They are critical habitats
to the worlds migratory birds and a broad range of endangered mammal,
reptile, amphibian, and plant species. They provide a broad range of flood
storage, pollution control, water supply, ecotourism functions to indigenous
peoples and country populations as a whole.
They are also at the center of severe land and water use conflicts. These are
conflicts between counties where wetland resources or the water supplies
required for such resources involve more than one country. These are conflicts
in use such as conflicts between habitat protection and charcoal production in
mangroves. These are conflicts between groups of peoples such as indigenous
peoples and hydropower advocates. Many wetlands have already been
destroyed by water extractions, dams, levees, channelization, and fills. Others
have been degraded by water pollution, overfishing and overhunting, timber
harvest, and a host of other activities.
This book describes these conflicts and international policies and institutions
developed to protect and manage wetland resources. Most of the broader
literature and other books on wetlands focuses on wildlife. Wildlife is described
in the case studies, which follow. But, Richard Smardon provides us with more.
He traces the history of conflicts and the development of policies and institutions to protect and manage wetland resources.
Richard has patiently prepared the book. It has been several decades in the
making. During this time, Richard and his colleagues and students have not
only investigated but also participated in efforts to protect and manage wetland
resources domestically and internationally such as his work in the Yucatan
Peninsula. Richard has throughout his career been interested in the role of local
people in resource management.
The case studies which follow will be of interest to anyone wishing to protect
wetland ecosystems. They will be of interest to teachers wishing students to
understand the complexities of natural resource policy making. They will be of
interest to NGOs and governments wishing to reduce conflicts and better
manage and restore wetlands.
vi
Foreword
The case studies are illustrated with many fine figures and photographs and
abundant references for anyone seeking more information.
My colleagues and I have had the pleasure of working with Richard and his
students for many years. This includes lively discussions on the case study
wetlands described in this book. During this time, Richard has given freely
his time to aid wetland protection and restoration efforts at all levels of
government and by NGOs. This work is much appreciated.
We hope you enjoy the book and find it useful. I thank Richard for preparing
the book and sharing his insights with us.
Berne, New York
Association of State Wetland Managers
Preface
Richard C. Smardon
vii
Acknowledgments
The author wishes to thank the many wetland experts around the world who
encouraged him to keep working on this book and reinforced the basic themes.
Specific acknowledgements for all those who made individual contributions to
the development of specific case study chapters are given below.
For review comments on the Wadden Sea wetlands chapter, I sincerely thank
Professor Dr. H.L.F. Saeijs, chief engineer, director of Delta Area and professor
of Water Quality Policy and Sustainability, Erasmus University in Rotterdam,
the Netherlands.
For the Axios River Delta comments the author wishes to thank Costas
Cassios of the Athens National Technical University and Topiotechniki whose
project allowed him to actually see the Axios Delta area. Special thanks to
Chrysoula Athanasiou of the WWF-Red Alert Project who provided detailed
comments on an earlier draft plus valuable updates. Additional material was
provided by Professor P.A. Gerakis of the Gaulandris Museum of Natural
History, Greek Biotype/Wetland Centre, Thermi, Greece and Professor J. Szijj,
University of Geasamthochschule-Essen, Germany.
For the Kafue Flats, Zambia River chapter, many thanks for the commentary provided by Bernard Kamweneshe of the Zambia Department of National
Parks and Wildlife, Dr. Charles Namafe, School of Education, University of
Zambia, and Ms, Monica Chundama, WWF Program Officer on an earlier
working draft of this chapter.
For east Kolkata wetland, coauthors plus the primary book author wishes to
acknowledge the efforts of Dr. N.C. Landi, deputy director of the Zoological
Survey of India, New Alipore, Calcutta, for his careful editing and rewrites of
this chapter.
Many thanks to George Archibald who agreed to let ICF cooperate with the
author on the Tram Chim Nature Reserve, Vietnam, study and to Jeb Brazen,
ICF, for letting the author interview him in depth and to Rich Beilfuss, ICF, for
his detailed comments on the first chapter draft. Thanh Vo, a doctoral student
at SUNY/ESF, provided recent updates plus photos of Tram Chim.
The author is deeply grateful for the interview time with Stephen Brown,
Cam Davis, Gail Gruenwald, and Nancy Patterson of Environment Canada for
the chapter on Great Lakes wetlands.
ix
Acknowledgments
The author is indebted to early review comments from Joann Andrews (past
president of PRONATURA) and Dr. John Frazier (formerly of CINVESTAV
and now with Smithsonian Institution) plus key feedback from Drs. Betty
Faust, Julia Fraga, and Jorge Euan of CINVESTAV, Merida, Mexico, for
Ria Celestun and Ria Lagartos wetlands chapter. Special contributions were
provided by Scott Moan (former landscape architecture masters student) for his
work on Ria Lagartos and to Gabriela Canamar (another landscape architecture student) who did translation work plus an ecotourism survey of Celestun.
For Mankote mangrove chapter the author acknowledges the collaboration
of Matius Burt, Yves Renard, Allan Smith, and the local mangrove producers
whom he interviewed plus the review comments of Allan Smith on an earlier
draft of this chapter.
Contents
1
1
3
5
11
16
17
17
21
21
21
24
28
28
29
30
31
31
32
33
33
33
34
34
34
36
38
39
40
41
42
xi
xii
Contents
Bonn Convention . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EC Directives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
The Beginning of Cooperative Management
of the Wadden Sea . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Trilateral Wadden Sea Cooperation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
The Trilateral Wadden Sea Plan Key Elements . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Shared Principles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Policy and Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Summary and Missing Links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
The Role of the Wadden Sea NGOs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
The Role of Wetland Science in Monitoring, Modeling,
and Future Impacts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Acronyms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
42
43
52
54
54
54
57
57
57
58
58
61
61
62
64
65
66
70
70
72
74
74
77
81
83
83
84
84
84
85
88
89
89
44
44
45
46
47
50
50
Contents
xiii
93
93
96
100
103
104
106
107
107
108
109
110
114
115
116
118
118
125
125
126
128
131
131
132
133
133
133
134
135
136
138
141
142
142
143
143
144
144
146
148
xiv
Contents
Acronyms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
6
153
153
156
156
157
161
161
162
165
167
168
170
173
174
174
175
176
176
179
179
181
187
190
191
191
192
192
192
193
193
194
202
204
204
211
211
211
Contents
xv
213
214
215
215
216
216
218
219
220
221
222
224
226
230
230
231
232
236
237
238
239
241
267
241
245
245
248
250
251
253
253
256
256
256
257
258
259
260
267
269
271
272
xvi
10
Contents
Geographical Context . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Wetland Ecology. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Local Land Use/Cultural History. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Early Problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Charcoal Production . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Era of Increased Wetland Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Current Management of the Mankote Mangrove . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Policy and Government Stakeholders. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
The Role of Scientific Assessment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Management and Social Structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Summary/Roles of CBOs and NGOs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Acronyms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
273
274
278
278
279
282
285
288
289
290
291
293
294
301
301
301
304
306
307
309
309
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
313
Chapter 1
Introduction
Wetlands are among the worlds most important environmental resources; yet
remain among the worlds least understood and most seriously abused assets.
Of all global systems, wetlands are the source of some of todays most contentious, difficult, and politically sensitive environmental and social questions.
Increasingly, in both the developed world and developing world, the future of
wetlands seems to depend on economic, social, and political development
trends and the outcomes of litigation, and legislative/administrative debate
rather than natural processes. Yet natural processes result in ecosystem functions that have real economic value to society which can be expressed in terms of
yield over time, such as fisheries production, maintenance of water quality, and
flood damage aversion. The purpose of this book is to examine the international
environmental policy implications of wetland use and management conflicts.
Wetlands occupy the transitional zone between permanently wet and generally dry environments (Finlayson and Moser 1991, p. 8) and generally have
some form of temporary flooding, saturated soils, and resultant plant communities that have adapted to these conditions. There are different forms of both
freshwater and saltwater or brackish wetlands including marshes, swamps,
peatlands, floodplain wetlands; mangroves, nipa and tidal freshwater swamp
forest; lake edge wetlands, estuaries and lagoons, and even man-made wetlands.
A number of authors have addressed wetland types and their occurrence
around the world (Finlayson and Moser 1991, Kusler and Opheim 1996,
Mitsch et al. 1991, Mitsch and Gosselink 2000, Whigham et al. 1993).
In the traditional view, wetlands are wastelands (Maltby 1986, p. 1, Mitsch
and Gosselink 2000, p. 13). Words like marsh swamp, bog and fen imply little
more than dampness, disease, difficulty, and danger. Such wasted lands can be
put to good use, however, if they are reclaimed for agriculture and building.
From mythology, we have the view that wetlands were bogs and swamps
inhabited with creatures, pixies, heathens, and monsters. This mythology was
transported from Europe to North America and probably is still with us,
explaining part of the negative attitude toward wetlands (Smardon 1983).
But historically, far from being wastelands, wetlands are among the most
fertile and productive ecosystems of the world. They are essential life-support
systems, play a vital role in controlling water cycles, and help to clean up our
environment as biofilters. Some wetlands produce up to eight times as much plant
matter as an average wheat field, promising higher crop yields if the fertility of the
wetland soil can be harnessed and the ecosystem managed for sustained production. Actually wetlands were the mainstay of the ancient Mayan food production
system, which was able to maintain multiple cities 2000 years ago (Smardon
2006). Many, if not all of the worlds great civilizations were born in wetland
regions, such as in the floodplains of the Nile, the TigrusEuprates, and the Indus
Rivers and in the Yucatan peninsula (Maltby 1986, Mitsch and Gosselink 2000,
p. 8). Wetlands traditionally are known for their value for biodiversity and as
habitat for plant animal and fish species (Verhoeven et al. 2006, Bobblink et al.
2006, Mitsch and Gosselink 2000). More recently a number of environmental
services or functions from wetlands are being recognized, such as
Table 1.1 Ecosystem services provided by/derived from wetlands (Millennium 2005)
Services
Comments and examples
Provisions
Food
Freshwater
Fiber and fuel
Biochemical
Genetic materials
Regulatory
Climate regulation
Water regulation
Water purification/
treatment
Natural hazard
regulation
Erosion regulation
Pollination
Cultural
Spiritual and
inspirational
Recreational
Aesthetic
Educational
Supporting
Soil formation
Nutrient cycling
the worldwide extent of wetlands is difficult because of the variation in definitions of wetland cover types and the fact that wetlands constantly change in
area with variation in water levels. Based on several estimates, the extent of
the worlds wetlands is thought to be from 7 to 9 million km2 or about 46% of
the worlds land surface (Mitsch and Gosselink 2000, p. 35). According to the
Millennium Assessment (2005) it is in excess of 1,280 million ha (1.2 million km2)
but wetlands everywhere are under threat and/or stress.
Agricultural practices such as extensive use of water for irrigation and excessive nutrient loading from use of nitrogen and phosphorous in fertilizers.
Freshwater diversion from estuaries causing less delivery of water and sediment to nursery areas and fishing grounds.
changes in coastal wetlands due to sea-level rise, increased storm and tidal
surges, changes in storm intensity and frequency, and subsequent changes in
river flow regime, and sediment transport;
changes in the distribution of coastal wintering shorebirds and other waterfowl as well as habitat loss;
incidence of vector-borne diseases such as malaria and dengue and of waterborne diseases such as cholera (Millennium 2005, p. 7).
The association of wetlands with diseases such as malaria, schistosomiasis
and in the northeastern US, eastern equine encephalitis has been a strong and
emotive factor in drainage or heavy use of insecticides. Recent outbreaks of
West Nile virus in bird populations in the United States and the fear of wild
waterfowl transferring avian flu in Asia and Europe have intensified these fears
in recent years. This encourages wetland loss throughout the world and is an
Fig. 1.1 Countries that are Ramsar Treaty contracting partners. Contracting parties are
shaded in dark gray. Figure drawn by Samuel Gordon and adapted from Ramsar Convention
for Wetlands: http://www.ramsar.org
Fig. 1.2 Annual history of Ramsar site designations. The first Ramsar site was designated in
1974. In this graphic, the annual level of Ramsar site designation is depicted along with a
cumulative trend line. Figure drawn by Samuel Gordon and adapted from Ramsar Convention for Wetlands: http://www.ramsar.org
Fig. 1.3 Figure illustrating approximate distribution of Ramsar sites around the world.
Figure drawn from Samuel Gordon and adapted from Ramsar Convention for Wetlands:
http://www.ramsar.org
Fig. 1.4 Total designated Ramsar site area/region (ha). Ramsar Contracting Parties come
from one of six administrative regions. This chart depicts the approximate current total
designated area of Ramsar sites from each region. The cumulative area of Ramsar sites
worldwide now totals approximately 159,551,478 ha designated in 1,721 sites. Figure
redrawn by Samuel Gordon and adapted from Ramsar Convention for Wetlands: http://
www.ramsar.org
During the initial years of the convention, most of the parties attention was
devoted to developing the List of Wetlands of International Importance (Ramsar Convention 1984). Designation of a wetland for the list means the areas
ecological character is to be maintained, and notification of any change in
ecological character, actual or potential, has to be given to the Ramsar Bureau
in Gland, Switzerland. If, as a result of urgent national interest, a site is removed
from the list, another area of original habitat is to be listed as compensation. So
far 152 contracting parties have listed 1,615 sites (much more than I site per
country) covering about 145 million ha (Wetlands International web site1). No
site has ever been deleted, though small boundary modifications have taken
place. The listing of a site does not mean that the site must necessarily be turned
into a nature reserve. Exploitation of wetland resources is entirely possible,
especially in the form of productive activity for the benefits of human pastoralists, agriculturalists, fisherman, or people who live on the site, as long as the
ecological character is maintained (Smart and Kanters 1991).
Unfortunately, the ecological character of the sites on the Ramsar List has
not always been maintained. Here are two cases in point:
Ria Largartos (also see Chapter 8), a hypersaline lagoon fringed by mangrove on the Yucatan peninsula is one of Mexicos premier wetlands and is
being impacted by (1) salt harvesting operation, (2) hydrologic flow restrictions due to bridges and roads across the lagoon, (3) filling of mangroves by
residents moving to coastal communities, (4) plus loss of fish rearing habitat
plus overfishing (Rosete et al. 1991, Faust and Sinton 1991, Smardon 2006).
In Europe, the Axios River Delta in Greece (see Chapter 3), another Ramsar
listed wetland, is being impacted by intensive rice farming, overgrazing on
the floodplain, and water pollution from upstream sources. Its ecological
character is also not being maintained (IUCN 1990, Tsiouris and Gerakis
1991).
1
The wise use of wetlands is defined as their sustainable utilization for the
benefit of human kind in a way compatible with the maintenance of the
natural properties of the ecosystem.
Sustainable utilization is defined as human use of a wetland, so it may yield
the greatest continuous benefit to present generations while maintaining its
potential to meet the needs and aspirations of future generations.
The natural properties of an ecosystem are defined as those physical, biological, or chemical components such as soil, water, plants, animals and
nutrients, and their interaction between them.
The Regina Conference also established a Working Group on Criteria and
Wise Use, which was charged with examining how to elaborate the criteria and
how to apply the wise use provisions. The Working Groups report was circulated to the contracting parties, in anticipation of the conference of the parties
held in June/July 1990 in Montreux, Switzerland.
The Working Groups report developed the Regina guidelines further. It
recognized that the elaboration of national wetland policies would be a longterm process, and that immediate action should be taken to stimulate wise use.
The revised guidelines therefore include both short- and long-term elements that
are divided into (1) actions that establish national wetland policies; (2) priority
actions at the national level; and (3) priority actions at particular wetland sites.
In order to increase knowledge and awareness of the importance of wetlands,
the benefits and values of wetlands were listed at the Regina Conference. The
listing was taken from Adamus and Stockwell (1983) and Adamus et al. (1987),
which provided a codification of wetlands functions. This is of special interest
because of its focus on functions of importance to people and thus on the
possibilities for human participation and wise use including
groundwater recharge;
groundwater discharge;
flood storage and desynchronization;
shoreline anchoring and dissipation of erosive forces;
sediment trapping;
nutrient retention and removal;
food chain support;
habitat for fisheries;
habitat for wildlife;
active recreation;
passive recreation and heritage value.
10
The overriding concern at the Leiden Conference on the Peoples Role in Wetland Management (Marchand and Udo de Haes 1990, Marchand and Udo de Haes
1991) was with the application of the wise use guidelines. Examples were needed
that could be adopted or developed by other contracting parties. The papers
presented at the workshop in Leiden did offer a number of such examples and
gave interesting insight into the attitudes of both countries that were contracting
parties and those that were not. One of the key issues is how the conventions work
can be extended beyond the conservation of waterfowl habitat, in order to give
greater weight to all aspects of wetlands and to develop the northsouth dialogue
for full consideration of wetland-dependent livelihoods. Other legal and technical
limitations of the Ramsar Convention will be covered in subsequent chapters.
Since 1971, the Ramsar Convention parties have held nine major meetings:
the fifth meeting in Kushiro, Japan, in 1993, the sixth meeting in Brisbane,
Australia, in 1996, the seventh meeting in San Jose, Costa Rica, in 1999, the
eighth meeting in Valencia, Spain, in 2002 and the ninth meeting in Kampala in
2005. These conferences of the parties have resulted in a number of programs
and at least 200 official decisions (117 resolutions and 83 recommendations)
(see http://www.ramsar.org).
In addition to the Ramsar Convention, there are other forms of international
wetland recognition. Some wetlands are given regional or national recognition
(Carp 1980). Others are recognized and protected by being UNESCO biosphere
reserves or parks such as the Ria Lagartos Biosphere Reserve in Mexico
(Chapter 8 this volume and Smardon and Faust 2006) or the Trebon Basin in
the Czech Republic (Kvet et al. 2002). Within biosphere reserves, nature
reserves and parks the usual management or protection device is zonation
where uses and activities are increasing restricted as one moves closer to critical
habitat areas. The implementation of zoning has been problematic in multiplepurpose biosphere reserves, where there is a range of activities undertaken by
local people living within the biosphere reserve. This is related to the problem of
local enforcement by government agencies or non-governmental groups
(NGOs) that manage the biosphere reserve. Or more importantly, it may be
due to lack of participatory processes in development of management plans for
these biosphere reserves (see Smardon and Faust 2006).
Wetlands under private ownership pose special management problems stemming from the difficulties of maintaining ecological integrity if the economic use
of the wetlands is not restricted. There may be resultant resource conflict as well
as upstream or upper watershed uses that are not compatible with downstream
ecological integrity. We also have the example of the United States and Canada
trying to restrict the inappropriate use of privately owned wetlands through
permit and review systems. This raises the taking issue of economic loss of
property rights without giving appropriate compensation as well as due process
and delay in decision making. Future chapters will address some of these basic
management issues that affect decision making within the context of public
versus private land ownership, governmental versus non-governmental management with attendant legal and economic issues.
11
In US vs. Riverside Bayview Homes, Inc. 474 US 121 (Sup. Ct. 1985) the
court unanimously upheld the Corps jurisdiction over wetlands adjacent to
navigable-in-fact waterways.
A 5-4 divided court in Solid Waste Agency of Northern Cook County vs.
Army Corps of Engineers SWANCC 531 US 159 (Sup Ct. 2002) held a series
of ponds in northern Illinois was not subject to CWA jurisdiction solely
based on their use by migratory birds. The court distinguished but did not
override Riverside Bay view (Kusler et al. 2006).
12
Rapanos vs. US 126 S. Ct. 2208 (Sup Ct. 2006), the third case, did not
override either Riverside Bayview or SWANCC (Kusler et al. 2006). The
case vacated to lower appellate court decisions upholding CWA jurisdiction
for wetland which were separated from ditches or drains leading into navigable waters by a berm and for wetlands linked to navigable waters through a
system of drainage ways and ditches (Kusler et al. 2006).
The US Corps of Engineers has to sort all this out in terms of the jurisdictional issue and its about as clear as mud!
In Canada, problems with the wise use of wetlands are concentrated at the
borders of major urban areas, especially around the Great Lakes and the St.
Lawrence River (see Chapter 7). In this region a great deal of money and
attention has been given to the wise use of wetlands, especially to passive and
outdoor recreation and other non-consumptive uses. There was activity in
the early 1990s by the bi-national Great Lakes Wetlands Policy Consortium
(an NGO) that has complied some 50 recommendations to pressure both
Canadian and US agencies to do more with wetlands protection, management
and even creation to offset previous wetland losses and impacts (see Brown
1990, Gruenwald 1990, Loftus et al. 2004). In addition there is the North
American Waterfowl Management Plan, whose objective is the protection of
existing wetlands and the creation of additional wetlands to ensure adequate
habitat for migratory waterfowl along the North Atlantic Flyway in the
United States, Canada, and Mexico (see Lambertson 1990, Loftus et al.
2004, Rubec 1994).
Interesting developments in Europe include (1) recognition of the importance of small wetlands, especially marshes, (2) the need for a census of small
remaining wetlands, (3) the need for modern costbenefit analyses concerning
modern cropping of rice paddies, (4) the need for cooperation between farmers,
recreationalists, and other participants to make conservation of small wetlands
economically viable, and (5) the need for approval at the national level of a law
for the protection of national wetlands (Maltby 1986, Williams 1990).
In the Netherlands we can see the results from the Dutch Society for the
Preservation of the Wadden Sea in Chapter 2 of this volume over a 25-year
history. The Netherlands part of the Wadden Sea has many values and is
particularly appropriate, given the issue of wise use inside a large Ramsar site.
Emphasis is given to the important role of policies that directly affect the
inhabitants of the area including (1) decreasing the intensity of farming on
the Wadden Isles, (2) giving more attention to nature-oriented recreation, and
(3) preventing reclamation of salt marshes and mudflats.
Other European countries may or may not have specific regulatory programs
protecting wetlands. For instance, Sweden investigated national wetland protection laws (Leander and de Mare 1994) but did not pass such legislation.
Sweden has several environmental laws that require landowners to preserve or
not pollute existing wetlands with appropriate economic compensation (Leander and de Mare 1994). This is an issue that affects much of Europe according to
13
Turner and Jones (1990), which includes market failure case studies for the
United Kingdom, France, and Spain.
There is hope that ecotourism and other uses will be useful in sustaining more
compatible usage of many wetlands throughout the world, particularly in
Central and South America (Rosete et al. 1991, Smardon 2006). If tourismgenerated revenues are returned to local peoples and/or community-based
organizations (CBOs) these funds can be used to maintain wetland-dependent
livelihoods or at least divert land use activities that would have a deleterious
impact on the wetland ecosystem. However, it remains to be seen whether
ecotourism or nature tourism is sustainable.
Wetland conversion and wetland drainage goes ahead despite the possibility
that greater benefits might come from more carefully considered management
and exploitation. Developed countries have apparently not learned from their
centuries of experience. The Irish Peat Board, for instance, argues that any
ecological damage brought about by peat mining in Ireland is a small price to
pay for reduced import bills and an improved standard of living.
In the Peoples Republic of China, multiple use ecosystems have been established via measures adopted for local management of wetlands. In Vietnam a
very alert and adaptable approach to wetlands use has resulted in a change from
intensive cultivation of rice on recently drained grounds to the cultivation of
less-intensive crops, which are more appropriate to the principle of wise use and
sustainability. But, at the same time, there is no legal recognition of jurisdiction
of wetlands for government or private ownership in Vietnam.
The same mistakes are being exported to the developing world, where many
of the biggest wetland conversion projects are being carried out with foreign
aid. The Netherlands, which has a longer history of expertise in land drainage
than most other countries, has financed drainage surveys in Zambia and
Jamaica. Swedish and Finish funding has supported a prospective peat mining
project in Jamaica, and Japanese money went into a plan to drain Jamaican
wetlands for agriculture (Maltby 1986).
In the late 1970s the World Bank financed feasibility studies and the preparation of plans to drain and divert to agriculture 570,000 ha of wetlands in
south Sumatra and central Kalimantan. Between 1981 and 1984 the World
Bank loaned $87 million for two Indonesian swamp reclamation projects,
which together resulted in the drainage of 39,000 ha of wetlands for agricultural
use and resettlement. The hydrological disruption, peat subsidence, and acid
sulfate soil problems that have resulted from this reclamation have caused
major ecological and environmental degradation. In some cases the land has
been abandoned, but the extent of damage to water quality, fisheries, and
wildlife habitats remains largely unknown.
In the mid-1970s the Inter-American Development Bank (IDB) partly
financed the drainage and conversion of agriculture of 2,000 ha of Jamaicas
Black River Upper Morass. Earlier, in the same decade, the IBD loaned $50
million toward agricultural conversion of 165,000 ha of marshland in Mato
Grosso State in Brazil and $95 million for drainage and irrigation of 81,000 ha
14
15
problems of the management and protection of the coastal wetlands around the
Mediterranean Sea. Politicians worldwide have often exploited the green
label in some cases with substantive results and media coverage of environmental issues is fairly constant, especially with environmental and economic
implications of regional climate change and the roles of wetlands. So this is the
opportunity for pushing the importance of effective wetland management
worldwide.
But, before we take action, we should be aware of the respective roles of
government, international, national, and regional NGOs, local communitybased organizations (CBOs), and specific livelihood linkages to wetland
resources locally. It is authors thesis that effective wetlands management is
strongly linked to the interchange of government, NGO, and CBO roles plus
local residents wise use of wetlands internationally. Only when we can understand how these roles and linkages work we can have lessons to impart about
effective wetland management policy. There have been very good international
guidance provided by the Ramsar Bureau, Wetlands International, IUCN, and
various authors (Dugan 1990, Maltby 1991, Rubec 1989).
Most recently the Millennium Ecosystem Assessment has specifically
addressed Ecosystems and Well Being: Wetlands and Water (Millennium
Assessment 2005). Within the summary for decision makers, the authors of
the report stress wetland services and human well-being including services for
those living near wetlands [that] are highly dependent on those services and are
directly harmed by their degradation (Millennium Assessment 2005, p. 1).
Other services listed include water purification and detoxification of waste,
climate regulation, mitigation of climate change and cultural services. The
report also reviews status and trends of wetlands, causes of wetland loss and
degradation, explore four possible scenarios for plausible futures as well as
potential responses to these alternate futures. The drivers of wetland stress and
change are very much as we have already seen in this introductory chapter. The
new emphasis in the Millennium Assessment (2005) is (1) the sustainable
possibilities and tradeoffs for groups utilizing wetlands for food fiber and fuel
and (2) wetlands role in climate change amelioration and resultant stress on
wetland systems from climate change.
We need to take a closer look at cases where all the actors and linkages are at
play and we can attempt to identify what is working or not with sustainable
wetlands management.
The case studies were chosen as being roughly geographic representation of
major wetlands systems in Europe, Africa, Asia, North America, and Latin
America/Caribbean. They were also chosen because there was significant NGO
involvement and there was substantial access to background information on
wetland management history, The author has direct knowledge of the Axios
River Delta in Greece, Great Lakes Coastal Wetlands in the United States and
Canada, Ria Celestun and Ria Lagartos estuarine lagoons in Mexico and
Mankote mangrove in St. Lucia. Interviews were done with major participants
for the Tran Trim Nature Preserve in the Mekong Delta, Vietnam, Great lakes
16
coastal wetlands in Canada and the US, and the Mankote mangrove in St.
Lucia. Major local actors were asked to review earlier versions of the case
studies. Within each case study there is usually a regional policy context, a
history documenting how changes have occurred to the respective wetland,
detailed listing of dominant flora and fauna to show how the wetland has
changed as well as documentation of the respective roles of key individuals,
organizations, and other stakeholders affecting wetland management decisions.
References
17
recognition and biosphere reserve status does little to reduce the stress. You will
be surprised as one local fishing village literally takes the bull by the horns to
solve their own resource dilemma.
Chapter 9 finishes the case studies with the story of a small mangrove wetland in St. Lucia typical of mangroves throughout Latin America and the
Caribbean. This is a story of local innovation for sustainable charcoal production while maintaining key habitat areas in the mangrove wetland.
Chapter 10 summarizes international, regional, and site-specific issues presented in the case studies and also summarizes effective innovations or major
barriers to sustainable wetland management.
Acronyms
CBO: community-based organization
EC: European Commission
CWA: US Clean Water Act
IDB: Inter-American Development Bank
IUCN: International Union for the Conservation of Nature
IWRB: IWRB
LDCs: lesser development countries
NGO: non-government organization
SWANCC: Solid Waste Agency of Northern Cook County vs. US Army
Corps of Engineers
WWF: Worldwide Fund for Nature-World Wildlife Fund
References
Adamus, P. R. and L. T. Stockwell. 1983. A Method of Wetland Functional Assessment. US
Federal Highway Administration, Washington, DC, Vol. 1 Report FHWA IP-82-83, Vol.
II, Report FHWA-IP-82-24.
Adamus, P. R., E. Clairain, E. J. Smith, and R. E. Young. 1987. Wetland Evaluation
Technique (WET), Vol. 2: Methodology, Operational Draft. Vicksburg, MI, US Army
Corps of Engineers Waterways Experiment Station.
Ambasht, R. S. and N. K. Srivastava. 1994. Restoration strategies for the degrading Rihand
River and Reservoir ecosystems in India. In W. J. Mitsch (ed.) Global Wetlands: Old World
and New, pp. 725728. Amsterdam: Elsevier.
Azarth, J., P. Banth, H. Azarth, and V. Selvan. 1988. Impact of urbanization on the status of
mangrove swamps in Madras. In D. D. Cook et al. (eds.) The Ecology and Management of
Wetlands, Volume 2: Management Use and Value of Wetlands, pp. 225233. Portland,
Oregon: Timber Press.
Baca, B. J. and J. R. Clark. 1988. Coastal management practices for prevention of future impacts
on wetlands. In D.D. Cook et al. (eds.) The Ecology and Management of Wetlands Volume 2:
Management Use and Value of Wetlands, pp. 2844. Portland, Oregon: Timber Press.
Baldock, D. 1984. Wetland Drainage in Europe. London: IIED/IEEP.
Bobblink, R., D. F. Whigham, B. Beltman, and J. T. A. Verhoeven. 2006. Wetland functioning in relation to biodiversity and restoration in Wetlands. In R. Bobblink, B. Beltman,
18
References
19
20
Patrimoine dans le Monde a LAube du XXXI Siecle, pp. 785815. Presses de LUniversite
de Paris-Sorbonne.
Smardon, R. C. 2006. Heritage values and functions of wetlands in Southern Mexico. Landscape and Urban Planning, 74(34): 296312.
Smardon, R. C. and B. B. Faust. 2006. Introduction: international policy in the biosphere
reserves of Mexicos Yucatan peninsula. Landscape and Urban Planning, 74(34): 160192.
Smart, M. and K. J. Kanters. 1991. Ramsar participation and wise use. Landscape and Urban
Planning, 20(13): 269274.
The Conservation Foundation. 1988. Protecting Americas Wetlands: An Action Agenda:
Final Report to the National Wetlands Policy Forum. Washington, DC: The Conservation
Foundation.
Toledo, A., A. V. Botello, M. Herzog, and F. Contreiss. 1989. Environmental Studies on
wetlands of Coatzacoalcos, Veracruz state, Mexico. In J.A. Kusler and S. Daly (eds.)
Wetlands and River Corridor Management, pp. 102107. Berne, New York: Association of
State Wetland managers.
Tsiouris, S. E. and P. A. Gerakis. 1991. Wetlands of Greece: Values, Alterations, Conservation.
Thessalanki: WWF Laboratory of Ecology and Environmental Protection, Faculty of
Agriculture, Aristotelian University of Thessalanki IUCN.
Turner, K. and T. Jones (eds.). 1990. Wetlands: Market and Intervention Failures. London:
Earthscan Publications Ltd, 202 pp.
Verhoeven, J. T. A., B. Beltman, F. F. Whigham, and R. Bobblink. 2006. Wetland functioning
in a changing world: Implications for natural resource management. In Verhoeven, J. T. A.,
B. Beltman, R. Bobblink, and D. F. Whigham (eds.) Wetlands and Natural Resource
Management, Ecological Studies Vol. 190, New York: Springer, pp. 112.
Vileisis, A. 1997. Discovering the Unknown Landscape: A History of Americas Wetlands.
Washington, DC: Island Press.
Whigham, D. F., D. Dyjova, and S. Hejny. 1993. Wetlands of the World: Inventory, Ecology
and Management. Dordrecht, The Netherlands: Kluwer, 768 pp.
Williams, M. (ed.). 1990. Wetlands: A Threatened Landscape, Oxford, UK: Basil Blackwell,
419 pp.
World Wildlife Fund. 1992. Statewide Wetland Strategies: A Guide to Protecting and Managing the Resource. Washington, DC: Island Press.
Chapter 2
Introduction
This is a story of a very large coastal wetland complex bordering the North Sea
plus three countries in Europe. Intertwined with a multi-jurisdictional management issues is the role of several NGOs most notably the Society for the
Preservation of the Wadden Sea. This case study will present the wetland
resource, the various threats to the resource, a three-country institutional
context, and finally the role and history of the NGOs involved.
The Wadden Sea covers an area of 8,000 km2, half of which is tideland and an
additional 1,000 km2 made up of the Wadden Islands. More than half (60%)
of the tideland found between Europe and North Africa to the mangrove coasts
is situated in the Wadden Sea. The sea is bounded by three countries: the
Netherlands, Germany, and Denmark and sits between Den Holder in the
Netherlands and Esberg in Denmark (see Fig. 2.1).
Historical Overview
Humans have interacted with the Wadden Sea since its origin 7,500 years ago.
Exploitation, habitat alteration, and pollution have strongly increased since the
Middle Ages, affecting abundance and distribution of many marine mammals,
birds, fish invertebrates, and plants. Large whales and some large birds disappeared more than 500 years ago. Most small whales, seals, birds, large fish,
and oysters were severely reduced by the late nineteenth and early twentieth
centuries, leading to the collapse of several traditional fisheries (Lotze 2005).
Since 1600 the surface area of the Dutch Wadden Sea has decreased by
successive reclamation of salt marshes. In 1933 the Zuiderzee (3,200 km2) was
closed off from the Wadden Sea causing an increase in tidal range and current
velocities in the remaining parts. In 1969 the Lauwerzee (91 km2) was closed off
and turned into a freshwater lake. Dredging in harbors and shipping routes as
well as extraction of sand and shells became common practice and contributed
to turbidity of the Wadden Sea. Discharge of nitrogen and phosphorus into the
western Wadden Sea increased manifold since 1950 causing an increase in
R.C. Smardon, Sustaining the Worlds Wetlands,
DOI 10.1007/978-0-387-49429-6_2, Springer ScienceBusiness Media, LLC 2009
21
22
Fig. 2.1 (a) Catchment area of the Wadden Sea and The Wadden Sea: Sublittoral, mudflats,
islands, and supralittoral areas redrawn by Samuel Gordon. Sources: Adapted from Common
Wadden Sea Secretariat, Undated. The Wadden Sea: A Shared Nature Area, p. 3, and WWF,
1991. The Common Future of the Wadden Sea, p. 57
Introduction
23
Fig. 2.1b and c Aerial photo of part of the Danish Wadden. Source: Common Wadden Sea
Secretariat, Undated. The Wadden Sea: A Shared Nature Area, p. 1
10 times between 1950 and 1961 due to culturing, and catches of cockles
increased slowly between 1955 and 1984. Whelks were fished until 1970
(de Jonge et al. 1993).
The most important changes in the biotic system of the Wadden Sea
(de Jonge et al. 1993) were increased production of microalgae and intertidal
macrozoobenthos which can be attributed to increased nutrient loads. Eutrophication provided ample food supply for mussels, which were harvested
mainly by man and eider duck, and may have caused increased growth rates
in juvenile plaice. Increased turbidity may have impaired life conditions for
adult dab and assisted in recovery of substantial eelgrass beds after their
disappearance in the 1930s (de Jonge et al. 1993, Swennen 1989).
24
Introduction
25
disturbance of benthic species on the bottom. As a result 25% of the flats in the
Wadden Sea have been closed for mussel and cockle fisheries, while effects of
shrimp fishing are still being investigated. Fishing licenses have been limited
and there is some minor fishing activity for eel, sole, gray mullet, and smelt.
In terms of biodiversity of the Wadden Sea we have a few definitive studies.
Wolff (2000) examined various causes of expiration of marine and estuarine
species within the Wadden Sea and their relative importance. He obtained data
from geological, archeological, historical, and biological publications. According
to Wolff (2000) at least 10 species of algae, 10 invertebrates, 13 fish, 5 birds, and
4 marine mammals became extinct during the past 2,000 years. Habitat destruction played a part in 26 cases, over-exploitation in at least 17 cases, and pollution in
at least three cases. According to Fog et al. (1996) eight species of amphibians and
four species of reptiles are threatened in at least one subregion of the Wadden Sea.
Of these, seven species of amphibians and all four species of reptiles are threatened
for the entire area and are therefore placed on the International IUCN Red list.
The only mammal left in the Dutch coastal waters is the seal (see Fig. 2.2). Its
reason for staying in the Wadden Sea is also the abundant food stocks, the
peace, and the space still to be found there. In summer the females have their
young on the high exposed sand bars. They also use these sand bars as places to
rest. In the 1950s there were still about 2,500 seals in the Dutch Wadden Sea, but
their number rapidly declined as a result of hunting and human disturbance,
and later water pollution. After reaching a low of 350 animals in 1975, their
number increased to about 1,000 in 1988. In that same year, a virus disease
attached to the colony and in combination with water pollution decimated the
animals to 350 in 1989. The seal has become an indicator of environmental
quality and its numbers have increased to almost 1,200 in 1994.
In 1962 the Netherlands prohibited seal hunting. Germany and Denmark
followed the lead in 1973 and 1976, respectively. The places where seals used to
Fig. 2.2 Seals on an offshore shoal. Source: Common Wadden Sea Secretariat, Undated. The
Wadden Sea: A Shared Nature Area, p. 3
26
rest are under additional protection. The Netherlands has two resorts for seals:
one on the island of Texel, in the research center of EcoMare, and the other a
village of Pieterburen. Germany has one in Norden and one in Fridrichskoog,
and Denmark one in Esbjerg.
The major landscape features heading back from the waters edge are salt
marshes, islands, dunes, and embankments around dike edges (see Fig. 2.3).
Much of the original marsh was destroyed by reclamation, but new salt marsh
has also been created due to natural siltation and accretion processes. The salt
marshes are extremely productive or fertile and are valuable as pastures for
farmers at the seaside. These same farmers have been trying to stimulate the
formation of salt marshes and these methods vary from country to country. In
1930 the Netherlands took over the SchleswigHolstein method, which implies
the stimulation of silt deposit by ditches and osier dams. When the deposit had
become high enough a dike was constructed and so a new plodder had been
created. Now and again a newly reclaimed salt marsh was protected against
further influence of the sea by a low dike. A similar salt marsh is called a
summer Plodder. In the 1960s the reclamation of the Dutch Wadden area
was stopped. Only maintenance of reclamation works is kept up. There is also
experimentation with different species such as Juncus and Phragmites for
brackish marsh creation (Bakker et al. 1993, Huiskes 1988) (Fig. 2.4).
Fig. 2.3 Typical estuarine pattern. Source: Common Wadden Sea Secretariat, Undated. The
Wadden Sea: A Shared Nature Area, p. 7
Introduction
27
Fig. 2.4 Coastal dunes. Source: Common Wadden Sea Secretariat, Undated. The Wadden
Sea: A Shared Nature Area, p. 12
developed dunes. Not all islands developed in this way. The Halligen in
the SchleswigHolstein area are remains of an extensive area of salt marshes.
The Danish Wadden Islands were also formed on sandbars; the wide
beaches are the result of the enormous transport of sand in this part of the
Wadden Sea.
Dunes are not only formed by the wind piling up loose sand,but the sand may
also be blown away again, unless plants hold it. Sometimes the sea washes away
large parts of the dunes during a gale. In the Netherlands, this is a real problem
on the island of Texel. When the dunes protect the land from the sea, much
effort is being made to keep them as they are.
Marram is planted and reed mats are put up to prevent the dunes from
eroding. Longitudinal dikes are also built across the beach to ward off the
current. This was done on Vieland. So the beach holds its initial width and the
waves can only wash dunes during extremely heavy storms. On Texel the beach
is raised with new layers of sand to protect the dunes. The west sides of most of
the islands of Lower Saxony have been embedded in concrete by heavy dikes.
In the Netherlands, by contrast, it is possible to keep the coastal strip more
dynamic. The key is that dune land variation in lime, lime limited, wet and dry
creates the variation and diversity in vegetation. Dunes also function as fresh
water collection devices.
For centuries embankment of land outside the dikes was common practice in
the Wadden area. Creeks were cut off in order to improve the protection of the
hinterland. It also made more soil available for farming and cattle breeding and
more recently for industrial and military activities. The land outside the dikes,
however, is also of great importance for wildlife as it provides many bird species
with grounds to feed, rest, and breed. In recent years the motives for embankment of new land outside the dikes came under great pressure, because there is
28
29
In the course of this century recreation on the Wadden Islands, where many
landscapes are combined (beach, dune land, salt marsh, woodland, and plodder), has developed into an important means of existence. This led to drastic
changes. Several farmers decided to close their farms and become recreational
farmers. Water sports have also expanded enormously in the Wadden Sea.
During high season the islands harbor so many tourists that the total number of
inhabitants is increased 10-fold. On the one hand, recreation affects nature and
landscape, on the other hand it has focused the attention on the Wadden area
with favorable effect on conservation and protection. In recent years there is a
tendency to expand the season in order to reduce the flow of tourists during the
high season.
The Wadden Sea is very attractive for water sportsmen. The number of
yachts is still increasing, and several Wadden Islands decided to enlarge their
marinas and the effects are not all positive. Careless water sportsman can
seriously disturb natural areas at critical times. Seals are very vulnerable in
summer when their young are born. This also applies for breeding, roosting,
and foraging birds. Since 1981 the number of areas coming under the Nature
Conservation Act has largely been extended. Some parts may not be entered by
boat or otherwise and sometimes entering is only allowed for nature study or
research.
Lauwersmeer
In 1969 the Lauwersmeer was separated from the Wadden Sea by a dike with
the intention of improving the drainage of the provinces of Groningen and
Friesland. This dike has been provided with a lock and a drainage sluice. The
result was the Lauwersmeer, a hinterland consisting of land and water. The
Lauwersmeer area is important for all kinds of migratory birds, such as geese.
There are many kinds of recreational facilities, especially for water sports. The
military exercise ground that has been established there does not fit in with
areas so near the Wadden Sea and near recreational activity.
In 1965 a plan was launched to connect the island of Ameland with the
mainland by means of two dams. This plan was the impetus to set up the Dutch
Society for the Preservation of the Wadden Sea. The Wadden Society succeeded
in preventing the plan from being realized. However, reclamation of an area of
4,000 ha along the Frisian coast, the so-called Noord-Friesland Buitendijks
(North Friesland outside the dikes), was still being pursued. But in the last
instance the Wadden Society also blocked this plan. Conservationists do not
support future plans for reclamation of parts of the Dutch Wadden area. In the
German Wadden, however, such plans are still an issue.
The Dutch Wadden area is also used for military purposes. Especially the
western part is extremely popular with the Ministry of Defense. Military
activities take place near the city of Den Helder and the island of Texel and
30
on and around the island of Vieland. In addition there is a route for low-flying
military aircraft over the eastern part, and the Lauwersmeer has an exercise
ground and shooting range. The German Wadden area is also disturbed by
military activities affecting human and wildlife activities.
Currents transport great quantities of polluted water from the European
rivers (Rhine, Schekdt, Meuse, Elbe, and Ems) into the Wadden Sea. The
atmosphere, the IJesselmeer, dumping in the North Sea, and discharges from
the Wadden Sea itself all add to the pollution. Agriculture and shipping oil (oil
spills) are also to be blamed for the pollution of the Wadden Sea. The polluting
substances penetrate into the food chain via plankton. As a result seals are
weakened, become infertile, and are susceptible to virus diseases. The number
of fish diseases in the North Sea and Wadden Sea still increases. Man is also part
of the food chain and recently found susceptible to the long-term subtle affects
of toxics. Fortunately the flow of polluting substances from the large rivers is
decreasing lately.
The bottom of the Wadden Sea holds natural gas in some locations. Oil
companies are constantly searching for these gas fields. On the island of
Ameland and the western part of the Wadden Sea exploitation has already
started. But there are more sites where the presence of natural gas has been
established. Exploitation of natural gas disturbs the ambient environment,
seriously affects the landscape for a long time, and leads to settlement. As a result,
vulnerable dune land and marshes are submerged, and the areas appropriate for
foraging birds decrease in size. The Wadden Society resisted the new plans the oil
concerns made to put new drilling rigs in the Wadden Sea from 1994. Exploitation
of natural gas is not accepted within the context of the Wadden Sea as a nature
reserve.
31
32
Schleswig-Holstein Germany
This part of the Wadden is quite different from those in Lower Saxony and the
Netherlands. The islands were formed in a different way and were called
Halligen. They are partly remains of the salt marshes that were washed
away by a fierce storm tide in 1634. In the course of time these islands grew at
the side of the mainland, while parts of them at the seaside were washed away.
The salt marshes were already inhabited before 1634. On the Halligen are
mounds, called Warften, on which one or more farmhouses were built. Some
Halligen are connected to the mainland by means of a dam. After the storm
tide of 1962 most Halligen have been provided with summer dikes. A unique
feature of this Wadden area is the Wanderdunen on Sylt, a bare dune land.
This conservation area is subject to continuous erosion. Along the coast of
Schleswig-Holstein active reclamation is still common practice.
In the last 50 years tens of thousands of hectares of biologically valuable
ground outside the dikes were lost. In the Schleswig-Holstein Wadden a new
dike was constructed in the Nordstrander Bucht, which resulted in the loss of
90 km2 of the Wadden area. Elsewhere an area of 570 ha is threatened by
embankment.
The Wadden area of Schleswig-Holstein is a very popular recreation area,
especially the island of Sylt with its ample facilities. High-rise blocks dominate
the capital of Westerland. Sylt is connected with the mainland by a dam. The
train running across the dam takes hundreds of thousands of tourists with
their cars to the island yearly. The islands of Pellworm and Amrum also
attract many tourists. On most of the Halligen recreation is still a smallscale affair.
Some years ago Lower Saxony, Hamburg, and Schleswig-Holstein have
designated their Wadden areas as National Parks. Unlike the Netherlands,
the federal governments disposed of legal tools enabling them to take drastic
protective measures. Germany has taken advantage of this possibility by creating special zones. In some of these zones, nature has absolute priority over all
human activities. In other zones some activities are permitted. And there are
buffer zones and zones where nature has no priority at all. The criteria for
zoning are different in both federal states concerned. Unlike the Netherlands,
Germany has not coordinated the administration of these zones.
The German Wadden area is exposed to several threats. Recreation is much
more intensive than in the Netherlands, also because many islands are easily
accessible by dams. Large-scale embankment projects were carried out in the
Leybucht and the Norstander Bucht. Oil exploration takes place near the bird
island of Trishen. Military activities are still expanded in the area. Large
industrial centers are established near Emden, Bremerhaven, Wilhelmshaven,
and Cruxhaven, involving contamination risks for soil, water, and air. A large
nuclear power plant is situated near Esenshamm in the Weser area, as is the case
at Bokdorf on the Elbe. Hamburg harbors many metallurgical and chemical
33
concerns. The Rivers Weser and Elbe are permanent sources of pollution for the
Wadden Sea. But Germany is also beginning to realize the importance of
protecting nature reserves such as the Wadden Sea.
Skallingen
The Danish Ministry for the Environment bought Skallingen as a conservation
area in 1976. This peninsula, which has a length of 13 km, came into being as a
result of the transport of sand that formed a whole with the beach ridges. It
consists of a row of dunes at the backside of which is an extensive salt marsh
bordering the Ho Bugt and transacted by many channels. The salt marsh
measures about 700 ha. Human activities have also marked the landscape of
Skallingen. The erosion of the dunes is partly blamed on recreation, and
intensive grazing causes the harm done to the salt marsh. Besides, many dikes
of dry sand have been put up and ditches dug. The south point suffers from
serious erosion.
Varde A
It is quite exceptional, especially in the Wadden Sea, that man allows rivers to
flow freely into the sea without taking precautionary measures in his effort to
check its stream by dikes and locks. The Varde A is such an exception. That is
why such an unusual landscape has been created in and near its estuary. The
extraordinary variety of its vegetation is a result that the freshwater river blends
with seawater. At extremely high water levels and stormy weather the saltwater
can penetrate a few kilometers into the riverbed. These annoying inundations
have been resisted everywhere else but they provide beautiful landscape in the
Varde A area.
34
Esbjerg
Due to the relatively low population density the Danish Wadden area is less
disturbed than the Dutch and German parts. Esberg is the only large town in
this neighborhood. The fish processing industries in this large fishing harbor are
mainly responsible for the discharge of large quantities of wastewater. Moreover,
the sewers of the city discharge into the Wadden Sea and the rubbish dump is
situated near the beach. This is why organic matter mainly pollutes this part of the
Wadden Sea. The coastal area north of Esberg along the Ho Bugt has a steep coast.
35
and scenic values at stake, and of activities which threatened these same values
with fast decline or total destruction. The usual response was regulations (laws),
which purport to restrict certain uses of the Wadden Sea areas. However, there
was further decline of the area due to loopholes in the regulations, insufficient
attention to particular values of the area, and lack of clear quality requirements.
Finally a set of regulations was issued in the three states that truly did not reflect
the ecological relations and connections characteristic of the area. Furthermore, these regulations were the result of numerous political compromises.
Many of the regulations shared no connection to one another, and were issued
by competing legislative bodies and competing authorities. There was no relation between the three countries bordering the Wadden Sea.
At the same time there were similar shared concerns. In the Netherlands and
Germany there were people who argued in favor of valuation and description
of the Wadden Sea as an ecological entity, recognizing protection as being of
national significance. In the Netherlands, this led to proposals for a special
Wadden act, and in Germany for a National Park Act for the Wadden area.
Politicians were not ready for such institutional mechanisms and presented
their own proposals. In Denmark, the most important Nature Conservation
Act came into force as a result of the discussion about proposed dams in the
1960s. A final solution is yet to be found and regulations concerning the affected
area have been and are still developing.
Before moving on to institutional mechanisms existing in each of the three
countries, we should at least acknowledge three major NGOs that have focused
public attention on the issues mentioned and in some cases forcing action. In
1965 the Dutch Society for the Preservation of the Wadden Sea was established.
The Wadden Society goals include optimal conservation of the natural and
historicalcultural values of the Wadden area. Several working groups in the
Wadden Society engage in diverse issues such as water, military use, recreation,
industrialization, and management. All legal means, which might lead to a
favorable policy review, are applied such as
The society has approximately 60,000 members, 300 of them active. The
members receive the Wadden Bulletin, a periodical with many activities about
landscape and nature in the international Wadden area and interviews with
people working and living in the area. Activities of the society are also given
much attention.
In Germany, the Schutzstation Wattenmeer and the World Wildlife Fund
(WWF) Wattenmeerstelle are active in Schleswig-Holstein. Not only do they
engage in campaigns against embankment plans and nuclear plants but they
also give information. Several islands have information centers, which also
publish a newsletter (Informationsbrief ).
36
In 1977 a Danish Wadden Group was established which at the time resisted
reclamation plans and the increasing facilities for water sports. The Fishing
Museum in Esbjerg has brought out quite a lot of publications on the Danish
Wadden. These three groups have been the major NGO actors for preservation
and ecosystem management of the Wadden Sea wetlands. The following sections will outline existing institutional protection measures for the three countries followed by international treaties and provisions.
The Netherlands
The Wadden policy in the Netherlands is based on the Physical Planning Act
and the Nature Conservation Act. These two regulations support a complicated
system that tries to make use compatible with protection. At the same time
efforts have been made to solve the problem of coordinating competing powers
of national, regional, and local authorities, and those of numerous other
departments and institutions. The Nature Conservation Act grants the status
of nature reserve by means of a designation with all concomitant legal consequences. The physical planning key decision (PKB), which is based on the
Physical Planning Act, regulated the various forms of exploitation and coordination of administrative aspects.
The combining of the two regulations was necessary because the Nature
Conservation Act cannot do justice to both the ecological and social functions
of such a large area. On the other hand, the legal status of the PKB was too
unstable and judicially weak to serve as a basis of integration for protection and
use of the area.
In the Dutch system, these values are first described in the PKB. By doing so,
the advantages of the physical planning law as the most favorable instrument to
weigh all interests at issue, including the interests of nature, could be used. In
this respect, use of a new instrument like the PKB based on the Physical
Planning Act can be supported. It provides an opportunity to straighten out
the rather complicated relations between ecological and social interests. By
combining both instruments, the Dutch government made a lot of concessions
to the Nature Conservation Act and the values and interests that the law is
supposed to protect, and thus to the ecological values as well.
The policy established in this combination of regulations is based on conservation, protection, and recovery of the Wadden Area. Human use is not excluded.
The PKB indicates what forms of use are meant, and how these are to be fitted to
actual situations, for example, by granting permits under the Nature Conservation
Act so as to cause as little damage as possible to the ecological value of the area.
The PKB further indicates to which geographic area it applies. The area is limited
to the actual marine part between the dikes on the mainland and the southern part
of the islands, and some of the uninhabited parts of the islands.
The Dutch set of regulations shows severe shortcomings according to van der
Zweip and Backes (1994). Although PKB allows the environment in the area
37
Fig. 2.5 Agricultural use of Wadden Sea marshes. Source: Common Wadden Sea Secretariat,
Undated. The Wadden Sea: A Shared Nature Area, p. 8
38
Germany
In Germany, there are a lot of various instruments, which together form the
judicial basis for the protection of the Wadden Sea. The legal system is rather
complicated for several reasons. In the first place, because of the federal form of
government, which means that the federal states (Lande) are the first to be
responsible for nature conservation, while the federal government acts only as a
coordinating body. All efforts to change this situation by a constitutional
amendment failed in the early 1970s. The lack of unity among the authorities
issuing regulations has been an important stumbling block in the development
of the protection of the Wadden area in Germany.
This protection is mainly based on the Nature Conservation Acts and
especially on the regulations for national parks. The Nature Conservation
Act of the federation defines what this protection should comprise and the
federal states have to work out the details of the regulation. As the German part
of the Wadden area extends over four federal states (Lower Saxony, Bremen,
Hamburg, and Schleswig-Holstein) the legal powers required for protection of
the area as a total entity are dissipated. For example, as early as 1974 large parts
of the area were already designated as wetlands of international importance
under the Ramsar Convention. Other parts were not designated. The area of
Schleswig-Holstein was designated as a national park in 1985, the area of Lower
Saxony in 1986, and the Hamburg area in 1990. Bremen was left out. Through
the City of Bremerton, the city-state of Bremen borders the Wadden area, is a
party to the trilateral Wadden consultants at a governmental level, though it has
no Wadden territory of its own, and therefore no specific Wadden regulations
of its own.
The three existing regulations of the national parks are not only different
from one another in a substantial way as to their form (laws in Hamburg and
Schleswig-Holstein, a regulation/bylaw in Lower Saxony) but also in their
territorial scope (with or without islands, salt marshes, forelands, and/or
dikes). Furthermore, their degree of effectiveness is quite different. Nevertheless, the regulation of national parks in Germany were the only chance of
realizing wider-ranging protection of the area than was possible under the
already existing regulations for nature conservation, as these were haphazardly
applied. It also offered the opportunity to create an administration infrastructure (national park administration) to manage the national parks as entities and
to provide funds for their management.
These national park settlements embrace nature conservation aims, and
formulate the acceptable and admissible social uses. All this is expressed in a
set of local, periodic bans, orders, and exemptions. All regulations in the Lander
are based on splitting up the area into zones, which apply different forms of
protection. Roughly, the area is divided up into three zones: zone I in which the
interests of nature are predominant and human use principle is excluded; zone
II in which human use is not excluded but where important protection measures
39
are taken; and zone III which includes all remaining areas, above all recreation
areas. A system of prohibitions applying to these zones has to guarantee that
use is compatible with protection, i.e., that human activities do not harm the
natural values.
Although protection of the Wadden area in Germany is mainly based on the
Nature Conservation Acts, the Physical Planning Act also plays an important
point. The systems, however, are not directly linked. The purposes established
through town and country planning are necessary additions. The hierarchical
structure of this instrument for planning is one of the reasons why certain uses,
including environmental uses, can be weighed and established at an administrative level. Though these uses can only be roughly described, they have a
highly standardized effect. In this way, various forms of exploitation have been
defined by zoning. The pros and cons of relevant interferences (some indicated
in the planned purpose) are meticulously weighed, both with respect to protection and to various other functions.
Lastly, sector law should be mentioned. On the basis of the constitutional
distribution of legislative power, some activities are exclusively regulated by
sector law (shipping on the Wadden Sea, for example). The nature conservation
laws of the federal states and the regulations concerning the national park
settlements adopted under them may not include any restrictions with regard
to these activities. Restriction for the sake of nature protection can be enforced
only under the sector law concerned. In actual practice, the authorities sometimes fail to do this, or if they do, the result is unsatisfactory. This can be
considered a weak spot in the German legal system for the protection of the
Wadden Sea.
Denmark
The Danish set of instruments for the protection of the Wadden Sea has been
highly refined in recent years. This applies to the legal foundations supporting the protective measures as well. In 1992, the various nature protection
laws were streamlined and integrated into the new Act on Nature Protection.
The former designations under these nature protection laws were combined
in 1985 to form one designation of large parts of the Wadden Sea as a nature
preserve. However, the protection of the Danish Wadden Sea is not fully
integrated into one regulation under the nature protection laws. In addition
to the general conservation rule according to the Nature Protection Act
that covers the whole region, there are special territorial laws applying to
specific areas (for the reclaimed Margrethe Kog and the Tonder Marsh salt
marshes).
Protection under the nature protection laws is complemented by protection
on the basis of town and country planning. The Danish physical planning laws
have also been drastically revised in recent years, especially with respect to the
40
integration of the various physical planning laws into the new 1992 Planning
Act. Just as in Germany, Danish physical planning is hierarchical. The regional
plans, which are drawn up by the two counties in the Wadden Sea region, are of
special importance. After weighing all interests playing a part in the area
concerned, the counties decide on the functions and the possibilities for development of the space concerned. The county and municipal councils will strive to
implement the guidelines of the regional plan. Their planning and development
activities may not contradict the regional plans. In most cases, the county or
municipal councils operate at first instance; hence the physical plans have a
significant practical importance.
International regulations have a large effect on the implementation of the
above-mentioned regulations in Denmark, especially the Ramsar Convention
and the EC Bird Directive, and in the future, the Habitat Directive. The Danish
Wadden Sea was designated as a wetland of international importance under the
Ramsar Convention in 1987, and earlier, in 1983, as a special protection zone in
accordance with Section 4 of the Bird Directive. The provisions from international agreements and EC directives are in principle not directly binding in
Denmark, but are first to be transformed into national law. Nevertheless, the
Nature Complaint Board, in particular, uses the provisions from the Ramsar
Convention and the EC Bird Directive for judicial review even without a clear
national foundation. In real practice, those international agreements and regulations are therefore of utmost importance for the protection of the Wadden
Sea, at least as far as the jurisdiction of the Nature Complaint Board is
concerned.
Besides this, specific decisions such as conservation decisions, which are
proposed by the nature conservancy boards in accordance with the rules laid
down in the Nature Protection Act, are important. Such specific conservation
decisions (e.g., regarding air traffic, marinas, water catchments, road projects,
or management measures for special areas) are brought to the Nature Protection Board of Appeal. The power of this board as an administrative appeals
board is based on such cases, which are viewed as administrative decisions
based on the Nature Protection Act. These specific conservation decisions
constitute another important environmental instrument for the protection of
the Danish part of the Wadden Sea.
41
Ramsar Convention
The Ramsar Convention aims at the protection and conservation of wetlands
(as discussed in Chapter 1), which means protection of the whole biotype rather
than only species. An area satisfying the criteria established by the convention
can be presented on the list of wetlands. At present, almost the whole Wadden
area has been designated as such and appears on the list.
Once an area has been designated, the contracting party is obliged under
Section 3.1 to . . .promote the conservation of wetlands included in the list.
Under Section 4.1 there is also an obligation to promote the conservation of
wetlands by establishing nature reserves whether or not these wetlands appear
on the list. Denmark drew the conclusion that the convention does oblige the
designation of areas satisfying the criteria, and consequently the protection of
them by means of the national regulations (nature reserves). The Netherlands
took the line that designation can only be realized and effective if the area is
already protected under national regulations and inclusion on the List of
Wetlands of International Importance only sets the seal of protection. It is
interesting, given this background that the Netherlands did not designate all
parts of the Wadden area, which are already fully protected under national
regulations. Though the whole PKB area is designated as a Ramsar area, not
included are important parts of the islands, a strip of the North Sea, and parts of
the mainland, which are also part of the Wadden Ecosystem. The German
government has established new nature reserves or extended existing reserves
on listed sites since for their inclusion on the list.
The Ramsar Convention has a strong influence on the protective measures
for the Wadden area. In all these countries, the area, or large parts of it, is
protected under national laws. This is also due to international supervision or
observance of the convention through the permanent secretariat, periodic
Conferences of the Contacting Parties, and access of NGOs to various events
and processes. Through this public exposure, obligations though not directly
binding, become morally binding. In Denmark, this is expressed by the fact that
42
Bonn Convention
The Bonn Convention especially aims at the protection of wild migratory
animal species. The contracting parties bind themselves to conserve the habitats
of the migratory species. The convention is a framework treaty on the basis
of which regional agreements can be concluded. In 1988, the Netherlands,
Germany, and Denmark concluded an agreement on the Conservation of
Seals of the Wadden Sea. This agreement came into force on October 1, 1991,
and is the first regional agreement under the Bonn Convention. So far the
43
EC Directives
Because of their binding effect, the most important international protective
measures are those taken by the European Commission (EC). Among these
measures are the Bird Directive and the new Habitat Directive, which have the
most forward reaching consequences for the protection of the area. The Habitat
Directive takes over and reinforces the function and the legal consequences of
the Bird Directive as far as the designated areas under this directive are
concerned, and also the provisions and obligations resulting from the Bern
Convention. The Habitat Directive has been enforced in the national regulations of the three Wadden countries.
So far, the Bird Directive has inadequately been implemented with respect to
the Wadden area, both as an obligation to designate protected areas and to the
observance of the protective measures required. Both the Netherlands and
Germany have been reproved for this several times by both the European
Commission and the European Court of Justice.
One of these cases is the judgment made by the European Court of Justice in
the Leybucht case regarding the structure of the new Habitat Directive. The
judgment was that it is justified that the Habitat Directive be more strictly
implemented and applied. The directives implementation does not only involve
designation of areas to be protected but also judicial consequences. The
44
45
with the adoption of the Joint Declaration in 1982. The Ramsar Convention
played an essential role in bridging the formal differences and expresses
the political commitment to cooperate in the protection of the Wadden Sea
(Dettmann and Enemark 2004). The three countries had ratified the Ramsar
Convention and were legally committed to implement its provisions. If in
accordance with Article 5, the Wadden Sea countries would consult on a
coordinated implementation of the Ramsar Convention with respect to the
Wadden Sea this greatly contributed to comprehensive protection.
According to the Joint Declaration, the governments declared their intention
to consult with each other in order to coordinate their activities and measures to
implement a number of international legal instruments with regard to the
comprehensive protection of the Wadden Sea region as a whole. The international legal instruments, as mentioned previously, are the Ramsar Convention
on Wetlands, the Bonn Convention on the Conservation of migratory species,
the Bren Convention on the conservation of European wildlife and natural
habitats, and the relevant EC directives, in particular the EC-Bird Directive.
The Joint Declaration resolved a dilemma. It is a declaration of intent,
stating the political commitment to work toward a common goal, but it includes
a number of legally binding international instruments. It was the intention of
the parties that counts, rather than the legal character of the instrument. The
Joint Declaration served as a catalyst in the period after 1982, and in conjunction with the establishment of the common secretariat in 1987, the Trilateral
Wadden Sea Cooperation was intensified and extended (Dettmann and
Enemark 2004). The Trilateral Wadden Sea Plan, which was adopted at the
Eighth Wadden Sea Environmental Ministers Conference in 1997, entails a
comprehensive common policy and management of the Wadden Sea (see
Waddensea Secretariat 1997)
46
The Wadden Sea Plan entails a number of critical decisions with regard to the
delimitation of the common management area, the shared principles, and
action to implement the targets.
Delimitation
The geographic range of the Wadden Sea Plan is the Trilateral Wadden Sea
Cooperation Wadden Sea area, which is
the area seaward of the main dike, or where the main dike is absent, the
spring-high-tide-water line, and in the rivers, the brackish-water limit;
the islands.
The trilateral conservation area is situated within the Wadden Sea, and
consists of the following:
In the Netherlands. the areas under the Wadden Sea Memorandum including
the Dollard
In Germany, the Wadden Sea national Parks and protection areas under the
existing Nature Conservation Act seaward of the main dike and the brackish
water limit including the Dollard
In Denmark, the Wildlife and Nature Reserve Wadden Sea
It is recognized that within the Wadden Sea area, there are areas where
human use has priority. The delimitation of the Wadden Sea area attempts to
bridge the formal differences in jurisdiction between the three countries. The
Wadden Sea area is a common management area and not a protection area,
which allows for the implementation of trilateral agreements, measures, and
actions by the application of a wide range of national instruments.
Shared Principles
The Guiding Principle of the Trilateral Wadden Sea Policy is to achieve, as far
as possible, a natural and sustainable ecosystem in which natural processes
proceed in an undisturbed way. The principal is directed toward the protection
of the tidal area, salt marshes, beaches, and dunes.
In addition, seven management principles have been adopted which are
fundamental to decisions concerning the protection and management within
the Wadden Sea area (see Waddensea Secretariat 1997):
47
The Precautionary Principle, i.e., to take action to avoid activities which are
Targets
The trilateral conservation policy and management is directed toward achieving
the full scale of habitat types, which belong to a natural and dynamic Wadden
Sea. Each of these habitats needs a certain quality (natural dynamics, absence of
disturbance, absence of pollution), which can be reached by proper conservation and management. The quality of habitats shall be maintained or improved
by working toward achieving targets, which have been agreed upon for six
habitat types. Targets on the quality of water and sediment are valid for all
habitats. Supplementary targets on birds and marine mammals have been
adopted, as well as targets on landscape and cultural aspects (see Waddensea
Secretariat 1997) (Table 2.1).
48
of artificial salt marshes, under the condition that the present surface area is not
reduced;
An improved natural vegetation structure, including the pioneer zone, of artificial salt
marshes.
Tidal areas
The tidal area covers all tidal flats and subtidal areas. The border to the North Sea side is
determined by an artificial line between the tips of the islands. The borders of the estuaries are
determined by the average 10% isohaline at high water in the winter situation.
The following targets are valid:
An increased area, and more natural distribution and development of natural mussel
beds, Sabellaria reefs and Zostera fields;
Viable stocks and natural reproduction capacity, including juvenile survival, of the
common seal and gray seal;
Increased natural dynamics of beaches, primary dunes, beach planes, and primary
dune valleys in connection with the offshore zone;
49
An increased natural morphology, including the outer deltas between the islands;
Favorable food availability for birds;
Viable stocks and a natural reproduction capacity of the common seal, gray seal, and
harbor porpoise.
Rural area
The rural area includes meadows and arable land on the islands and on the mainland where
there is a strong ecological relationship with the Wadden Sea.
The following target applies
Favorable conditions for flora and fauna, especially migrating and breeding birds.
Targets on the quality of water and sediment
Nutrients
A Wadden Sea, which can be regarded as an eutrophication non-problem area.
Natural micropollutants
Background concentrations in water, sediment, and indicator species.
Man-made substances
Concentrations as resulting from zero discharges.
Source: Dettmann and Enemark (2004).
50
51
Although the adoption in 1991 of the common principles and objectives was
a significant step in the right direction, there were still major shortcomings in
the trilateral cooperation. The principles and objectives were formulated in a
way that allows individual countries considerable freedom for interpretation.
Consequently, to some they can follow their own course while still complying in
terms of the trilateral agreement.
Furthermore, the ministerial declarations are not legally binding. When
a participating country does not comply with the adopted principles and
objectives the other countries can only react at a political level and there
are no significant sanctions. For these reasons and others previously
covered in the review of existing management instruments, the NGOs
sponsored a second study, which concerned the legal component of the
managerial view. The intention was to study how the rules applied to the
three countries could be harmonized. This study resulted in the publication entitled Integrated System for Conservation of Marine Environments Pilot Study: Wadden Sea (Zweip and Backes 1994). Hans
Revier, director of the Dutch Wadden Society, pointed out the need for
such a study
52
Water quality targets especially for total discharge, nutrients, heavy metals,
53
54
change, leading to adaptation in the birds annual cycle. The biggest problems
may arise for those birds, which depend on wetlands, because many of these
wetlands may desiccate (Meekes 1992).
Summary
So in essence, the role of Wadden Sea NGOs evolved from early protection of
species to campaigns against specific development proposals and management
activities, to international diplomacy and influence of policy determined at the
Trilateral Government Wadden Sea Conferences. The strategy for the 1991,
1994, and 1997 meetings is that of the agenda setters; preparation of major
policy documents designed to have maximum impact on policy decision
makers. NGOs concerned with the Wadden Sea continue their monitoring
role, especially with the international conventions such as Ramsar, Bonn
Convention, and EC Bird/Habitat Directives. Above all the Wadden Sea
NGOs do an incredible job with education through use of newsletters and
other media to keep members and concerned citizens informed. The role of
wetland science is also critical in monitoring and reporting on the health and
direction of change of ecosystems habitat and specific species as reported above
in the previous section
Acronyms
EC: European Commission
IUCN: International Union for the Conservation of Nature
PKB: Physical Planning Act
References
Bachest, S. 1991. Acceptance of national parks and participation of local people in the
decision making process. In M. Marchel and N.A. Udo des Has (eds.) Special Issue
Wetlands. Landscape and Urban Planning, 20: 239243.
Bakker, J. P., J. de Leeuw, K. S. Dijkema, P. C. Leendertse, H. H. Prins, and J. Rozema. 1993.
Salt marshes along the coast of the Netherlands. Hydrobiologia, 265(13): 7395.
van Berkel, B. M. and J. M. Revier. 1991. Mussel fishery in the international Wadden Sea,
consistent with wise use? In M. Marchel and N. A. Udo des Has (eds.) Special Issue
Wetlands. Landscape and Urban Planning, 20: 2732.
Brouns, J. J. 1992. Climatic change and the Wadden Sea, The Netherlands. Wetlands Ecology
and Management, 2(12): 2329.
Christiansen, C. and T. Aagaard. 2004. Wadden Sea research: An introduction. Geografix
Tidsskrift, Danish Journal of Geography, 104(1): 13.
References
55
Dettmann, C. and J. Enemark. 2004. Workshop D The Wadden Sea Plan common
management of a shared wetland. In 5th European Regional Meeting on the Implementation
and Effectiveness of the Ramsar Convention, 48th December 2004, Yerevan, Armenia.
Fog, K., R. Podloucky, U. Dierking, and A. H. P. Stumpel. 1996. Red list of amphibians and
reptiles of the Wadden Sea area. Hegoland Marine Research, 50(Suppl. 1): 107112.
Goss-Custard, J. D., R. A. Stillman, A. D. West, R.W. G. Caldow, P. Triplet, S. E. A. le V. dit
Durell, and S. McGroty. 2004. When enough is not enough: Shorebirds and Shell fishing.
Proceedings of the Royal Society B: Biological Sciences, 271(1536): 233237.
Hergreen, R. 1991. Towards a new vision on the development of the Wadden Sea. In
M. Marchel and N. A. Udo des Has (eds.) Special Issue Wetlands. Landscape and
Urban Planning, 20: 168176.
Huiskes, H. L. 1988. The salt marshes of the Westerschelde and their role in the estuarine
ecosystem. Aquatic Ecology, 22(1): 5763.
de Jong, F. and K. Siderius. 1995. The Wadden Sea: Our compassion and concern. North Sea
Monitor, Dec.: 1516.
De Jonge, V. N., K. Essink, and R. Boddeke. 1993. The Dutch Wadden Sea: A changed
ecosystem. Hydrobiologia 265(13): 4571.
Kees, T. P., T. Piersma, and K. Comphuysen. 2001. What peak mortalities of Eiders tell us
about the Dutch Wadden Ecosystem. Wadden Sea Newsletter, 1: 4245.
Lotze, H. K. 2005. Radical changes in the Wadden Sea fauna and flora over the last 2000
years. Hegoland Marine Research, 59(1): 7183.
Meekes, H. T. H. M. 1992. An inventory of the possible effects of climate change on Western
Palearctic migratory birds. Wetlands Ecology and Management, 2(12): 3136.
Nienhuys, K. 1990. The interaction between a Dutch NGO and the local people in the promotion of wise management of the Wadden Sea Area. In M. Marchand and H. A. Udo ed Haes
(eds.) The Peoples Role in Wetland Management, Proceedings of an International Conference
[Leiden, The Netherlands, June 58 1989], pp. 766771. Centre for Environmental Studies,
Leiden University.
Reise, K. 1995. Predictive ecosystem research in the Wadden Sea. Hegoland Marine Research,
49(14): 495505.
Revier, H. 1995. An integrated system for the protection of the Wadden Sea: A reality or
something to work for? North Sea Monitor, Dec.: 811.
Smit, C. J. 1989. Perspectives in using shorebird counts for accessing long-term changes in
wader numbers in the Wadden Sea. Hegoland Marine Research, 43(34): 367383.
Smits, N. A. C., J. H. J. Schaminee, and L. van Durren. 2002. 70 years of permanent plot
research in the Netherlands. Applied Vegetation Science, 5(1): 121126.
Swennen, C. 1989. Wadden Seas are rare, hospitable and productive. In M. Smart (ed.)
International Conference on the Conservation of Wetlands and Waterfowl [Heiligenhafen,
Federal republic of Germany, 26 Dec. 1974], pp. 184198. Slimbridge, U.K.: International Waterfowl Research Bureau.
Van der Brink, P. J. and B. J. Kater. 2006. Chemical and biological evaluation of sediments
from the Wadden Sea, The Netherlands. Ecotoxicology, 15(5): 451460.
Van der Perk, J. and R. de Groot. Undated. Working Paper 12: Case Study Critical Natural
Capital: Coastal Wetlands: The Dutch Wadden Sea, as part of the CRITINC Project:
Making Sustainability Operational: Critical Natural Capital and the Implications of a
Strong Sustainability Criterion. Environmental System Analysis Group, Wageningen
University & Research Center, 43 pp.
Van Eerden, M. R., R. H. Drent, J. Stohl, and J. P. Bakke. 2005. Connecting seas: Western
Palearctic continental flyway for water birds in the perspective of changing land use and
climate. Global Change Biology, 11(6): 894908.
Van Katwijk, M. M., D. C. R. Hermus, D. J. de Jong, R. M. Asmus, and V. N. de Jong. 2000.
Habitat suitability of the Wadden Sea for restoration of Zostera marina beds. Hegoland
Marine Research, 54(23): 117128.
56
Verhulst, S., K. Oosterbeck, A. L. Rutton, and B. J. Ens. 2004. Shellfish fishery severely
reduces condition and survival of oystercatchers despite creation of large marine protected
areas. Ecology and Society, 9(1): 17.
Waddensea Secretariat. 1997. Trilateral Sea Plan: Eight Trilateral Governmental: Conference
on the Protection of the Wadden Sea. Stade, Germany: Wadden Sea Secretariat, http://
www.waddensea-secretariat.org/tgc/Wsp/
Wadden Society. 1994. Be careful of the Wadden Sea, Harlingen: Wadden Society, 30 pp.
brochure.
Walters, A. R. 1990. Top-down approach to protecting wetlands: A Dutch experience. In
M. Marchel and N. A. Udo des Has (eds.) Special Issue Wetlands. Landscape and Urban
Planning, 20: 623635.
Wolff, W. J. 2000. Causes of extirpation in the Wadden Sea, an estuarine area in the
Netherlands. Conservation Biology, 14(3): 876885.
World Wildlife Fund. 1991. The Common Future of the Wadden Sea. Husun, Germany: World
Wildlife Fund for Nature, WWF-Wattenmeerstelle, 64 pp.
van Zutphen, J. P. 1989. Nature management and sustainable development in the Dutch
Wadden Sea. In W. D. Verney (ed.) Nature Resources and Sustainable Development:
Proceedings of an International Congress [Groningen, The Netherlands, 69 Dec. 1988],
pp. 302311. Amsterdam: IOS.
van der Zwiep, K. 1990. An integrated system for conservation of marine environments: Pilot
Study: Wadden Sea. In M. Marchand and H. A. Udo ed Haes (eds.) The Peoples Role in
Wetland Management, Proceedings of an International Conference [Leiden, The Netherlands,
June 58 1989], pp. 716722. Centre for Environmental Studies, Leiden University.
Van der Zwiep, K. and C. Backes. 1994. Integrated System for the Conservation of Marine
Environments, Pilot Study, Wadden Sea. Baden-Baden: Nomes Verlagsgellschaft, 244 pp.
Chapter 3
Introduction
This chapter takes a look at wetland conservation in the Mediterranean and more
specifically at a Ramsar wetland site in Greece the Axios River Delta complex.
The delta complex actually includes three rivers, the Axios, Loudias, and Aliakmon
rivers, but for the purposes of this chapter is referred to as the Axios Delta. The
questions here to be examined is what has been the recent impact of European
wetland conservation policy expressed by the Grado declaration, MedWet, and
Greeces wetland policy on a specific wetland area? The other issue is what
specific roles did the WWF Greece-sponsored project (the NGO in this case)
play in wetland management policy affecting the Axios River Delta area?
57
58
Legislation
In recent years decentralized services with appropriate technical staff have been
established in order to apply legislation to each area. This legislation concerns
the conservation of nature and exploitation of natural resources. It now applies
to all Greek wetlands whether they are covered by international law or are
covered only by Greek legislation. Indeed some wetlands covered by national
legislation are more important than some included in the lists of the International Conventions.
The following wetlands have been listed under the Ramsar Convention:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
Evros Delta
Amvrakikos Gulf
Vistonis Lake plus the Porto Lagos Lagoon
Delta of the Rivers Axios, Aliakmon, and Alyki Kitros
Mesologi Lagoon
Nestos Delta
Lake Mikri Prespa
Mitrikou Lake
Artificial Lake of Kerkini
Lakes Volvi and Lagada
Kotichi Lagoon and Strofilia Forest
For each of these wetlands, studies have been elaborated by the Ministry of the
Environment, Physical Planning and Public Works, with the participation of
scientists of different university faculties in order to assess the wetlands ecological characteristics, to register the dangers that threaten them, and finally to make
a proposal about their delineation. The author worked on such a study for the
Delta of the Rivers Axios, Aliakmon, and Alyki Kitros to determine whether
remote sensing signatures could be used to delineate wetlands in the area.
The delineation of the core as an area under complete protection and the
definition of minimum activities are in balance with the wetlands function.
59
60
61
62
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(9)
63
attention and study. Some of the most well-known associations have a long
history of activities, especially for wetlands. Two of them, namely the Greek
Society for Protection of Nature (oldest Greek NGO) and the Greek Society for
the Protection of the Environment and Cultural Heritage are known widely as
the Greek Society. Their activities vary from the publication of flyers and
posters, elaboration of research on wetlands, organization of seminars and
lectures to the establishment of two biology research stations. The research
station of the first company is located in the Deltas of the Evros River and the
second in Mikri (little) Prespa. These stations have hosted many researchers and
naturalists, both Greek and foreign. The Greek Company for the Protection of
Nature carries one of the largest reputations in Greece, for information on
protection of nature in general and wetlands specifically.
The Greek (Hellenic) Ornithological Company, with its numerous local
chapters in several wetland areas, in spite of its recent founding, has been
addressing wetland protection issues. It is not limited to scientific activity
such as the midwinter waterfowl census, but has taken on strong partisan
initiatives. The Society is systematically monitoring populations of Pygmy
Cormorant and the Lesser White-footed Goose in the Axios Delta and other
wetlands in Greece. There are other national (Pan-Hellenic) associations, especially scientific, which among other interests include wetlands protection (e.g.,
Greek Botanical Company, Greek Forestry Company, Greek Zoological Company, Greek Hydrotechnical Company, Association of Greek Ecologists, Association of Law on the Environment).
Also important is the formation of small groups, interested especially in
protecting certain wetlands. Some of them are functioning under a regular
constitution where others are citizen groups. There are such associations of
citizen groups for Prespes (actually two of them, one local and one based out of
Athens), for Nestos Delta, for Loudias, for Trichonis, for Vegoritida, and
possibly others. The numerous ecological movements (meaning the green movement which managed to capture a temporary seat in parliament) appeared in
almost every district because they all included protection of wetlands on their
agendas (e.g., Komotini, Lamia, Xanthi, Patra [Thessaloniki]).
All these organizations have problems with resources and the Greek government rarely invites representatives of ecological associations to participate in
decision making. Legal protection (or environmental law in general) has rarely
been used by the ecological associations during their campaigns. This is even
though existing special legislation on wetlands and the environment, in combination with more general laws, present opportunities for legal action.
The support from foreign national and international, non-governmental
associations and organizations for the protection of nature, offered to Greece
for many years, is very significant. Their activities are taking place in combination with related Greek associations, universities, or independently. They
include research programs, training for groups of experts, general information
for the public, publishing written material, mailing of newsletters, and even
appeals to the Greek government for forthcoming ecological disasters. The
64
65
66
Fig. 3.1 Location of Axios Delta in Greece and Axios River watershed and drainage to the
Mediterranean Drawn by Samuel Gordon. Sources: Alphamentor 2005. Small Hydro Projects
in Greece: The Case of Axios River. PowerPoint presentation made in Krakow, Poland, on
September 1920, 2005, http://www.alphamentor.gr; And European Commission, undated,
Eurocrat: European Catchments and Coastal ZoneAxios River CatchmentAxios: The
Axios River Catchment http://www.cs.iia.cnr.it/EUROCRAT/Axios%20ingles.htm
67
Fig. 3.2 Low oblique aerial photo of Axios River Delta. Source: Alphamentor 2005. Small
Hydro Projects in Greece: The Case of Axios River. PowerPoint presentation made in Krakow
Poland on September 1920, 2005, http://www.alphamentor.gr
68
of sand deposits changed too after the diversion of the same river. Those
deposited by its former marsh eroded away while new ones appeared along its
course right after the construction of the new river bed.
Major reductions of the floodplain and riverine forests took place at the
same time. The increase of the population of the plain led to direct forest
clearance to satisfy increased needs for fuel wood, timber as well as agricultural
land. Part of the forest was replaced by meadows and part by scrubland as a
result of the combined effect of forest clearance and major alterations of
hydrology of the area that followed the diversion of the Axios River, the diking
of both Axios and Aliakmon Rivers, and the drainage of Giannitsa Lake and
Loudias Marshes, but the lagoon area remained unaltered.
During the following period (19351970) further reclamation works that
took place led to complete drainage of all marshes left in the central part of
the plain (3,175 ha) and to major reductions of the coastal marsh area. Dikes
were built along the coast, and filling of the marsh area with land was the marsh
reclamation practice of the period. About 4,281 ha of coastal marsh were lost
due to the conversion to agricultural land, another 525 ha were lost due to
erosion, and sediment deposits created subsidence that took place at the old
Axios River Delta, while 725 ha of new marsh were created by the two river
mouths.
A further reduction of forest area for the same reasons as was mentioned
previously was the other main feature of the period. Another 4,450 ha of forest
were lost while scrubland area declined as well (by 4,181 ha). Meadow area was
converted to agriculture while lagoon area remained almost the same. An
increase of lagoon area is due to further extension of the newly formed Axios
Delta. No sand deposits were recorded at the end of this period as the building
of dams along the upper course of the two main rivers as well as the diversion of
Axios sediment into the deeper parts of the gulf caused the loss.
The final account of the delta during 19701990 represents further reductions of coastal marsh area due to further reclamation. The other major feature
of the period was the reclamation of 469 ha of lagoon area between Loudias and
Aliakmon Rivers. Remnants of riverine forest are now limited only along the
riverbeds of the two major rivers. The slight increase of scrubland area was due
to the declaration of a game reserve along the Axios River bed that excluded
farming from the designated area.
The natural part of the wetland is covered by salt marshes, which are the
predominant feature of the coastal area (see Fig. 3.2). The rich material carried
down by the river has created within the delta a series of shallow lagoons and
sandy islets, frequently colonized by a wealth of dense vegetation. Bushes and
tall trees line the banks of the islets and the riverbed (see Figs. 3.3 and 3.4). The
wilderness areas of the wetlands are criss-crossed by the drainage ditches
delineating the arable land. In the spring and summer, when the extensive rice
paddies are flooded, they enhance the landscape of the natural wetland and
create a unique landscape.
69
Fig. 3.3 Axios River Floodplain from the air. Source: Alphamentor 2005. Small Hydro
Projects in Greece: The Case of Axios River. PowerPoint presentation made in Krakow Poland
on September 1920, 2005, http://www.alphamentor.gr
Fig. 3.4 Axios River Floodplain from the riverbank. Source: Alphamentor 2005. Small Hydro
Projects in Greece: The Case of Axios River. PowerPoint presentation made in Krakow,
Poland, on September 1920, 2005, http://www.alphamentor.gr
Despite the changes that took place over the past century when the
wetland lost almost a third of its original size, the delta continues to
impress scientists and visitors with its diversity, especially for fisheries
and bird habitat.
70
Wetland Description
The following sections describe current wetland vegetation, fauna, and land
use. Major sources for the following section include Athanasiou (1987, 1990),
Athanasiou et al. (1994), Gerakis (1988), Jerrentrup et al. (1988), Kazantzidis
(1996), Nazirides et al. (1992), Newly (1995), Psilovikos (1992), Tsiouris and
Gerakis (1991), and Valaoras (1992).
Wetland Vegetation
In coastal wetlands, vegetation varies according to the humidity and salinity of
the soil. The Axios Delta comprises six distinct vegetation zones:
Halophytic vegetation: Halophytes are plants, which thrive, in a saline
environment like salicornia, which dominates one of the plant communities. Sapphire (Salicornia europaea) is an indicator species for one
community that includes Aeluropus littoralis, Halimione portulacoides,
Sperrula sp., and asters (Aster tripolium). Another salt marsh community
has rushes (Juncus maritimus) as an indicator species with other members
being black grass (Juncus gerardii), A. littoralis, sapphire (S. europaea), and
asters (A. tripolium). The third salt marsh community has two indicator
species: alkali grass (Puccinellia festuciformis) and H. portulacoides with the
other member being A. tripolium. The fourth salt marsh community has
two species of Arthrocnemum as indicators: Arthrocnemum fruticosum and
A. glaucum with other members being H. portulacoides, sea lavender (Limonium gmelinii and L. bellidifolium), asters (A. tripolium), alkali grass (P.
festuciformis), sapphire (S. europaea), and foxtail (Hordeum maritimum).
The fifth community consists of one species Arthrocnemum perennis and the
sixth community also has one dominant species, Halocnemetum
strobilaceum.
The tamarisk scrubland community (see Fig. 3.5) is found mostly flanking
the river, but also further inland in the delta. Nearer to the sea the tamarisk
ceases to thrive and is gradually replaced by halophytes, except right along
the riverbed where the increasing salinity is tempered by the freshwater of
the river. The indicator species is tamarisk (Tamarix hampaenan) and the
halophytic under story includes European alkali grass (Puccinellia distans),
A. littoralis, and H. portulacoides. Non-halophytic under story vegetation
includes Bermuda grass (Cynodon dactylon) and foxtail (Hordeum
murinum).
Rush meadows (Juncus spp.) are chiefly found in areas protected from the
effects of saltwater. Large expanses once covered with rushes have been
reclaimed for farmland. Indicator species is rush (Juncus acutus) and other
species include peas such as Fabaceae Leguminosae and Fabaceae
Gramineae.
Wetland Vegetation
71
Fig. 3.5 Axios River Floodplain Tamarix plant community. Source: photo by Dylan Lloyd
that appeared in Newly (1995, p. 4)
Reed beds are found at the mouth of the river and along the riverbanks and
drainage canals. Three phytosociological units were recognized: Bolboschoenetum martimi is an indicator species for one community with other species being
common reed (Phragmites australis) and narrow-leafed cattail (Typha angustifolia). The second community is dominated by common reed (P. australis) with
other species being common cattail (Typha latifolia), narrow-leafed cattail (T.
angustifolia), water fennel (Oenanthe aquatica), flowering rush (Butomus umbellatus), Bolboschoenus maritimus, spike rush (Eleocharis palustris), purple loosestrife (Lythrum salicaria), water veronica (Veronica anagallis-aquatica), and
water mint (Mentha aquatica).
Hydrophytic species, like duckweed and hornwort, flourish whenever there are
shallow expanses of freshwater such as irrigation canals, drainage ditches, and
rice paddies. Specific species include pondweed (Potamogeton nodosus), sago
pondweed (Potamogeton pectinatus), and Potamogeton perfoliatus, water milfoil (Myriophyllum sp.), hornwort (Ceratophyllum sp.), European frogs bit
(Hydrocharis morsus-ranae), duckweed (Lemna minor and Lemna trisulca),
and mosquito fern (Azolla filiculoides).
Riparian forest (see Fig. 3.6) can be found along the banks of the river and on
the many islets formed in the riverbed. The principal species are white poplar
(Populus alba), black poplar (Populus nigra), black alder (Alnus glutinosa),
white willow (Salix alba), Salix triandra, silky-osier willow (Salix viminalis),
and purple-osier willow (Salix purpurea). Under story vegetation includes
bramble (Rubus sp.), hops (Humulus lupulus), ivy (Hedera helix), birthwort
(Aristolochia clematitis), Cynanchum acutum, silk vine (Periploca graeca),
mint (Mentha sp.), sedge (Carex sp.), and European water horehound
(Lycopus europaeus).
72
Fig. 3.6 Axios River Floodplain grassland community. Source: photo by Dylan Lloyd that
appeared in (Newly 1995, p. 5)
Wetland Fauna
The deltas extensive undeveloped areas are more isolated from human disturbance, and provide an ideal habitat for a whole variety of wildlife. Both
saltwater and freshwater fish live in the Axios Delta. Thirty-six different
species have been identified, of which 33 are indigenous and 3 have been
introduced. They include perch, carp, eels, mullet, needlefish, and one endemic species of roach (Rutilus macedonicus).
Although the amphibian and reptilian populations of the delta have not been
studied in detail, six species of reptiles have been observed. Frogs, terrapins, and
water snakes are found in the canals and drainage ditches, while turtles, snakes,
and lizards thrive in drier areas. The Alyki wetland adjacent to the Axios Delta
is a site of herpetological importance. A large population of tortoise (Testudo
hermonni) began a slow recovery between 1990 and 1999 following catastrophic
habitat destruction in 1980 (Hailey and Goutner 2002).
By far the most impressive inhabitants of the delta are its birds. Some 215
different species have been identified; of these, 109 are waterfowl or shorebirds,
which are dependent on water presence. These species come to the delta to nest,
to winter, or to rest during their long migratory journeys. Waterbirds that
utilize the Axios, Loudias, and Aliakmon estuaries include Eurasian spoonbill
(Platalea leucorodia), little bittern (Ixobrychus minutus), black-crowned night
heron (Nycticorax nycticorax), squacco heron (Ardeola ralloides), little egret
(Egretta garzetta), Dalmatian pelican (Pelecanus cripus), Pygmy cormorant
(Phalacrocorax pygmeus), Eurasian oystercatcher (Haematopus ostralegus),
black-winged silt (Himantopus himantopus), Pied avocet (Recurvirostra
Wetland Fauna
73
74
Sightings
Species captured
Dead animals found
Species captured
Species captured
Sightings
Sightings
Sightings
75
Urban waste and industrial effluents from the entire area drained by the river
constitute a water quality problem. Most of the waste and effluent originates
within the former Republic of Yugoslavia to the north plus many towns and
villages along the Greek portion of the river, which ends up in the delta. Unabsorbed fertilizers and agro-chemicals from adjacent farmlands also end up in the
delta with negative effects on the quality of the water and all that lives in it.
Studies have indicated that organochlorides, metals, POPs, and other chemicals have ended up in birds and benthic organisms with the Axios Delta. For
instance, Goutner et al. (1997) have examined organochloride insecticide residues in eggs of little tern (S. albifrons) in the Axios River Delta. Goutner et al.
(2005) have also examined colonial waterbirds (Aves, Charadriiforms) for
PCBs and organochloride pesticide residues in eggs. All pollutants were
detected in all species in all areas expect Deldrin in the Mediterranean gull.
Percent levels of higher chlorinated PCB congeners (IUPAC 118, 138 and 180)
were greater than other compounds in all species and all areas, probably due to
their bioaccumulation properties. Significant differences between Mediterranean gulls and avocets (at Ervos) were found with regard to PCB 138 and PCB
180, whereas differences between Mediterranean gulls and common terns (at
Axios) were found for all PCBs except PCB 8 and PCB 20. Maximum pesticide
concentrations in all samples were below 50 ppb, except for B-HCH and
2.40 DDD for all areas and species. In summary, agro-chemical sources are
dominant over industrial pollution, but their levels were too low to have adverse
biological effect over the species studied (Goutner et al. 2005).
Albaige (2005) also looked at levels of persistent organic pollutants (POPs) in
different biotic (bivalves, fish, marine mammals, and sea birds) and abiotic
compartments (air, seawater, and sediments) of the Mediterranean Sea. No
conclusions were drawn due to scarcity of emission data and shortage of
measurements of good quality.
Janssens et al. (2002) and Goutner and Furness (1997) looked at heavy
metals, especially mercury in the Axios River Delta for water birds. Janssens
et al. (2002) analyzed heavy metals (sliver, arsenic, cadmium, copper, and
mercury. Lead and zinc concentrations have been found in feathers of nesting
great tits (Parus major). There was a gradient of higher concentrations of silver,
arsenic, mercury, and lead for those specimens closer to the pollution source
and no significance in cadmium between sites. Goutner and Furness (1997)
measured mercury concentrations in feathers of little egret and black-crowned
night heron chicks and their prey in the Axios River Delta. Significantly major
concentrations occurred more in night herons than in little egrets in 1993. Diets
differed considerably between the two species due to different foraging habitats.
Mercury concentrations in the pumpkinseed sunfish (Lepomis gibbosus), goldfish (Cariassius auratos), and dragonfly (Odonata larvae) were highest among
the prey. Frogs and water beetles (Dytiscids) had moderate concentrations,
whereas saltwater fish and terrestrial prey had very low mercury concentrations. The implication is that deltaic marshes are the habitat most polluted with
mercury.
76
77
Illegal reclamation of salt marsh for secondary home development or establishment of facilities either for shellfish cultivation or establishment of stables
for animals becomes the most serious threat for further reduction of coastal
marsh areas.
78
The flood control measures taken along the routes of the two rivers of the
plain do not allow the river water to spread on the marsh areas where marsh
plants could trap the sediment. In addition, a number of impoundments built
along the courses of the Axios and Aliakmon Rivers for irrigation and energy
production purposes also retain part of the sediment. So in essence, sediment is
reduced from upstream sources, has little chance to deposit sediment along the
river courses, and once it reaches the delta edge moves directly to the deeper
portions of the gulf. The natural deposition period is closed now by construction of dikes along the rivers and the seashore. Only catastrophic floods and
irrigation water can bring fresh sediments to the area.
Flood storage and desynchronization: Mediterranean wetlands are likely to
provide localized flood control function during winter when the annual rainfall
may cause seasonal flooding (Maltby et al. 1988). What little opportunity for
flood storage and desynchronization was provided by the former floodplain of
the Axios River. Because of the dikes and control structures on either side of the
river, this function is greatly reduced.
Shoreline erosion reduction: The tide is at a minimum in the Mediterranean
but storm and wave action can contribute considerably to coastal erosion.
Marsh-protected coasts suffer comparatively little damage from storms and
wave action. The only evidence of coastal erosion in the Axios Delta was
provided by the retreat of the coastal marsh in the vicinity of the old Axios
River Delta. About 525 ha of coastal marsh were lost during 19451970 due to
erosion and subsidence of the abandoned delta (Athanasiou 1990).
Groundwater recharge and discharge: A water balance groundwater study
was done by NEDECO from 1968 to 1969. The study indicated that the amount
of downward and upward groundwater flows was negligible. A vertical hydraulic gradient exists between the phreatic zone and the top of the artesian aquifers
over much of the plain. The gradient in the study area was generally downward
and small while the sediments over the bulk of the plain are particularly clayey
and therefore highly impermeable. The same study concludes that most of the
surface water bodies Galikos, Axios, Loudias, and Aliak Rivers gain from
groundwater. However, all rivers flow within bounded areas, protected by
cutoff drains over a large part of their length so that their influence as an
input to water bodies is negligible.
Exploitation of aquifers for irrigation and water supply may result in a fall in
the water table, saline penetration, and reduced standing water leading to
significant reductions in waterfowl and fisheries habitat. Possible seawater
seepage in both phreatic and artesian systems in the area was considered by
NEDECO (1970) to be negligible. Groundwater quality, even in the vicinity of
the sea, for both phreatic and artesian waters was found to be significantly
different in composition from seawater. Nevertheless, high evaporation rates
during periods of low precipitation combined with the shortage of irrigation
water derived from the rivers (Axios River has been dry during most of the
summer the last few years) increase the demand for irrigation and place additional pressures on reduced freshwater supplies.
79
80
81
82
defuse pollution. Riparian forests also play a significant role in erosion prevention as well as wildlife habitat. In the river corridor they serve as a significant
nesting and roosting habitat for waterfowl.
The marshes: This type of habitat has undergone a huge decrease of area due to
conversion to agricultural land as was previously discussed. There are hardly
any fresh marshes (380 ha) nowadays and those remaining are the most vulnerable areas in danger of further reclamation.
A waterbird survey on the accessible marshes of the area was conducted in
spring 1989 and summer 1989 and 1990 (Athanasiou 1990). The results of the
long-term monitoring of birds were presented in a delineation study in 1996.
The marsh areas were classified for their vegetation and flooding regime and
evaluation for their relative importance for waterfowl population. Athanasiou
observed waterfowl during seven field visits over a total area of 1,814 ha
consisting of tidal salt marsh (409 ha), permanently flooded non-tidal marsh
(125 ha), lagoons (169 ha), and fresh water marsh (380 ha). The results demonstrate the impacts of the flooded areas for waterfowl populations during spring
and summer. Seasonally flooded salt marsh (425 ha) (dry during survey) and
dry salt marsh (306 ha) were also surveyed but no birds were observed. The
same areas, besides being of significant importance for waterfowl during spring
and summer also perform the functions of shoreline protection (tidal marsh),
nutrient retention and removal (fresh water marsh, tidal marsh), and important
habitat for fish and shellfish (tidal marsh and subtidal marsh).
The delineation of the area as a Ramsar site did not include a very important
part of the marsh habitat. The KalochoriGalikos area happens to include
almost all permanently flooded non-tidal marsh habitats found in the whole
wetland area as well as significant fresh water, tidal marsh, and lagoon areas.
The permanently flooded non-tidal salt marsh, although just 7% of the surveyed area, concentrated on average of 32.6% of the observed waterfowl. It is
also a very important roosting site of the little egrets breeding in the area,
mainly used in late summer. If the Ramsar Convention is going to have any
beneficial effect, this part of the wetland should enjoy full protection and should
be involved in the relevant delineation.
Other management concerns for marsh areas include the following:
Protection of all marsh areas (seasonally flooded salt marsh, dry salt marsh)
as a buffer zone between the agricultural land and wet habitats.
Establishing the carrying capacity of marsh areas for grazing and/or control
overgrazing and extensive destruction of nests of breeding waterfowl during
spring.
The scrubland: The tamarisk scrubland area consists of an important habitat
for wildlife. Further removal will not only reduce habitat diversity but will also
83
84
The JMD that concerns the Axios Delta together with adjacent Galikos and
Loudias estuaries, Aliakmon Delta, and Alyki Kitros has been circulated to the
associated authorities whose views have been collected and processed. The
official JMD has been issued and is still in force (WWF-Greece 2000).
Management Scheme
Until today, there has been no single wetland management scheme for any
wetland or any protected area in Greece. What this means is that all activities
affecting wetlands (crop and animal farming, irrigation, fisheries, housing and
industry development, hunting, etc.) are managed, but what is missing is an
integrated approach to wetland management.
In 1996 the Ministry of Environment put into operation a scheme that will
utilize the information center already constructed in the vicinity of Axios Delta
(town of Chalastra) as well as the warden hats (three at the Axios Delta). This
scheme consisting of two scientists and three guardsguides will operate for 2
years. Among the duties that will be undertaken by the scheme will be (1)
establishment within the local society, (2) getting acquainted with local problems and demands, and (3) facilitation of communication of associated parties, the coordination of positive actions, and the collaboration with local
NGOs. At the end of the 2 years, there will possibly be an opportunity for the
development of a wetland management scheme for the site. WWF thought that
its Red Alert Project had also been invited to participate in the advisory
committee for the wetland management scheme (Athanasiou 1996).
Habitat Directive
The Axios Delta (and Axios River) has been included in the proposed list of
sites eligible to be included in the NATURA 2000 network of Directive 92/43/
EEC also known as the Habitat Directive. The implementation of this directive
attempts to put forward a network of sites (Sites of Community Importance)
and also to designate sites as Special Areas of Conservation, in order to contribute to nature conservation within the territory of the European Union.
85
Detection and monitoring of threats to the site, through regular site visitation
and the development of a network of contacts and constant information
gathering (local authorities, public services, local NGOs, unions of farmers,
fishermen, hunters, etc.).
documentation of threats;
evaluation of possible effects of threats on wetland functions and values;
investigation of possible alternatives that are not detrimental to the site or
proposing conservation measures;
86
87
88
References
89
cooperation with the JMD scheme created by the Ministry of Environment. The
management issues that the Red Alert Project plans to become involved with
have been chosen on the basis of serving as pioneer projects in the field of
wetland management in Greece while placing much emphasis on the active
involvement of local people. Two of such projects are as follows:
Rice Farming at the Axios Delta how can it become more compatible with
natural wetland functions?
Protection restoration of the riverine forests and Tamarix scrub woodland in
the Axios Delta related to needs of colonial nesting birds.
These will be important management activities as we have seen in the current
management issues section of this case study. It remains to be seen how the
JMD, the management scheme, and the role of the Red Alert project will work
out. In 1999 there was an Expression of opinion was filed with the Ramsar
Convention (1999) for possible removal of the Delta of the Axios, Loudias, and
Aliakmon rivers. The Axios Delta and many Greek wetlands have some tough
management problems to solve, a history of wetland degradation, and little
environmental advocacy. At least with the help of WWF Greece, some in roads
have been made toward basic recognition of wetland functions, values, and
health. The role of WWF Greece Red Alert project as an environmental conscious and monitoring presence should be especially noted.
Acronyms
EC: European Commission
EEC: European Economic Community
IUCN: International Union for the Conservation of Nature
IWRB: International Wetlands Research Board
JMD: Joint Ministerial Decision
NEDECO: Netherlands Engineering Consultants
PCB: polychlorinated biphenyls
POP: persistent organic pollutants
WWF: Worldwide Fund for Nature World Wildlife Fund
References
Albaige, J. 2005. Persistent organic pollutants in the Mediterranean Sea. In Handbook of
Environmental Chemistry, pp. 89149. Berlin/Heidelberg: Springer.
Altigos, N., K. Kyraikos, A. Maheras, and N. Nikolaidis. 1962. Project d Irrigation de la Plaine
de Salonique, sur Rentabilite. Athens: Royaume de Greece, Ministere de la Corrdination.
Athanasiou, H. 1987. Past and present Importance of Greek Wetlands for Wintering Waterfowl. Slimbridge UK: IWRB Pub., 63 pp.
Athanasiou, H. 1990. Wetland Habitat Loss in Thessaloniki Plain, Greece. M.Sc. Dissertation,
London: University College, 45 pp., plus appendices.
90
References
91
92
Van Gils, J. A. G. and P. Aigiropoulos. 1991. Axios River basin water quality management.
Water Resources Management 5(34): 271280.
Walling, D. E. and B. W. Webb. 1987. Material transport by the worlds rivers: evolving
perspectives. In Water for the Future: Hydrology in Perspective, pp. 313329. International
Association Scientific Hydrology Publication 164.
Zalidis, G. 1993. International wetlands inventory for Greece: prospects and Progress. In
M. Moser et al. (eds.) Waterfowl and Wetland Conservation in the 1990s; A Global
Perspective, pp. 178184. Slimbridge, UK: IWRB Special Publication No. 26, IWRB.
Chapter 4
Introduction
In parts of sub-Saharan Africa, as well as South America, India, and southeast
Asia, interior riverine wetlands are stressed or altered by dams and reservoir
projects for hydroelectric, irrigation, and flood control benefits (Dugan 1988,
Nelson et al. 1989, Scudder 1989). Resultant impacts from hydroelectric alteration and lack of flooding downstream affect both biodiversity and human use
of floodplain wetlands for agriculture, fiber, and medicinal plant usage
(Mathooko and Kariuki 2000, Tockner and Stanford 2002).
We know relatively little about many of the interior wetland systems of
Africa as few wetland inventories have been done to document existing African
wetlands distribution, value, and function prior to the 1980s. Wetland inventories were brokered by the IUCN and/or the Ramsar Bureau from the 1980s
on. In Zambia a comprehensive wetland inventory was completed in 2002.
Because of the impacts on biodiversity and floodplain-dependent agriculture, scientists around the world are re-examining the possibility of emulating
flood flows to re-establish lost floodplain functions (Acreman 1994, Bayley
2006, 1995, Giller 2005, Horowitz 1994, Junk et al. 1989, Standford et al. 1996,
Ward and Stanford 2006, Welcomme 1995). In fact, specific reintroduction of
flood flows have been partially implemented for riverine wetland systems in
South Africa (Brock and Rodgers 1998, Le Maitre et al. 2002), Cameroon
(Evans et al. 2003, Mouafo et al. 2002, Scholte et al. 2000, Wesseling et al.
1996), for the Phongolo floodplain (Bruwer et al. 1996), northern Nigeria
(Thomas 1999), as well as work proposed for the Zambezi River (Beilfuss and
Davies 1999, Gammelsrod 1996, Scudder and Acreman 1996).
Kafue Flats, as we will see, is one of the most studied and unique floodplain
riverine systems in Africa. This case study is important as it races both the
biodiversity and human livelihood changes within a wetland system with little
dependence on government or NGO intervention and management until recent
times.
The Kafue River is a major north bank tributary of the Zambezi, which joins
downstream of the Chirundu, and approximately 75 km below the current
Kariba Dam (Fig. 4.1). Its basin lies wholly within the Republic of Zambia,
R.C. Smardon, Sustaining the Worlds Wetlands,
DOI 10.1007/978-0-387-49429-6_4, Springer ScienceBusiness Media, LLC 2009
93
94
Fig. 4.1 Location map of Kafue Flats on the Zambezi River. Drawn by Samuel Gordon and
adapted from WWF-Partners for Wetlands Zambia WWF, Kafue Flats, http://www.pan
da.org/about_wwf/where_we_work/africa/where/zambia/kafue
Introduction
95
The Kafue Flats formed a large annually flooded plain (see Figs. 4.2a and b)
approximately 255 km long and up to 56 km in width, along the borders of the
Kafue River (see Fig. 4.1), a major tributary of the Zambezi. About
3,0005,000 km of the total area of 7,000 km is inundated for a period ranging
from 1 to about 7 months. When dry, most of the grasslands on the Kafue Flats
are grazed by cattle, owned by local herdsman of the Ila and Tonga tribes. The
Fig. 4.2a Nyimba looking northwest from east of Nampewgue in April 1970. Photo credit:
University of Michigan Fisheries Research Team
Fig. 4.2b ChungaNamp Gag in April 1970. Photo credit: University of Michigan Fisheries
Research Team
96
annual flooding largely prevents any other type of traditional land use on the
flats proper, but in the dryer parts of the transition zone some corn is grown
locally. Fishing villages are found on the higher levees along the main river and
its tributaries. The traditional inhabitants of the flats, the Twa, live in mostly
permanent villages, while migrants from other areas of Zambia and from
neighboring countries usually occupy semi-permanent villages that have to be
abandoned during high floods.
On the Kafue Flats only a few large-scale agricultural projects have been
implemented. In the southeastern part of the flats near Mazabuka (Fig. 4.2)
some 10,000 ha of sugarcane are grown under irrigation. Apart from this, use of
the Kafue River water for farming on a commercial basis is confined to some
small-scale private estates in the same area.
97
Among the larger herbivores, by far the most important inhabitant of the
Kafue Flats in terms of numbers of individuals, however, is the Kafue lechwe
(Kobus leche kafuensis) (see Figs. 4.3a and b). This antelope, which is endemic to
the Kafue Flats, lives a semi-aquatic way of life. Its special hoof structure
enables it to walk on very soft and sticky clay soils during flooding and allows
it to graze the emergent vegetation in the shallows, up to 50 cm deep water.
Fig. 4.3a Red Lechwe, pelican (pink back), wood ibis and spoonbills along Kafue Flats in
1970. Photo credit: Donald Stewart
Fig. 4.3b Red Lechwe buck in April 1970 Photo credit: University of Michigan Fisheries
Research Team
98
Lechwe spend most of their time on the floodplain (see Bell et al. 1973, Handlos
et al. 1976, Howard et al. 1988, Howard and Sidorowicz 1976, Robinette and
Child 1964, and Sayer and van Lavieren 1975). During high flood, however, the
deep water forces the lechwe to leave the floodplain and almost completely strip
this area of plant cover.
Apart from lechwe, a number of other animals still present today at Lochinvar and Blue lagoon, must be mentioned. Zebra (Equus burchelli), the second
most abundant species at Lochinvar, may be found on the floodplain only when
the soils are dried out and hard. During the rainy season and the early dry
season these animals are largely confined to the termitaria grasslands. Wildebeest (Connochaetes taurinus), though much less numerous than zebra, shows
more or less the same seasonal migration pattern. Other large ungulates on the
flats and adjacent woodland areas at Lochinvar include buffalo (Syncerus
caffer), Oribi (Ourebia ourebi), reedbuck (Redunca arundinum), and kudu (Tragelaphus strepsiceros). See Ellenbroek (1987), Perera (1982), Sayer and van
Lavieren (1975), Sheppe and Osborne (1971), and Williams and Howard
(1977) for more background on mammals.
Larger carnivores such as lion (Panthera leo) and wild dog (Lycaon pictus)
occasionally visit the area. Spotted hyena (Crocuta crocuta), serval (Felis serval), and side-striped jackal (Canis adustis) are still permanent inhabitants. Two
interesting nocturnal mammals, still common at Lochinvar but rarely seen, are
the peculiar termite-feeding aardvark (Orycteropus afer) and the vegetariancreated porcupine (Hystrix spp.). Hippopotamus (Hippopotamus amphibius)
occurs in small herds in most parts of the Kafue Flats (Fig. 4.4) while sitatunga
(Tragelaphus spekei), a true aquatic ungulate, is confined to papyrus and reed
marshes, has been observed locally. At Lochinvar the activities of hippos hardly
produce any visible signs of utilization of the floodplain grasslands.
Fig. 4.4 Hippos in the Zambezi in April 1970. Photo credit: Donald Stewart
99
Every year the Kafue River floods the Kafue Flats to a depth of up to 5 m for
several months. The flats are 235 km long and up to 40 km wide. The life of the
flats is conditioned primarily by the alternating rainy and dry seasons and by
the floods. About 80 cm of rain falls from November to April. The Kafue rises
slowly during the rains, is highest in May, and falls during the latter part of the
dry season. Vegetation is composed primarily of grasses, especially Oryza
barthii (wild rice). The main vegetation zones include (1) the Main river; (2)
levees; (3) lagoons and depressions; (4) floodplain grassland; (5) water meadow;
and (6) the littoral zone. A Vetivera belt includes (7) lower termitaria zone; (8)
upper termitaria zone; and (9) transition zone (see Figs. 4.5a and b). Finally
there is the upland consisting of (10) Munga woodland and (11) Miombo
woodland (Ellenbroek 1987). Because of the abundant water the primary
productivity of the flats is much greater than surrounding woodlands as is
secondary productivity.
Every year there is an alternation of aquatic and terrestrial faunas. During
the floods fish move onto the flats from the Kafue River, and most spawning
takes place there. Terrestrial species are driven off, but as the floods recede they
reoccupy the floodplain and use what is by far the best grazing in the region.
Large mammals find shelter in tall stands of grass on the floodplain, small
mammals in the thick mat of vegetation that covers much of the ground or in
the deeply cracked soil.
There is a gradient to use of the floodplain; some species (hippopotamus,
otter) always stay near the water at low water, others (lechwe, zebra, wildebeest)
go for varying distances onto it, and more than half the animals (squirrel,
vervet, aardvark) go onto it little if at all. Failure to use the floodplain seems
to be due to the absence of suitable habitats or food, rather than exclusion by
100
Fig. 4.5b Flooded termitaria grassland near Chunga in April 1970. Photo credit: Donald
Stewart
the floods. The most abundant large mammal on the floodplain is the lechwe.
Several shrews and mice, especially Mastomys natalensis, are common on the
floodplain and breed there during the rains. During the floods they leave the
flood plain or take refuge on natural levees along the Kafue. Crocodile (Crocodylus nilotica) and monitor live near the waters edge and move in and out
with the floods like the hippopotamus. Some snakes are common on the flats,
but turtles and frogs are not. Terrapins are present in some areas. Although ants
and termites are abundant in the surrounding region, they are largely excluded
from the flats by the floods. An excellent source on the vegetation of the Kafue
Flats is Ellenbroek (1987) and for fauna, see Sheppe and Osborne (1971).
Of all the birds that use Kafue Flats, and are wetland dependent, the Wattled
Crane is one of the most significant and threatened species. The large river
basins like Kafue Flats are their preferred habitat in shallow wetlands with
minimal human disturbance. Their diet consists primarily of aquatic vegetation
such as Cyperus and Eleocharis spp. and water lilies (Nymphaea), but also
includes seeds, insects, and waste grain in drier habitats (Douthwaite 1974a).
The cranes are non-migratory but do irregular local movements in response to
water availability (Burke 1992).
101
primarily Tonga in the southeast and Ila in the northeast and west. They
practice a largely subsistence agriculture, with corn and other staple crops.
Much of the economic and social life centers on cattle. These tribes originally
practiced shifting agriculture, but increasing population and habitat deterioration have caused more people to be crowded on less land resulting in constant
use of the same land and subsequent deterioration of the soil.
The flats themselves are inhabited only by fishermen, who live in scattered
villages on the natural levees along the Kafue River (see Figs.. 4.6a, b and c).
The original inhabitants were Batwa, but when commercial fishing became
important in the 1950s people from the other fishing tribes moved onto the
flats and now seem to be replacing the Batwa. Fisherman on the Flats was
estimated at about 1,000 in 1964 (Pike and Corey 1965), many of them present
only at low water, the main fishing season. This is one of the most important
fisheries in Zambia (Chapman et al. 1971, Dudley and Sculley 1980, Lagler et al.
1971, Muyanga and Chipungu 1982). Fish are taken by gill net or seine, set from
dugout canoes and fiberglass boats. Most of the catch is sundried, bundled, and
102
sold to itinerant African traders who come out to the river during the dry season
in trucks or on bicycles.
In addition to fishing, the permanent residents grow small patches of corn,
vegetables, and tobacco for their own use, and many of them have cattle. High
floods cover even the highest levees and the residents may live in water for
several weeks.
After the flood recedes, tribesmen from wooded areas around the flats bring
tens of thousands of cattle to the river. Grazing on the uplands is poor at best
and almost worthless during the dry season, and most of the growth of the cattle
takes place during the few months when they are in the flats.
Most of the flats area was native reserve, but early in this century several
large areas were given to European settlers for ranching and some are still used
this way. There is a large agricultural research station at Mazabuka. East of
Mazabuka a small area of the floodplain has been diked and farmed, but the
heavy clay soil makes farming impractical.
Except for the extermination of game herds, use by man seems to have done
little to disturb the ecology of the flats according to Sheppe and Osborne (1971)
up until the hydroelectric dam development. Cattle may remove all of the
exposed vegetation in some areas, but it is replaced by an equally heavy growth
during the next rain and flood season. It has been suggested that sorghum
thickets may form where there were cattle pens during the years of commercial
ranching. Numbers of winter-thorn and perhaps other trees on the levees have
been cut to make dugouts and used for firewood, and the villages and their
gardens have changes in small areas of the levees. No new plants or animals
are known to have colonized the flats as a result of mans activities in 1971,
except perhaps the pied wagtail (Motacilla aquimp Dumont), which is said to
occur on the flats only around human habitation. Recently man has contributed to the invasion of Kariba weed (Salvinia molesta), which becomes
entrapped in fishing gear, and then the seed is transported to non-infested
areas (B. Kamweneshe).
103
104
105
1966. Its seven-volume report was published 2 years later (FAO 1968). As
expected the report viewed favorably the development of hydroelectric potential, but its recommendations led to modifications to the scheme on ecological
grounds (particularly in response to changes in the flooding regime). In the
meantime work had gone ahead on the engineering aspects and in April 1967
the Swedish engineering consultants engaged on the work SWECO presented
their report on the Stage I power station, followed by that on the gorge storage
reservoir in 1968 (SWECO 1967, 1968). The first stage of the Kafue Gorge
scheme commenced in 1967 and was completed in 1972.
At the Kafue Gorge the river descends approximately 600 m over a distance
of 25 km. To develop the hydroelectric potential of the site a three-phase scheme
was proposed:
Stage I: Construction of the first power station within the gorge utilizing the
upper 400 m head of water, and having an initial capacity of 600 MW.
Regulated flow for this stage was to be provided by the construction of the
shallow Kafue Gorge Reservoir, inundating the eastern edge of the flats.
Stage II: The addition of two additional generating units at the Kafue Gorge
(upper) Power Station to provide a total output of 900 MW. This required
improved water regulation, which would be possible with the construction
of the Itezhitezhi Dam, 250 km upstream, and above the flats section of
the river.
Stage III: Construction of the Kafue Gorge Lower Power Station is to
harness the remaining 200 m head of water to have a 450 MW capacity,
making a total installed generating capacity for the gorge of 1,350 MW. A
possible fourth stage involves the raising of the height of the Itezhitezhi
Dam and the installation of a small generator unit there.
Preliminary work started at the Kafue Gorge Station in 1967, and in October
1971 the first generating unit was commissioned. Completion had been planned
for 1970, but not until April 1972 were all four 150 KW units in operation. The
power station is located in a chamber cut out of solid rock some 500 m below the
ground to which water is conveyed from the dam in a 10 km tunnel. The dam
itself is an earth rock fill structure 50 km high and 375 m long. As can be seen
from these dimensions, it was contained in a very narrow valley and could be
quite easily increased in height.
The impoundment area, behind the dam, which covers an extensive area of
the eastern part of Kafue Flats, is shallow and so a slight increase in water depth
would result in a massive extension of the flooded area, and corresponding
enormous increase in evaporation. For this reason, the normal maximum
design level for the dam is 976 m. This will flood an area of 800 km, although
the maximum design level for the dam is 979.0 m, which would give a flood area
over three times as large; approximately 3,200 km, which is almost half the total
area of the flats. Such extensive flooding was viewed as unacceptable in view of
its effects on other activities in the flats but during the 3-year period 19731975
the reservoir level was raised to a temporary high level of 977.8 m to ensure
106
adequate water regulation during the period when the Itezhitezhi Dam was
being constructed.
Work on Stage II of the project began in 1972, for planned completion in
1978. At the Kafue Gorge the original four generating units were augmented by
two additional units, giving a station generating capacity of 900 MW. At
Itezhitezhi construction began in June 1973 and the dam was completed in
1977. Itezhitezhi Lake created by the dam covers an area of 370 km extending
30 km along the Kafue and its tributary the Musa River. Ninety per cent of the
area of the lake sits within Kafue National Park, and the natural hydrologic
regime was substantially modified by this development.
Water Regulation
The real problem or issue is not so much the construction of dams, but that of
water level regulation and its effect behind the dam at Kafue Gorge. The
seasonal pattern of rainfall over the Kafue Basin results in wide seasonal
discharge variations in the river from a low flow of 50 m/s to a high of 700 m/
s at the Kafue Gorge. In order to produce a more constant flow, both between
seasons and between wet and dry years, a reservoir is required to retain the peak
discharge, which can be released progressively when natural drainage levels
decline. It is most efficient, in an engineering sense, to have the reservoir at, or a
short distance upstream of, the power station. In the case of the Kafue, the
gorge reservoir immediately upstream of the power station is inadequate for
water regulation, for its volume is limited by unfavorable basin shape. It has a
maximum capacity of only 800 million m at the normal maximum water level
which would only ensure a firm power output of only 207 MW in dry years
which is below station capacity.
It was therefore necessary to locate the main storage reservoir at Itezhitezhi,
above the flats. This has a storage capacity of 4,950 million m. The location of
the main storage reservoir upstream of the flats, and some 250 km distant from
the power station that it serves, gives rise to the problems, which are causing
wide-ranging ecological concern.
The flats have marked annual flooding regimes, and vegetation, wildlife,
fish, and man are all adapted to this. The widespread flooding of the flats is not
desirable from the viewpoint of regulation for hydroelectric purpose as large
water losses occur by evaporation, and regulation at Itezhitezhi involves holding back part of the flood. Changes in the natural flooding regime are inevitable
and drastic. These changes involve the eastern and western parts of the flats
differently.
In the eastern part of the flats the effect of the Kafue Gorge dam, in general,
will be an increase in the amount of flooding (SWECO 1971). The maximum
reservoir level, especially in the entrance of the gorge, will be significantly higher
than natural flood levels. As the major function of the regulation is to ensure
107
adequate water supply at the gorge, during the drier parts of the year there will
be significantly more water in this part of the flats than under normal conditions. Water storage at the Kafue Gorge Reservoir will be much less efficient
than at Itezhitezhi on account of high evaporation and evapotranspiration
losses from aquatic vegetation, which abounds in shallow waters. Perennial
shallow water conditions would also encourage the growth of aquatic plants
such as papyrus, increasing further loss by transpiration, and causing trouble
with the penstock intakes of the dam. Water releases from Itezhitezhi will thus
not be increased until the level at Kafue Gorge Reservoir has been dropped
below its maximum, and as there is a substantial lag time in the passage of water
through the flats, considerable variation of water level in the eastern part of the
flats happens.
In the western part of the flats the situation is reversed (SWECO 1971) with a
reduction in either the amount or duration of flooding or both. In wet or even
normal years the amount of water spilled from the Itezhitezhi after filling the
dam is likely to be no less than the peak river flow under natural conditions.
However, the duration of this maximum discharge will be considerably reduced,
so that even normal levels of flooding are reached, they will be reached only
briefly. The main problem will be in dry years, when the flood peak does not fill
the reservoir and so there will be no spilling of peak discharge. Thus no flooding
will take place. This could have disastrous effects on the ecology and economy
of this part of the flats, and so to simulate natural conditions in these dry years a
freshet of 300 m/s is to be released over a 5-year period in March (the normal
period of peak discharge) to produce a partial flooding. Even with a freshet, it is
clear that in dry years there will be a very significant reduction in the amount of
flooding in the western part of the flats.
Vegetation
The floodplain vegetation, mostly consisting of grasses, depends on the annual
flooding cycle and has died out in the new bodies of permanent water, which in
places now support large submerged mats of aquatic vegetation. Lagarosiphon
ilicifolius and Potamogeton thumbergi have been identified from Chunga Lake.
Thickets of plants that require permanently moist soil are becoming established along the shore of new bodies of water. These plants include papyrus
108
(Cyperus papyrus), Kariba weed, and cattail (Typha domingensis), which were
formerly excluded by the dry soil that prevails during the low-water season
(Mumba 2003).
As had been expected, the elimination of floods on much of the flats has
reduced the productivity of the grasses there, though in 1983 it was not possible
to distinguish this affect from the affect of the drought. Food elimination has
also permitted the invasion of the floodplain by woody plants that formerly
were killed by the floods. The most common is Mimosa pigra, a tropical
American shrub that is now a pest in many tropical areas around the world.
Hibiscus diversifolius var. rivularis also occurs in place.
Affects on Fauna
Unidentified ants are now widespread in places where they formerly did not
occur (Sheppe and Osborne 1971). Surprisingly, termite mounds were not seen
on the former floodplain, although, before the dams were built, colonies were
sometimes temporarily established in sites that were not flooded during the
years of low floods.
It had been expected that the dams would benefit fisheries, but initially this
has not happened (Dudley and Scully 1980). Experimental sampling in the mid1970s showed reduced populations of several major fish species, although it is
not clear whether this is a long-term trend and, if so, whether it is caused by the
dams, overfishing, years of low rainfall, or other factors.
T. O. Osborne (in lit.), former Park Biologist at Lochinvar National Park,
believes that the altered flooding regime has adversely affected ungulates, cattle,
birds, and fish. Elimination from large areas of the former floodplain grasses
has reduced the populations of herbivores and their predators. The floodplain
fish were primarily herbivores, and populations of both fish and fish-eating
birds have been reduced. There are now many fewer of the formerly abundant
herbivorous snails, and the openbill storks (Anastomus lamelligerus) that fed on
them. A reduction in herbivorous insects has also led to there being now smaller
numbers of Jacanas and insect-eating birds.
Parts of the floodplain that once had only transient populations of rodents
and shrews now have presumably permanent populations in the thickets of
papyrus and other plants that have developed on perennially marsh grown
around new bodies of water. Specimens of the shrews Crocidura marquensis
and C. occidentalis and the rodents Praomys (mastomys) natalensis complex
and Dasymys incomtus were trapped in such habitats in 1983. One specimen of
the black or roof rat, Rattus rattus, which had not been previously recorded from
that part of Zambia, was trapped on the riverbank opposite a fishing village.
The only animal that has been carefully monitored is the lechwe, which was
described before. Rees (1978a,b) believes that the altered flooding-regime
threatens the lechwe by reducing its food supply, while Schuster (1980) suggests
109
that the altered regime may threaten the lechwe directly by interfering with its
reproductive behavior and hence lowering the birth rate.
Each species will be apt to respond to the changing flood regime differently,
depending on how the precise details of the regime relate to its own needs.
Concern has been raised on effects of nesting of species such as the yellow-billed
stork (Mycteria ibis) and other water birds of the Kafue Flats. Change in
flooding hydrology regime is a principal threat to the wattled cranes habitat
and reproduction. Douthwaite (1974) noted that the number of pairs attempting to nest on the Kafue Flats depended on the degree of flooding. After an
average flood (6.4 m), 40% of the pairs attempted to breed. After minimal flood
(5.0 m) only 3% of all pairs of all pairs bred. From 1971 to 1973 aerial surveys of
wattled cranes were conducted on the Kafue Flats, Busanga Plain, and Lakanga
Swamp (Douthwaite 1974). In 1987, 369 wattled cranes were counted in an
aerial survey of the Kafue Flats which projects to 2,500 birds for the entire area
(Burke 1992).
110
The other stress on wetland health for the region is the impact of copper
mining effluent containing heavy metals and resultant degradation of the Kafue
River ecosystem and in this case the sediment and biota of the Kafue Flats
wetlands (Mwase et al. 1998, Norrgren et al. 2000). Mining effluent has entered
the waterways of the copperbelt for the past 70 years (van der Heyden and New
2003), resulting in extensive environmental impacts detected as far downstream
as the Kafue Hook bridge, 700 km from the mining area (Backstrom and
Jonsson 1996). Several geo- and hydro-chemical studies have quantified the
impact of the mining industry on Kafue River chemistry. Kasonde (1990) and
Pattersson and Ingri (2001) have documented the increased concentration of
dissolved and suspended heavy metals in the Kafue River and the marked
accumulation of cobalt, copper, iron, and manganese within the river sediment.
Metal accumulation within the Kafue River ecosystem has been associated
with various toxicological impacts. The disappearance of hippopotamus (H.
amphibius) from the Kafue River in Chingola (van der Heyden and New 2003),
the proliferation of water hyacinth, and the bioaccumulation of heavy metals
within wildlife tissue have been associated with pollutants in the Kafue River
ecosystem (Sinkala et al. 1977; Syakalima et al. 2001).
Mwase et al. (1998) found elevated levels of copper in river sediments and
associated this with increased pathology of fish in Kite, Itezhitezhi, and Kafue
Town. Mwase et al. (1998) and Norrgren et al. (1998, 2000) demonstrated
increased fish mortality and decreased aquatic productivity following exposure
of caged fish eggs and fry to Kafue River water and sediment from the mining
activity.
The other impact from mining effluent is metal concentrations in wetland
plants, which affect plant function and productivity (van der Heyden and New
2003). Some aquatic plants are less tolerant, but both Typha spp. and Cyperus
spp. are more tolerant and this leads to homogeneity in wetland vegetation
composition. Sources report that over 99% of the wetland vegetation at New
Dam, Zambia, is composed of Typha spp. and Cyperus spp.
111
studied both before and after construction of the dams. In the 1960s an FAO
team produced a multiple volume report on the resources of the area (FAO
1968). The all-important hydrology of the flats was studied by the FAO team
and more recently by a Dutch team (DHV Consulting Engineers 1980). Soils
and agriculture were studied by FAO.
FAO (1968), Douthwaite and Lavieren (1977), and Ellenbroek (1987) have
described the vegetation. The fish and fisheries have been studied by Chapman
et al. (1971), Lagler et al. (1971), Dudley and Scully (1980), and Muyanga and
Chipungu (1982), among others. Several workers have studied bird populations
(Osborne 1973, Douthwaite 1974a,b, 1982).
There have been numerous studies of lechwe, including those by Robinette
and Child (1964), Bell et al. (1973), Sayer and Lavieren (1975), Handlos et al.
(1976), Schuster (1980), Rees (1978a,b), and Howard and Jeffrey (1981, 1983).
Other mammals have received less attention (Sheppe and Osborne 1971, Sheppe
1972, 1973).
The University of Zambia has had an active interest in the area since the
1960s and its Kafue Basin Research Project (KBRP) continues to study some
aspects of the ecology and human use of the flats, including an annual aerial
census of lechwe populations. KBRP has also sponsored several conferences
and publications on the area (Williams and Howard 1977; Howard and Williams 1982).
Despite all this academic activity, there has been very little activist or NGO
activity until just recently. As Sheppe (1985) puts it Our understanding of the
basin is still inadequate for satisfactory protection and management of its
resource and second, what we do know has little effect on policy decisions.
The construction of the power project was approved without regard to its
probable environmental effects, and its design and operation have been based
almost entirely on a desire to produce the greatest possible amount of power
without regard to other interests.
In 1983, during regional discussions concerning a wetlands program for
southern African states belonging to the Southern African Development Coordination Conference (SADCC) it was suggested that wetlands management be
integrated with community development. This was the first formal recognition
of the strategic significance of Zambias wetlands and the dependence of their
conservation on the socio-economic well-being of resident communities. This
initiative was further developed by the government of Zambia as part of a joint
WWF/IUCN Wetlands Program. This program culminated in a consultative
workshop, which was held in 1986 for representatives of local communities
from two of Zambias largest wetlands, government and party political officials,
technical experts, and other concerned organizations and individuals.
It was against this background that the WWF-Zambia Wetlands project was
established with WWF-I support in 1986. The projects aims are appropriate to
government policy as specified in the National Conservation Strategy for
Zambia adopted in 1985. The project grew out of concern that conventional
management of Zambias wetlands was failing to coordinate development and
112
113
114
115
eventually become self-sufficient from local revenues and expansion of indigenous economic activity.
The vast growth of human and cattle populations required much land for
settlement and grazing. By 1990, human population in the region had grown
from 96,000 to 946,000 while the cattle population had expanded to more
than 250,000. A sharp land use conflict resulted, which required the
116
establishment of a commission of inquiry in a land matters dispute in southern province in 1982 (GRZ 1982).
The location and expansion of the Nakamba sugar estate affected cattle
movements into the Kafue Flats in the Mwanachingwala and Sionjalika
communities.
The construction of the hydroelectric dam (previously covered) Itezhitezhi
caused serious concern as people in the area relied on regular flood patterns
for improving the quality of the ranges used by their cattle.
These years had very little rainfall. Areas such as Choma and Kafue recorded
mean rainfall of less than 800 mm (Tiffen and Mulele 1993).
Current population movements into the area follow the increase in fishing
and the improved market for fisheries products. While only Twa people fish in
the southern province, a large population of migrant fishermen have moved
into the area from western Luapula and northern provinces of the country.
They have established semi-permanent villages in the flood plane in the Luwato,
Nyimba, Wanki, and Namalyo areas.
All the above factors, especially the hydrologic alteration due to the dam
operation, have reduced flood levels, changed timing, and reduced duration of
water levels, in tern causing
117
118
The Integrated Water Resource Management Project is part of the Kafue pilot
project being implemented by the Ministry of Energy and Water Development
through the Water Resources Action Program (WRAP). It is hoped that such a
program will act as an example and catalyst for sustainable water resources
management in the whole region, notably the wider Zambezi River Basin.
So, we have a dynamic situation of a natural flood-driven system with
traditional fishing and cattle grazing that is suddenly transformed by two
large hydroelectric facilities. In-migration and resource use pressures are
further stressing both ecosystems and local populations traditional uses. The
current WWF partnership initiative seeks to
provide both socio-economic and biodiversity benefits for seemingly conflicting stakeholders;
develop model sites where ownership lies clearly with partners allowing
eventual phased withdrawal of WWF;
magnification using Kafue Flats as a model for integrated water management to extend throughout the Zambezi River Basin.
Acronyms
FAO: Forest and Agricultural
GMA: game management area
IUCN: International Union for the Conservation of Nature
KFP: Kafue National Park
NP: national parks
LNP: ochinver National Park
KBRP: Kafue Basin Research Project
MEWD: Ministry of Energy and Water Development
SADCC: Southern Africa Development Coordination Conference
SWECO: Swedish Engineering Company
WWF: World Wildlife Fund for Nature World Wildlife Fund
ZAMA: Zambian Wildlife Authority
ZESCO: Zambian Electricity Supply Company
References
Acreman, M. 1994. The role of artificial flooding in the integrated development of river basins
in Africa. In C. Kirby and W. R. White (eds.) Integrating River Basin Development,
pp. 3544. Chichester, UK: John Wiley and Sons.
References
119
Acreman, M. C. 1996. The IUCN Sahelian Floodplain Initiative, networking to build capacity to manage Sahelian floodplain resources sustainably. International Journal of Water
Resources Development, 12(4): 429436.
Backstrom, M. and B. Jonsson. 1996. A Sediment Study in the Kafue River, Zambia. Unpublished Masters Thesis, Lulea University of Technology, Lulea, 96 pp.
Bayley, D. B. 1995. Understanding large river systems: Floodplain ecosystems. Bioscience,
45(3): 153158.
Bayley, D. B. 2006. The flood pulse advantage and the restoration of river floodplain systems.
Regulated Rivers; Research and Management, 6(2): 7586.
Beilfuss, R. D. and B. R. Davies. 1999. Prescribed flooding and the rehabilitation of the
Zambezi Delta, Mozambique. In W. J. Streever, (ed.) An International Perspective on
Wetland Rehabilitation, pp. 143158. The Netherlands: Kluwer Academic Publishers.
Bell, R. H. V., J. J. Grimsdell, L. P. van Lavieren, and J. A. Sayer. 1973. Census of the Kafue
Lechwe by a modified method of areal stratified sampling. East African Wildlife Journal
11: 5575.
Brock, M. A. and K. H. Rodgers 1998. The regeneration potential of the seed bank of an
ephemeral floodplain in South Africa. Aquatic Ecology, 61(2): 123135.
Bruwer, C., C. Poultney, and Z. Nyathi. 1996. Community based hydrological management
of the Phongolo floodplain. In M. Acreman and G.E. Hollis (eds.) Water Management and
Wetlands in Sub-Saharan Africa, pp. 199212. Gland, Switzerland: IUCN/The World
Conservation Union.
Burke, A. 1992. The Cranes Status Survey and Conservation Action Plan, Wattled Crane
(Bugeranus carnunculatus). USGS, Northern Prairie Wildlife Research Ctr, 23 pp.
Chabwela, H. N. W. 1998. Case Study Zambia: Integrating Water Conservation and population Strategies on the Kafue Flats. In A. Sherbinin and V. Dompka (eds.) Water and
Population Dynamics: Case Studies and Policy Implications, Washington, DC: AAAS, and
http://www.aaas.org/international/ehn/waterpop/zambia.htm
Chapman, D. W., W. H. Miller, R. G. Dudley, and R. J. Scully. 1971. Ecology of the Fishes in
the Kafue River. Rome: FAO FI: SF/Zam 11: Tech. Rep. 2, 66 pp.
Chooye, P. M. and C. A. Drijver. 1995. Changing views on the development of the Kafue
Flats in Zambia. In H. Roggeri (ed.) Tropical Freshwater Wetlands, Dordrecht, Netherlands: Kluver Academic Publishers.
Douthwaite, R. J. 1974a. An endangered population of Wattled Cranes (Grus carunculatus).
Biological Conservation, 6(2): 134142.
Douthwaite, R. J. 1974b. The Ecology of the Ducks (Anatidae) on the Kafue Flats, Zambia.
Lusaka: Final Report to the Kafue Basin Research Committee, Univ. of Zambia, 103 pp.
(mimeograph.).
Douthwaite, R. J. 1982. Water birds: Their ecology and future on the Kafue Flats. In Howard
and Williams, 1982, pp. 137140.
Douthwaite, R. J., and L. P. van Lavieren. 1977. A Description of the Vegetation of Lochinvar
National Park Zambia. Nat. Coun. Sci. Res. Tech. Rpt. (Lusaka), 34, 66 pp.
Dudley, R. G. and R. J. Sculley. 1980. Changes in experimental gill net catches from the Kafue
Floodplain, Zambia, since construction of the Kafue Gorge Dam.
Dugan, P. J. 1988. The importance of rural communities in wetlands conservation and development. In D. D. D. Cook et al. (eds.) The Ecology and Management of Wetlands, Volume 1:
Management Use and Value of Wetlands, pp. 311. Portland Oregon: Timber Press.
Ellenbroek, G. A. 1987. Ecology and Productivity of an African Wetland System. Dordrecht/
Boston/Lancaster: Dr. W. Junk Pub. / Kluwer Acad. Pub. Group.
Evans, S. Y., K. Bradbrook, R. Braund, and G. Bergkamp. 2003. Assessment of the restoration potential of the Logone floodplain (Cameroon). Water and Environment Journal,
17(2): 123128.
FAO. 1968. Multipurpose Survey of the Kafue River Basin, Zambia, Rome: FAO/SF; 35 ZAM,
7 vols.
120
Gammelsrod, T. 1996. Effect of Zambezi River management of the prawn fishery of the
Sofala Bank. In M. C. Acreman and G. E. Hollis (eds.) Water Management and Wetlands
in Sub-Saharan Africa, pp. 119124. Gland, Switzerland: IUCN.
Giller, P. S. 2005. River restoration: seeking ecological standards. Journal of Applied Ecology
42(2): 201207.
GRZ (Government of the Republic of Zambia). 1982. A Report of the Commission of Inquiry
into Land Maters of Southern Province. Lusaka, Zambia.
Handlos, W. L. 1977. Aspects of Kafue Basin Ecology. In Williams and Howard, 1977,
pp. 2939.
Handlos, D. M., W. L. Handlos, and G.W. Howard. 1976. A study of the diet of the Kafue
Lechwe (Kobus leche) by analysis of rumen contents. In Proc. Fourth Regional Wildlife
Conf. East Central Africa (Dept. NP &WS, Lusaka, Zambia), pp. 197211.
Horowitz, M. M. 1994. The management of an African river basin: alternative scenarios for
environmentally sustainable economic development and poverty alleviation. In Koblenz
(ed.) Proceedings of the International UNESCO Symposium: Water Resources Planning in a
Changing World, pp. 7382. Karlsrue, Germany: International Hydrological Program of
the UNESCO/OHP National Committee of Germany.
Howard, G. W. 1977. National Parks in the Kafue Basin. In Williams and Howard, 1977,
pp. 4756.
Howard, G. W. and D. R. Aspinal. 1974. Aerial census of Shoebills, Saddlebilled Storks and
Wattled cranes at the Bangweulu Swamps and Kafue Flats, Zambia. Ostrich, 55:
207212.
Howard, G. W. and D. R. Aspinual. 1984. Aerial census of shoebills, saddle billed storks and
wattled cranes at the Bangweulu Swamps and Kafue Flats, Zambia. Ostrich, 53: 207212.
Howard, G. W. and R. C. V. Jeffrey. 1981. Present distribution of Lechwe on the Kafue Flats.
Black Lechwe No. 1 NS, pp. 1720.
Howard, G. W. and R. C. V. Jeffrey. 1983. Kafue Lechwe population status 19811983.
Chilangua: Report to the Director NPWS, mimeo.
Howard, G. W., R. C. V. Jeffrey, and J. J. R. Grimsdell. 1984. Census and population trends
of Black Lechwe in Zambia. African Journal Ecology 22: 175179.
Howard, G. W., R. C. V. Jeffrey, B. M. Kamweneshe, and C. M. Malambo. 1988. Black
Lechwe population Census, Bangweulu Swamps. Chilanga: Report to the Director NPWS
(mimeo.).
Howard, G. W. and J. A. Sidorowicz. 1976. Geographical variation of the Lechwe (Kobus
leche gray) in Zambia. Mammalia 40: 6977.
Howard, G. W. and G. J. Williams (eds.). 1982. Proceedings of the National Seminar on
Environment and Change: The Consequences of Hydroelectric Power Development on the
Utilization of the Kafue Flats. Lusaka: Kafue Basin Res. Com., Univ. of Zambia, Lusaka,
159 pp.
Jeffrey, R. C. V. 1990. A general appraisal of consumptive wildlife utilization in Zambia. In
M. Marchand and H. A. Udo de Haes (eds.) The Peoples Role in Wetland management:
Proceedings of the International Conference [Leiden, the Netherlands, June 58 1989], pp.
336338. Centre for Environmental Studies, Leiden University.
Jeffrey, R. C. V. and P. M. Chooye. 1990. The peoples role in wetland management; The
Zambian initiative. In M. Marchand and H. A. Udo de Haes (eds.) The Peoples Role
in Wetland management: Proceedings of the International Conference [Leiden, the
Netherlands, June 58 1989], pp. 8391. Centre for Environmental Studies, Leiden
University.
Junk, W. J., P. B. Bayley, and R. Sparks. 1989. The flood pulse concept in river-floodplain
systems. In D. P. Dodge (ed.) Proceedings of the Large River Symposium, pp. 110127.
Canadian Special publications in Fish and Aquatic Science, volume 106.
Kasonde, J. 1990. Environmental Pollution Studies on the Copperbelt in the Kafue Basin.
Lusaka: National Council of Scientific Research WRRU/ERL/TR.
References
121
Lagler, K. F., J. M. Kaptezki, and D. J. Stewart. 1971. The Fisheries of the Kafue River Flats,
Zambia in Relation to the Kafue Gorge Dam. Rome: FAO FI: SF/Zam 11: Tech. Rpt., 1,
161 pp.
Le Maitre, D. C., B. W. van Wilgen, C. M. Gelderblom, C. Bailey, R. A. Chapman, and J. A.
Nel. 2002. Invasive alien trees and water resources in South Africa: case studies of the costs
and benefits of management. Forest Ecology and Management, 160(13): 143159.
Lehmann, D. A. 1977. The Twa: People of the Kafue Flats. In Williams and Howard, 1977
(qv), pp. 4146
Mathooko, J. M. and S. T. Kariuki 2000. Disturbances and species distribution of the riparian
vegetation of a Rift Valley stream. African Journal of Ecology, 38(2): 123129.
Mouafo, D., E. Fotsing, D. Sighomnou, and L. Sigha. 2002. Dam, environment and regional
development: Case study of the Logone floodplain in Northern Cameroon. International
Journal of Water Resources Development, 18(1): 209211.
Mumba. M. 2003. Vegetation and hydrological changes in the Kafue Flats Zambia associated
with the construction of the Itezhitezhi and Kafue Gorge Dams. Geophysical Research
Abstracts, 5: 14074.
Muyanga, E. D. and P. M. Chipungu. 1982. A short review of the Kafue Flats fishery from
1968 to 1978. In Howard and Williams, 1982, pp. 105113.
Mwase, M., T. Viktor, and L. Norrgren. 1998. Effects on tropical fish of soil sediments from
Kafue River, Zambia. Bulletin of Environmental Contamination and Toxicology, 61(1):
96101.
Norrgren, L., B. Brunstrom, M. Engwall, and M. Mwase. 1998. Biological impact of lipophilic sediment extracts from the Kafue River Zambia, in microinjected rainbow trout
yolk-sac fry and chick embryo livers exposed in vitro. Aquatic Ecosystem Health and
Management, 1: 9199.
Norrgren, L., U. Petersson, S. Orn, and P.-A. Bergqvist. 2000. Environmental monitoring of
the Kafue River located in the Copperbelt, Zambia. Archives of Environmental Contamination and Toxicology, 38(3): 334341.
Nelson, R. W., R. S. Ambasht, C. Ameros, G. W. Begg, A. A. Begg, A. A. Bonetto, I. R. Wais,
E. Dister, E. Wenger, C. M. Finlayson, J. K. Handoo, A. K. Pandst, K. M. Mauuti, D.
Parish, and D. Savey. 1989. River floodplain and delta management team: A project of the
Worlds Wetland Project. In J. A. Kusler and S. Daley (eds.) Wetlands and River Corridor
Management, pp. 7582, Berne, NY: Association of Wetland Managers.
Osborne, T. O. 1973. Additional notes on the birds of the Kafue Flats. Puku, 7: 163166.
Perera, N. P. 1982. Ecological considerations in the management of wetlands of Zambia. In B.
Gophal, R. E. Turner, R. G. Wetzel, and D. F. Whigham (eds.) Wetlands Ecology and
Management, pp. 2130. New Delhi: National Institute of Ecology and International
Scientific Publishers.
Pettersson, U. T. and J. Ingri. 2001. The geochemistry of Co and Cu in the Kafue River as it
drains the Copperbelt mining area, Zambia. Chemical Geology, 177: 399414.
Pike, E. G. R. and T. G. Corey. 1965. The Fisheries of Zambia, the Kafue floodplain. In M. A.
E. Mortimer (ed.) The Fish and Fisheries of Zambia, pp. 7684. Lusaka: Ministry of Lands
and Natural Resources.
RAMSAR. 2002. A Directory of Wetlands of International Importance: Zambia. Wetlands
International and RAMSAR, A Web document found at http://www.wetlands.org/RBB/
Ramsar_Dir/Zambia/zm001D02.htm
Rees, W. A. 1978a. The ecology of the Kafue Lechwe: The food supply. Journal of Applied
Ecology, 15: 177191.
Rees. W. A. 1978b. The ecology of the Kafue Lechwe: Soils, water levels and vegetation.
Journal of Applied Ecology, 15: 163176.
Rees, W. A. 1978c. Do the dams spell disaster for the Kafue Lechwe? Oryx, 14: 231235.
Robinette, W. L. and G. F. T. Child. 1964. Notes on the biology of the Lechwe (Kobus leche).
Puku, 2: 84117.
122
Sayer, J. A. and L. P. van Lavieren. 1975. The ecology of the Kafue Lechwe populations in
Zambia before the operation of hydroelectric dams in the Kafue River. East African
Wildlife Journal, 13: 938.
Schelle, P. and J. Pittock. 2005. Restoring the Kafue Flats; A Partnership approach to environmental flows in Zambia. Godalming, UK: Dams Initiative, Global Freshwater program,
WWF International, 10 pp.
Scholte, P., P. Kirda, S. Adam, and B. Kadiri. 2000. Floodplain rehabilitation in North
Cameroon: Impact on vegetation dynamics. Applied Vegetation Science, 3(1): 3342.
Schuster, R. H. 1980. Will the Kafue Lechwe survive the Kafue dams? Oryx, 15: 476489.
Scudder, T. 1989. River basin projects in Africa. Environment 31(2): 49, 2732.
Scudder, T. and M. C. Acreman. 1996. Water management for the conservation of the Kafue
Flats, Zambia and the practicalities of artificial releases. In M. C. Acreman and G. E.
Hollis (eds.) Water Management and Wetlands in Sub-Saharan Africa, pp. 101106. Gland,
Switzerland: IUCN.
Seyam, I. M., A. Y. Hoekstra, G. S. Ngabirano, and H. H. G. Savenije. 2001. The Value of
Freshwater Wetlands in the Zambezi Basin. Globalization and Water Resources Management: The Changing Value of water, AWRA/IWLRI University of Dundee International
Specialty Conference, 10 pp.
Sheppe, W. A. 1972. The annual cycle of small mammal populations in a Zambian floodplain.
Journal of Mammalia 53(1): 445460.
Sheppe, W. A. 1973. Notes on Zambian rodents and shrews. Puku, 7: 176190.
Sheppe, W. A. 1985. Effects of human activities on Zambias Kafue Flats ecosystem. Environmental Conservation, 12(1): 4957.
Sheppe, W. A. and T. O. Osborne. 1971. Patterns of use of a floodplain by Zambian
mammals. Ecological Monograph, 41(3): 179205.
Sinkala, T. et al. 1977. Control of Aquatic Weeds in the Kafue River Phase 1: Environmental
Impact Assessment of the Kafue River basin between Itezhitezhi Dam and the Kafue Gorge.
Lusaka: Ministry of the Environment and Natural Resources, Gov. of the Republic of
Zambia.
Standford, J. A., J. V. Ward, W. L. Liss, C. A. Frisnell, R. N. Williams J. A. Lichatowich, and
C. C. Cotant. 1996. A general protocol for restoration of regulated rivers. Regulated
Rivers, 12: 391413.
Subramanian, S. P. 1986. A brief review of the Bangweulu Basin and Kafue Flats. Proceedings
of the WWF-Zambia Wetlands Project Workshop. Lusaka.
SWECO. 1967. Kafue Gorge Hydroelectric Power Project. Lusaka.
SWECO. 1968. Kafue River Regulation: Project on the Main Storage Reservoir. Lusaka, 2 vols.
SWECO. 1969. Kafue River Regulation: Water Management Stage I. Lusaka.
SWECO. 1971. Kafue River Hydroelectric Power Development Stage III Itezhitezhi Reservoir
and Extension of Kafue Gorge Upper Power Station Preliminary Study. Lusaka, 3 vols.
Syakalima, M. S. et al. 2001. Bioaccumulation of lead in wildlife dependent on the contaminated environment of the Kafue Flats. Bulletin Environmental Contamination and Toxicology, 67(3): 438445.
Thomas, D. H. L. 1999. Adapting to dams: agrarian change downstream of the Tiga Dam,
Northern Nigeria. World Development, 27(6): 919935.
Tiffen, M. and M. S. Mulele. 1993. Environmental Impact of the 1991-2 Drought on Zambia.
Zambia Country Office, Lusaka: IUCN.
Tockner, K. and J. A. Stanford 2002. Riverine floodplains; present state and future trends.
Environmental Conservation, 29: 308330.
Van der Heyden, C. and M. New. 2003. Natural wetland for mine effluent remediation? The
case of the Copperbelt. School of Geography and the Environment, Oxford University
UK, 24 pp.
Ward, J. V. and J. A. Stanford. 2006. Ecological connectivity in alluvial river ecosystems and its
disruption by flow regulation. Regulated Rivers, Research and Management, 11(1): 105119.
References
123
Welcomme, R. L. 1995. Relationships between fisheries and the integrity of river systems.
Regulated Rivers, 11(1): 121136.
Wesseling, J. W., E. Naah, C. A. Drijver and D. Ngantou. 1996. Rehabilitation of Logone
floodplain, Cameroon, through hydrological management. In M. C. Acreman and G. E.
Hollis (eds.) Water Management and Wetlands in Sub-Saharan Africa, pp. 158198. Gland,
Switzerland: IUCN.
Williams, G. J. 1977. The Kafue hydroelectric scheme and its environmental setting. In
Williams and Howard, 1977, pp. 1326.
Williams, G. J. and G. W. Howard. 1977. Development and Ecology in the Lower Kafue Basin
in the Nineteen Seventies; Papers from the Kafue Basin Research Committee of the
University of Zambia, Lusaka.
WWF. 2001. Investing in the Kafue Flats Wetlands to ensure clean water and wildlife for later
years. WWF document found at http://www.partnersforwetlands.org/report/report-zmbiasept.2001.html
WWF, KafueFlats, http://www.panda.org/about_wwf/where_we_work/africa/where/zam
bia/kafue
Chapter 5
125
126
of such wetlands to absorb heavy metals and other pollutants (Prain et al. 2006,
Vymazel 2005) or pass them on to wildlife (Fasela 2002). There are also issues of
hosting vectors for disease such as mosquitoes during wetland maintenance or
reconstruction or even the perception of this threat (Smardon 1989, Zedler and
Leach 1998). Other issues include suitability of altered urban wetlands to
support migratory waterfowl populations and compatibility with human pollutions visitation of such populations (Antos et al. 2007, Zedler and Leach 1998).
In some cases reconstructed urban wetlands have evolved to elaborate wetland
parks complete with structures and interpretation facilities such as in Hong
Kong and Taipei, Taiwan.
The overriding issue is examining the compatibility of multiple environmental services by urban wetlands (Emerton 2005, Zedler and Leach 1998) plus the
connection to local livelihoods (FAO 2003, Ratner et al. 2004) in the face of
overwhelming pressure for land use conversion.
Fig. 5.1a Location of east Kolkata wetlands. Drawn by Samuel Gordon and adapted from
wwfindia at http://www.wwfindia.org/calcutta_29php?fileid=29
127
Fig. 5.1b East Kolkata wetlands layout and use. Drawn by Samuel Gordon and adapted from
D. Ghosh, 1998
Fig. 5.2 East Kolkata wetlands view of treatment lagoons. Source: D. Ghosh, 1998, p. 1
products obtained from plant resources. These resources include Typha elephantia and Typha domenginsis (hugla or cattail), Aeschynomene aspera (shoal),
Cyperus pangorei and Cyperus corymbosus (madurlathi or sedges), Trapa natans
var. bispinosa (paniphal), and Euryale ferox (makhona) (see Table 5.1). In
addition, several wetland plants have all been harvested by rural villagers as
supplemental vegetables and medicinal plants. Kalmi (Ipomoea aquatica) and
Kachu (Celccasu esculenta) are the most prominent (Ghosh 2004).
128
Hugla/cattail
Typha elephantia
Typha domenginsis
Holga gunri
Shola
Aeschynomene
aspera
Madurlathi/sedges
Cyperus pangorei
Cyperus corymbosus
Makana/fox nut
Euryale ferox
Mats
Thatching/roofs
Paper/decoration
Sweets
Hats
Shola art/ornamental
products
Mats
painting/printing
Rs. 100,000/ha/year
2.273 USD/year
Fruits/seeds
Edible puff
Fried seeds
INR 16,000/ha
INR 107.400/ha
USD 2,330
Paniphal/water
Edible fruit
chestnut
Ponds/pits
Trapa natans var.
bispinosa
Medinipar
Lotus
Flowers
Nelumbo nucifera
1
Data obtained from Ghosh 2004.
2
INR Indian National Rupee 1 USD 45 Indian Rupees.
Rs. 5,000/ha/year
Rs. 9,000/ha/year
2530 INR2/kg
Rs. 40.000/ha
INR 26,000
36,000/ha/season
Rs. 2,000 3,600/
season
129
tanks of varying sizes lying between the latitudes 22, 310 2300 22, 330 3000 north
and longitude 88, 270 2000 88, 280 5400 east, about 3 m above the sea level and
covers a total area of 80 ha in area with 60 ha of water bodies and 20 ha of
uplands and dike area. The landscape elements include approximately 70% fish
ponds (less than 115 ha), 10% dike or embankment, 7% slum or squatter
settlements, 5% sewage treatment ponds/channel, 4% deer park and garden,
and the remaining 4% of land area is comprised of rail lines, solid waste fallows,
and office establishment. According to Ramsar guidelines for classification of
wetlands, BBNP is at present man-made, sewage-fed aquaculture fishponds.
Today the wetlands of east Kolkata encompass about 20,000 acres containing vegetable farms, rice paddies, and fish farms (see Figs. 5.3, 5.4, and 5.5).
Fig. 5.3 Nature park and treatment lagoons. Source: DFID, 2001, p. 2
Currently, only about one-third of the citys sewage water actually flows
through the marshes. The Kolkata Municipal Corporation constructed two
channels approximately 33 km long, one for the storm runoff during the
monsoon season and the other for sewage outfall after primary treatment at
Beutala in two sedimentation tanks. These tanks, however, have not worked in
a decade so there is untreated sewage from the city being released directly to the
dry flow channel. As sewage increased from the city, the storm flow channel has
also been put to use for sewage outfall year-round (Patnik 1990). These channels take all but approximately one-third (utilized by the sewage farms and
fisheries) of the sewage outfall to the Kulti Gong River. The water from the
channel is released into the Kulti Gong through a lock-type system, which
attempts to keep the backflow from the river out during that part of the day
when the river water level is higher than the canals water level. The sewage for
the fisheries and agriculture has been removed through a provision in the outfall
130
Fig. 5.5a Early morning fishing in the east Kolkata wetlands. Source: D. Ghosh, 1998, p. 3
drainage scheme to raise an adequate water head and to supply sewage to most
of the fish ponds by gravity (D. Ghosh 1990). So the east Kolkata marshes
have gradually evolved into 12,000 ha for vegetable farms, wastewater-fed
ponds, or Bheris and rice paddy cultivation.
131
Fig. 5.5b Early morning fishing in the east Kolkata wetlands: close up. Source: D. Ghosh,
1998, p. 3
132
formed with the assistance and guidance of one land manager of CPT and one
deputy director of the Department of Fisheries, Government of West Bengal.
The members of MFCS also gained the support of the CPT to launch
conversion of the wetlands into an urban fishery-cum-recreational ecosystem.
MFCS initiated eco-development activities under the guidance of the chief
executive officer appointed by the Department of Fisheries, Government of
West Bengal. In the process, in 1985, the MFCS established the water area and
the surrounding embankment as an ecological park and subsequently developed the renamed area as a nature park in 1991 as a conservation measure.
The MFCS organization is the product of a long and determined struggle by
a group of fishermen led by seven members who had immigrated to the wasteland near the Kolkata dock area (Metiaburj) in search of contract jobs around
1942 when the Damodar River had dried up (Dutta and Rapoor 1992). The
foundation of this CBO was started with 53 fishermen depositing 25 paisa per
member per day and at present there were 100 members with voting rights, 176
nominal members, and 150 casual laborers associated with the Mudialy Fishermans Cooperative Society (Ghosh 1993a). So, a total of about 400 fishermen
families are associated with the organization and the society. From 1961
onward the society grew tremendously in terms of membership, nature conservation activities, prevention of pollution, and supply of fresh fish to the
Kolkata markets.
133
along with the filling up of the southern part of the swamp with solid
waste.
Cutting of native flora like Aeschynomene indica, Sesbania cannabina, gradually changing the ecological condition of the wetland.
Introduction of exotic flora including Acacia auricularis and subabul, Leucaena macrophylla.
Greening of the dike area with Acacia indica, Aegle marmelos, Azadirachta
indica, Carica papaya, Emblica officinalis, Zizyphus mauritiana.
Undertaking plantation program pertaining to leguminous, dust absorbing,
bird attracting, and horticultural plants.
Gradual predominance of phytoplankton communities belonging to Chlorophyceae and Cyanophyceae in the fishponds.
134
(iii) Reeds
(iv) Sedge
135
136
4. Fruit plants
5. Wild plants
6. Exotic plants
treating about 25 million liters of sewage daily and protecting the River
Hugli from being polluted;
providing a green patch in this industrial area through planting more than
100,000 saplings;
Present Activities
The MFCS primary activity is pisciculture (fish culture) (see Fig. 5.5a and
5.5b). The basic layout and landscape mapping were done by Ghosh and Sen
(1992) in 1988. Tanks or ponds were serially organized to act as facultative,
maturation, and polishing tanks. Fish are grown in maturation and polishing
tanks only. The water sources are domestic wastewater and urban runoff. The
fisheries function as multiple-pond wastewater aquaculture systems. Studies
on physicalchemical characteristics of the wastewater entering and leaving
the wastewater entering and leaving the wetland system and the performance
of the wetlands treating wastewater were carried out by the National Environmental Engineering Research Institute (NEERI 1990) in Kolkata at the
behest of the CPT.
Besides fish culture, the MFCS also has a plantation program under
which a nursery has been set up for different varieties of plants. Species
137
are generally selected on the basis of their utility. They are fruit-bearing
trees, flowering plants, trees providing dense foliage, plants acting as
bioindicators of air pollution and those varieties which survive in urban
and industrial areas and also help in mitigating atmospheric pollution.
From 1985 to 1989 about 96,000 saplings were planted, of which 59,000
(60%) have survived. The society aimed to grow 2,000,000 saplings by
the year 1989/1990. The fishery area, when interspersed with trees
attracts many birds. A total of 120 species of birds from 35 families
have been identified (Chattopadhyay 1985).
Another objective of the MFCS is to build the fishery and the adjoining area
as an amusement center or a waterfront recreation center, especially for children. A deer enclosure with 22 (in 1996) spotted deer (Axis axis) has already
been built. Other recreational facilities and facilities for environmental education are also being contemplated including raising ducks that also fertilize the
fish ponds.
During 1987/1988, the NFCS earned about 1,897,000 rupees (USD 99,842).
Total investment was about 2,529,000 rupees (USD 133,105) comprising the
cost of fish seed (42%), wages and incentives given to other workers (53%), and
other input costs (5%). The total sales turnover was 4,426,000 rupees (USD
232,947) of which 3,500,000 rupees (USD 184,210) was from the sale of fish.
From 1987/1988 to 1988/1989, production increased from 3.91 tones/ha to
about 4 tons/ha. During 1989/1990 production was about 5.61 tons/ha. In
1978/1988 the costs of labor for routine fishery activities accounted for about
54% of the total investment. In 1989/1990, this went down to about 26% while
renovation costs accounted for about 9% of the total investment.
In addition to the members, the society also provides occasional employment
to the local people. The members of the MFCS obtain a daily wage ranging from
28 rupees (USD 1.47) to 55 rupees (USD 2.89) depending on the nature of the
work. In 1987/1988 about 87,000 man-days were created. Besides the daily wages,
the MFCS encourages and ensures savings by the members and also provides
financial assistance in the form of aid, loans, and pensions to its members.
The entire activity of the MFCS depends on its own resources and no
financial assistance is sought from the outside. The establishment of the
MFCS originated from individual contributions of 0.25 rupees (USD 0.013)
per day for 50 members and their personal labor. The society received effective
leadership from the executive officer, appointed by the Department of Fisheries, who continues to act as a facilitator to the members of the MFCS in the
present phase of its activities.
The following tables describe the three major activities of vegetable farming,
wastewater-fed ponds, and rice paddy cultivation. It should be known that the
wastewater-fed ponds and fishery activity started first and this was followed by
the use of wastewater for vegetable farming and rice paddy cultivation.
So Tables 5.4 and 5.5 describe most of the ongoing production activity as
well as the usage of sewage effluent as part of the production process. All is not
well as there are constant threats to these very productive processes.
138
150 tons of
vegetables
per annum
8,000 tons/
annum
139
park, container repair yard, truck terminals, warehouses, water basin facilities,
and construction of a housing complex and a road (AWB and WWF 1993). The
CPT started distributing portions of the wetland area back to the dock authorities and initiated disposal of solid waste and city garbage at the wetland site
through Calcutta Municipal Corporation (CMC) up to 1989 (Ghosh and Sen
1992). Though solid waste activity has been stopped, the CPT has been increasing
rent regularly. The rent paid by MFCS to CPT has undergone a 15% rise in 1988.
In November 1990, the lease to MFCS was extended to 3 years with the condition
of a 25% rent increase each year. The society (MFCS) requested consideration of
these terms and asked for a long-term lease with more rational rent. The CPT did
not accept the appeal and issued an order on July 15, 1992 to vacate the area by
July 23, 1992. The Fisheries Department of the Government of West Bengal
strongly reacted to this approach and requested the chairman of CPT to hand
over the park area to the Government of West Bengal (Ghosh 1993a), This
dispute has been referred to the courts since 1992. Now solid waste is utilized as
part of the vegetable growing process as described in the previous section.
Mention should be made here that the existing laws are the (i) West Bengal
Fisheries (Acquisition and Requisition Act and (ii) the Town and Country
Planning Act which stipulates that no pond measuring five cottahs (0.03 ha)
or more can be filled up. The West Bengal Inland Fisheries Act (1984) stipulates
that the management of embankments is obligatory for the proper utilization of
fishponds. But, to date, the existing laws are not strictly enforced. There is every
reason to protect and preserve this unique ecosystem, which can serve as a
model for low-cost options for municipal sanitation in the poorer parts of the
world (Ghosh 1993a). Furthermore, the traditional rights of fishing have been
observed since 1958, which is a prevalent practice in the region, and is an
important regulatory factor in legislation and management options.
The water bodies of BBNP receive raw wastewater from the adjoining
152 industrial units (see Table 5.6), which are also imposing considerable
threat to these wetlands. The conflict between the landowner and the
leaseholder is the major constraint impeding the progress and productivity
of park activities. The disposal of raw waste instead of treated waste is an
Table 5.6 Adjoining industrial units and waste flows to park
Number of
Wastewater flow (approx.
Sl. No.
Type of industry
industries
m3/day)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Engineering
industries
Chemical
industries
Godowns/garages
Institutions
Miscellaneous
industries
Totals
Source: Deb et al. (1996).
65
1728.6
26
15,489.6
42
4
15
1505.6
2015.6
1050.6
152
21790.0
140
important risk factor toward toxic pollutant hazard/health hazard for the
fish eaters of West Bengal. There are also other limitations and threats like
the flow of funds, grazing by pigs, washing, bathing, defecation, etc., as
shown in the utilization of BBNP (see Table 5.7).
Table 5.7 Utilization scenario of BBNP, Kolkata
Usage categories
A. Wetland/water usage
1. Fisheries including nursery pond
2. Source of employment/economic support
3. Recreational boating
4. Fresh water fish supply to Calcutta market
5. Reservoir of water for
a. sewage water receptacle*
b. waterfowl habitat biodiversity
c. bathing for slum dwellers*
d. washing for slum dwellers*
e. domestic water fro slum dwellers
f. fire fighting
g. irrigation for garden plants
6. Sewage disposal both industrial and domestic*
7. Water purification/pollution abatement for Ganges
8. Tourism/ecotourism
9. Conservation/eco-development/microclimate
10. Defecation and afterwash*
11. Retention of floodwater/waterlogging prevention
12. Piggery (for slum dwellers)*
13. Duckery (domestic)
14. Research/training/environmental management
15. Solid waste disposal (up to 1989)*
16. Grazing (by pigs, goats, etc.)
Utilization status1
VH
VH
H
H
VH
H
M
M
M
L
L
VH
VH
VH
H
H
H
H
L
H
H
H
141
Year of
Production
Table 5.8 Fish yield and earning from fish sale by MFCS
Area under fish
Total proYield/ha
Total earning
culture (ha)
duction (MT)
(MT)
(Rs. 00000)
19801981
40
65
19811982
40
74
19821983
43
79
19831984
45
87
19841985
45
97
19851986
45
85
19861987
60
229
19871988
60
235
19881989
65
260
19891990
50
288
Source: MFCS records (Dutta and Kapoor 1992).
1.6
1.8
1.9
1.9
2.2
1.9
3.75
3.92
4.20
5.6
8
10
12
13
12
13
34
35
39
50
142
143
144
Azadirachta indica, and Ficus religiosa), 30% fruit trees for attracting birds, and
10% horticultural plants to combat soil erosion and air pollution affects. Such a
vegetation program also helps in fishpond fertility due to biomaturing through leaf
litter decomposition of nitrogen-rich leguminous plants grown on dikes alongside
the water bodies. The green patch developed in this industrial southwestern sector
of congested Kolkata is a welcome relief of aesthetic importance to the urban
environment. Landscape management includes the maintenance of the dikes and
landscape beatification by cutting, trimming, and weeding of the uplands and
wetlands after the growing season (in the post-monsoon period, October) by the
MFCS. Birds attracting acidic trees such as Triphala are planted at a distance
from the water to avoid acidification from overfertilization of the fishponds.
Organizational Development
Based on sewage-fed wetlands owned by the CPT, the society (MFCS) has
developed an ingenious process based on eco-engineering principles to perform
three important functions:
145
scientific pisciculture;
deweeding and desilting of tanks or lagoons;
intensive fish culture;
scientific training for developing a balanced ecosystem;
preparing the members for undertaking future development work of the
society out of their own savings.
146
Rs. 160.045543.82
Rs. 3544.009551.74
Rs. 400/month/
member
Rs. 2000
Rs. 1000
Rs. 35, 000
Rs. 500
Full reimbursement
up to Class IV
Members or widow
Marriage grant
Members daughter
Funeral expense
Members death
Housing loan
Without interest
Consumption loan
One time
Janata Insurance Policy
Coverage of accident
Drainage/sanitation/drinking
Servicecharge paid by
water
MFCS
Source: MFCS records.
Note: Expenses relate to the years 19801981 to 19891990.
Expenses on charity ranged from Rs. 479.00 to Rs. 53,182.75 a year.
Expenses on sports reaches as high as Rs. 61,175.00 in 19891990.
National Film Festival award in 1992 for the documentary film Mudialy
Alternative on the activities of this organization in the Nature Park (BBNP)
being considered as the best film in the field of Environmental Conservation
and Preservation in 1992.
Best Fishermans Cooperative Society awards in 1993 from the State Cooperative Bank and State Cooperative Union.
Indira Priyadarshini Vrikshanitra (Friends of Trees) awards for Forestry in
1995 from the Government of India.
Several awards from various flower and vegetable shows organized in the
state of West Bengal.
147
movement surrounding the protection of BBNP, various public interest, environmental and peoples science groups have taken interest. The local state government
had taken note of plans of the Calcutta Trust (CPT) to reclaim the wetlands of
BBNP for real estate development.
The CPT, in a very sudden move, decided to take possession of the land and
water bodies on July 23, 1992. The state government intervened in favor of MFCS.
Section 144 was promulgated per order of the Alipore Court, Kolkata, and
stopped the CPT from developing the wetland area. The Fisheries Department,
Government of West Bengal had proposed to take hold of the wetlands from CPT,
but the CPT refused the request for transfer of the wetlands on August 4, 1992.
They secured a stay order against Section 144 from the High Court on August 7,
1992. Three days later the MCFS also got a stay order against any further action
from the same court on August 19, 1992 (Uttarpara Vigyan Sanstha et al. 1992).
Outside the court, various peoples science groups, environmental groups,
health movement groups like Nagrik Manch, the Scientific Workers forum, the
Vigyan Vikas, the Institute of Engineers, the Peoples Science Coordination
Center have jointly taken up the challenge to confront the CPT (Mukul 1992).
So far this matter has not been settled.
Recently, the Slim Group of Indonesia has proposed a new Kolkata International Development Project which includes expressways, bridges, special
economic zones, industrial hubs, plus wealth and knowledge centers. This
proposed 85 km expressway starts from Baraset and will pass along the northern edge (see Fig. 5.6) of the east Kolkata wetlands, even though an exact
148
alignment has not been chosen. But many are concerned about potential
impacts to this Ramsar wetland.
Summary
The urban wetlands in Kolkata have many features for waterfront recreation.
They also have lent themselves well to use by local communities. But besides
these functions the Brace Bridge Nature Park has various other important roles
to play in the municipal sanitation for purifying wastewater as well as in fisheries. The indigenous technology adopted to wastewater management by
MFCS, a community-based fisherman organization, efficiently utilizes the
algal species for performing the dual task of nutrient recovery and food chain
support for pisciculture seems to be a precedent for the future of sanitation
technology. In so doing, such a system could assume global significance as a
tutorial system (Bhagat 1993). Following this example, some developing
country communities could develop their apparently unproductive waterlogged
city fringes into uses for environmental protection, food production, and
employment generation.
In terms of success indicators such as application of modern environmental management principles, style of function, experience, socio-economic proximity, access to leadership to members, and building patronage
membership, the present CBO (MFCS) has made remarkable advances in
entrepreneurial function as professional managers of urban wetlands. The
organizational abilities of MFCS such as their honesty, hard work, and
dedication as well as their openness, willingness to learn through internalization of the scientific community and public interest groups, and
especially their attitude toward leadership via cooperative management
have all contributed to their remarkable success in wetland management
(Dutta and Rapoor 1992).
Managing urban wastes, both solid and sewage, is a complex problem. But
low-lying sewage-fed wetlands of Kolkata, such as the east Kolkata wetlands
(Ghosh 1993b) and BBNP (Nandh 1996) have a natural and environmentalfriendly system of municipal sanitation and atmospheric purification. Being
packed with actively photosynthesizing green plants, both macrophytic and
planktonic, have allowed these areas to be virtually inexhaustible reservoirs of
oxygen. Presently, these two urban and periurban wetland systems are threatened with reclamation for real estate development. However, with the growing interest in wetland conservation, the peoples movement reminiscent of the
Chipko kind have succeeded in affecting the stay order from the Kolkata
High Court over the proposed development plans for Kolkatas eastern wet
tract. The role of PUBLIC (People United for Better living in Kolkata), a
voluntary organization, to steer through such a stay order indicates that the
wetlands in the east of Kolkata can no longer be a natural or easy choice for
urban expansion.
Summary
149
150
Acronyms
BBNP: Brace Bridge Nature Park
CMC: Calcutta Municipal Corporation
CMPO: Calcutta Metropolitan Planning Organization
CPT: Calcutta Port Trust
DOE: Department of Environment
ECW: East Calcutta Wetlands
FFDA: Fish Farmers Development Agency
MFCS: Mudialy Fishermans Cooperative Society
NEERI: National Environmental Engineering Research Institute
PUBLIC: People United for Better Living in Calcutta
References
Antos, M. J., G. C. Ehmlee, C. L. Tzarios, and M. A. Weston. 2007. Unauthorized human use
of an urban coastal wetland sanctuary: Current and future patterns. Landscape and Urban
Planning, 80(12): 173183.
AWB and WWF. 1993. Directory of Indian Wetlands. Asian Wetland Bureau and World
Wildlife Fund for Nature, India, pp. 1252.
Bhagat, R. K. 1993. Uses of Calcuttas wetlands. Yojana, 36(24): 1719.
Chattopadhyay, K. 2001. Environmental Conservation and Valuation of East Calcutta Wetlands. Wetlands and Biodiversity EER Working Paper Series: WB-2 prepared for the
World Bank. Mumbai, India: Indira Gandhi Institute of Development Research,
Goregaon (East), 67pp.
Chattopadhyay, S. 1985. Ecological Reconnaissance of the Brace Bridge Swamp A proposed
bird sanctuary of Calcutta, Appendix II. Calcutta: Zoological Survey of India, pp. 18.
Costa-Pierce, B. A., A. Desbonnet, P. Edwards, and D. Baker. 2005. Urban Aquaculture,
CABI Publishing.
Das, K. K., A. K. Biswas, A. K. Ganguly, N. Chattopadhyay, S. H. Mollah, P. B. Sanyal, and
S.C. Deb. 1990. Recycle and reuse of industrial effluents for aquaculture a case study.
Proceedings of National Seminar on Utilization of Resources, India, pp. 7378.
Deb, S. C., K. K. Das, and S. C. Santra. 1994. Studies on the productivity of sewage fed pond
ecosystem. Proceedings of the Academy of Environmental Biology, 3(1): 3342.
Deb, S. C., J. S. Pandey, and S. C. Santra. 1996. A practical approach to water pollution
control through ecologically balanced wastewater management: A case study from
Calcutta, India. In S. R. Mishra (ed.) Assessment of Water Pollution, pp. 6379. Delhi:
APH Publishing Company.
Deb, S. C. and S. C. Santra. 1995. Plankton ecology of sewage fed aquatic ecosystem in
Calcutta. In R. C. Mohaznty (ed.) Environment, Change and Management, pp. 7889.
New Delhi: Kamal Raj Enterprise.
Dutta, S. and S. Rapoor. 1992. Collective Action, Leadership and Success in Agricultural
Cooperatives- A Study of Gujarat and West Bengal Draft report. Ahmedabad: Indian
Institute of Management, 368pp.
El Harake, M. 1998. The future of Calcutta sewage, Waste yes, want not. At http://darwin.
bio.uci.edu/sustain/suscoasts/melharake.html
Emerton, L. (ed.). 2005. Values and Rewards: Counting and Capturing Ecosystem Water
Services for Sustainable Development. Colombo: IUCN Water, Nature and Economics
Technical Paper No. 1, IUCN Ecosystems and Livelihoods Group Asia, 93pp.
References
151
Fasela, M. 2002. Coastal and inland wetlands in China and Pakistan: Colonial water birds as
bioindicators of pollutant levels and effects. Project report http://www.unipv.it/webbio/
labweb/ecoeto/cina/index.htm
FAO. 2003. Urban Forestry in Asia-Pacific Region status and prospects, Annex 2 Roles and
Importance of urban Trees and Forests. FAO Corporate Document Repository at http://
www.fao.org/decrep/003/x1577e/x1577E12.htm
Gerrad, P. 2004. Integrating Wetland Ecosystem Values into Urban Planning: The Case of That
Luang Marsh, Vientiane, Lao PDR. IUCN-The World Conservation Union, Asia Regional and Environmental Economics Programme and WWF Lao Country Office, Vietnam.
Ghosh, A. K. 1990. Biological resources of wetlands of East Calcutta, India. Journal of
Landscape and Ecological Studies, 13: 1023.
Ghosh, A. 1997. Management of East Calcutta Wetlands and Canal System, Dept. of Environment, Govt. of West Bengal assisted by the UK Overseas Development administration.
Ghosh, D. 1990. Wastewater fed aquaculture in the wetlands of Calcutta an overview. In
P. Edwards and R. S. V. Pullin (eds.) Wastewater Fed Aquaculture, pp. 5056. Bangkok,
Thailand: Environmental Sanitation Center, Asian Institute of Technology.
Ghosh, D. 1993a. Uncertainty over Mudialy Nature Park in CPT wetlands near Brace Bridge
Railway Station. Environment, 1: 45.
Ghosh, D. 1993b. Towards sustainable development of Calcutta wetlands, India. In
T. J. Davis (ed.) Towards Wise Use of Wetlands, pp. 107112. Gland, Switzerland:
Ramsar Convention Bureau.
Ghosh, D. 1998. The Calcutta wetlands, Turning bad into good. Ashoka Changemakers Journal (Oct. 1998) and http://www.changemakers.net/journal/98October/
ghosh.cfm
Ghosh, S. K. 2004. Traditional commercial practices in sustainable development and conservation of man and wetlands. Knowledgeable Marketplace Reports. Bangkok, Thailand:
The Third IUCN World Conservation Congress (1725 Nov. 2004).
Ghosh, D. and S. Sen. 1992. Developing waterlogged areas for urban fishery and a waterfront
recreation project. Ambio 21(2): 185186.
Ghosh, A. K. and S. Chattopadhyay. 1990. Biological Resources of Brace Bridge wetlands.
Indian Journal of Landscape System and Biological Studies, 13(2): 189207.
Ghosh, D. and S. Sen. 1992. Developing waterlogged areas for urban fishery and a waterfront
recreation project. Ambio, 21(2): 185186.
Guntenspergen, G. R. and C. Dunn. 1998. Introduction: long term ecological sustainability of
wetlands in urbanizing landscapes. Urban Ecosystems, 2(4): 187188.
Hart, T. H. F. 2006. An overview of water sensitive urban design practices in Australia. Water
Practice and Technology, 1(1): 18.
Irvine, K. N. 2007. The Role of Phnom Penhs Wetlands in Sustainably Treating Sewage
Discharges to the Mekong/Bassac River System. Final Report. Department of Geography
and Planning, SUNY Buffalo State College, 22pp.
Kada, 1991. Understanding the state of lake environment from a socio-cultural perspectivean example from Lake Biwa, Japan. In M. Hasimoto (ed.) Guidelines of Lake Management, pp. 718. Japan: ILEC/UNEP.
Kumar, D. and B. S. Keddy. 2000. Ecology and Human Well Being. Beverly Hills, CA: Sage
Publications.
Lee, W.-I. 2006. A study of ecological spatial patterns of Tianain City, Taiwan. Paper
presented at IFoU 2006 Beijing International Conference at http://dspace.lib.ksu.edu.
tw:8080/dspace/handle/123456789/2700
Mukul. 1992. To save the wetlands struggle by a fishermans cooperative in Calcutta.
Frontline, November 20, 1992, pp. 7684.
Mukherjee, R. 1991. Rapid Assessment of Flora and Fauna in Urban Fishery and Waterfront
recreation Ecosystem (Near Brace Bridge Railway Station). Calcutta: Report of Eastern
Regional Centre, National Wasteland development Board, pp. 159.
152
Chapter 6
Introduction
Stretching about 200 km between the border of Kampuchea and the South
China Sea, nine branches of the mighty Mekong River (meaning nine dragons)
spread across a wide and fertile delta where three crops of rice can be harvested
each year (see Figs. 6.1 and 6.2). The Mekong originates in the mountains of
western China where spring melts and rains, together with summer monsoons
of the tropics, combine to flood the banks from June through October. The
annual cycle, interacting with the daily ebb and flow of the tides, created ideal
habitats for both fresh and saltwater wildlife. But today the Mekong Delta is
one of the heavily populated regions of the earth. Most of the forests and
wetlands have been transferred into cities and farms. The delta is Vietnams
food basket (Torrell and Salamanca 2005).
The Mekong River basin is of truly exceptional significance to international
biodiversity conservation in comparison with other parts of tropical Asia. The
area supports a very large number of bird species identified as globally threatened or globally near threatened (Buckton and Safford 2004) including the
famous Eastern Saurus Crane (Grus antigone sharpii), giant ibis (Pseudibis
gigantea), white-shouldered ibis (Pseudibis davison), and the Bengal Florican
(Eupodotis bengalensis). A recent study by IUCN lists the Mekong River as one
of the nine richest watersheds for fish biodiversity globally, with 298 recorded
species, including the endemic giant catfish (Pangasianodon gigas) and the giant
Mekong bard (Catlocarpio siamensis) and several species of giant stingray
(Hans 2000).
The Mekong wetlands also have a critical role as a staging post in flyways for
a number of migratory birds (Scott 1989). The best known example is Tram
Chim National Park in Vietnam, which hosts the entire population of Eastern
Saurus Crane (G. a. sharpii) during the dry season. The freshwater wetlands are
also important for migratory egrets and shorebirds.
All living resources in the Mekong River are increasingly under threat.
Fishing practices in all countries include use of batteries, poison, and explosives
as well as small mesh nets. Other animals that are collected in wetlands include
frogs, snakes, and turtles, and their numbers are dropping. This is partially
the result of trading wildlife products, particularly the manufacturing of
traditional Chinese medicines. Birds have been hunted and are often victims
of agro-chemical pollution.
R.C. Smardon, Sustaining the Worlds Wetlands,
DOI 10.1007/978-0-387-49429-6_6, Springer ScienceBusiness Media, LLC 2009
153
154
Fig. 6.1 The Mekong River, watershed, and sources: Drawn by Samuel Gordon and adapted
from http://corrtho.cool.ne.jp/mekong/outline/mekong_river_c.html
Other threats to the Mekong Delta as a region are enumerated. The whole
basin is under consideration for hydroelectric generation so the question is how
this might affect downstream hydroelectric regime (Frappart et al. 2006, Quang
2002, Tanaka 2003, White 2002) and especially fisheries (Kite 2000, Van
Zalinge et al. 2003). Much of the delta is moving toward integrated rice and
fisheries production (Berg 2002, Ringler and Cai 2006, Rothius et al. 1998,
Torrell and Salamanca 2003) and intensive shrimp aquaculture production at
Introduction
155
Fig. 6.2 Mekong Delta and major habitat sites within the Mekong Delta, Vietnam. Tram
Chim site is indicated by number 10 within Can Tho Province. Redrawn by Samuel Gordon
and adapted from Torrell and Salamanca (2005)
the southern edge of the delta. Concerns include pesticide impacts from rice
culture inland (Phuong and Gopalakrishhan 2003, Torrell and Salamanca
2003) plus acid soils (Van Mensvoort 1996, Husson et al. 2000) for the inland
portions and saltwater intrusion and use of aqua-cultural chemicals for the
southern delta edges (Kam et al. undated). Even with these stresses on the biota
within the Mekong Delta, a current ecological assessment of the Mekong basin
for primary productivity and phytoplankton composition suggests the sampling sites have not suffered from ecosystem degradation.
Long-term climate change and rising sea levels may aggravate both saltwater
intrusion plus chemical contamination problems (Torrell and Salamanca 2003,
Wassermann et al. 2004). This may cause increasing vector-borne diseases such
as malaria and West Nile. On the other hand current demographic studies of
mosquito-borne malaria within rural districts of the delta have been going
down (Erhart et al. 2004).
This is the story of the International Crane Foundation and Vietnamese
Conservationists efforts to restore a badly damaged delta wetland habitat.
Although the International Crane Foundation has had an international reputation for their efforts to restore crane populations and habitat, this effort
stretched them in new directions. Also involved were a number of other private
156
foundations and academicians from Vietnam, Germany, the United States, and
Australia. That is what is so interesting.
Historical Context
Key sources for historical context are Doug et al. (2003), Duc et al. 1989, Thanh
(2003), and Trong (1990). Prior to the 19611975 Second Indochina War, a
wetland wilderness survived just east of Mekong near the Kampuchean border.
The area now known as Tram Chim (meaning bird swamp) covered approximately 50,000 acres over a shallow basin, which supported wide expanses of
sedge marshes and clumps of Melaleuca forests (see Fig. 6.2). Sarus Cranes
nested in the open marshes, while ibises, herons, cormorants, and anhingas
littered the trees with stick nests and whitewash. Deep water, dense vegetation,
and proximity to Kampuchea rendered Tram Chim an important refuge for
Vietcong soldiers during the last Indochina war. In an effort to control their
activities, two huge drainage channels were excavated like an X across the
basin and the inflammable Melaleuca was napalmed. Gunboats patrolled the
channels. Enemies and large birds were shot from helicopters. The wetland was
devastated. Only a denuded landscape remained.
Excessive drainage desiccated native vegetation, increased the frequency of
catastrophic wild fires, severely altered the wetland hydrologic regime, and
virtually eliminated the complex food web that the floodplain supported. As
plant and animal species vanished, indigenous human populations were also
replaced. Acid sulfate soils underlying the formerly waterlogged wetland substrate underwent oxidation and hydrolysis reactions, which lowered the surface
water pH below 3 and released toxic concentrations of iron and aluminum ions.
Thus at the onset of each rainy season floodplain waters became non-potable,
non-swimmable, and biologically sterile (Pantulu 1981).
Wetland Soils
The acid sulfate soil problem either was developed or was aggravated to its
present level of magnitude during the late nineteenth century. The reason is that
the pyrite deposits, which react to deep drainage and consequent oxygen intrusion by acidification, underlay broad depressions in the delta; the pyrite is
oxidized to iron (III) hydroxide and sulfuric acid with jarosite as the typical
intermediate product (van Mensvoort 1996, Husson et al. 2000). As a direct
result of anthropogenic interference, large areas (1.8 10 ha) are barren due to
the acid sulfate soil problem (Van Mensvoort 1996, Husson et al. 2000). The
only plant coverage on these soils is provided by weeds (e.g., Hellicharis equisetina) and sedges (Carex spp.) and acid-resistant herbaceous vegetation,
mainly Eleocharis dulis, Ischaemum aristatum, Phragmites karka, and Saccharum spontaneum. They form a dense cover and reach heights of 1.53.0 m.
The waterside forests predominately include Melaleuca cajuputi trees. The pH
Wetland Flora
157
of the water in highly affected areas drops, and in some locations, to 2 during
critical times of the annual cycle, namely at the outset of the rainy season. High
concentrations of iron and aluminum in drainage waters in the area are toxic to
crops in otherwise fertile areas and fish kills occur in canals and streams. Some
scientists feel the ecological changes have reached the stage where they are
irreversible (Pantulu 1981).
Wetland Flora
The original vegetation over most of Tam Nong district was the Mixed Swamp
forest with Melaleuca trees as dominants intermingled with many herbaceous
grasslands covered with water almost throughout the year (see Fig. 6.3a and b).
Fig. 6.3a and b Overview of Tram Chin area. Photo credit: Thanh Vo
158
However human disturbance (as we have reviewed) has disturbed the original
forest, which is replaced at the present time by rice fields and secondary
vegetation, types which still cover large areas of acid sulfate soils. There are
both natural and disturbed vegetation associations present.
The following associations characterize the natural vegetation (see Pham
2003, Kiet 1991, 1994); there is Melaleuca forest, which is a relict of the
degraded primitive forest including many afforested areas of new plantations.
Fig. 6.4a and b Typical current vegetation patterns in the Tram Chim Reserve. Photo credit:
Thanh Vo
Wetland Flora
159
160
Fig. 6.5 Eastern Saurus Cranes. Photo credit: George Archibald in the ICF Bugle Vo. 3, No.
1, Feb. 1987, p. 5
161
Immersed and marginally wet plants include Coix (Coix aquatica), common
reed (Phragmites communis), bulrush (Scirpus lacustris), bamboo (Bambosa spp.), water primrose (Jussiaea repens), water morning glory (Ipomoea aquatica), and water smart weed (Polygonum tomentosa).
Wetland Fauna
Fish fauna of the wetlands (see Kite 2000, Van Zalinge et al. 2003) are locally
characterized as Poissens blancs or Poissens noirs (white or black fish)
depending on their migratory patterns. The so-called white fish usually enter
the wetlands during the flood season to spawn. The few that are stranded in
these wetlands grow there and provide a rich fishery. Such white fish include
carps and catfishes of the genus Pongasius, and in the Mekong plain, clupieds,
threadfins, and drums. The blackfish such as the murrels (Channa spp.), anabantids (Anabas testudineus), catfish of the genera Saccobrachus and Clarius,
and the spiny Mastacemebelus spp. are more or less permanent residents of the
wetlands. Such fisheries have a very high economic value for local food subsistence and for cash (see Do and Bennett 2005, Ringler and Cai 2006).
Other vertebrates of economic importance that inhabit wetlands are frogs,
snakes, crocodiles, large water lizards, and waterfowl such as grebes, pelicans,
darters, herons, ducks, cranes, ibises, storks, and snipes. All these species are
permanent residents with the exception of the migratory waterfowl. A number
of very rare species have been observed including white-winged wood duck,
Greater Adjutant Stork, black-necked stork, Bengal Florican (E. bengalensis)
as well as the Eastern Sarus Crane (G. a. sharpii) (see Figs. 6.7 and 6.8) (Beilfuss
1996). The Siamese crocodile (Crocodylus siamenis) was formerly common in
the Mekong Delta but is one of the worlds most endangered crocodilians (Platt
and Tri 2000).
162
Fig. 6.7 Typical dike and surrounding rice fields and Melaleuca forest in the Mekong Delta.
Photo credit: Thanh Vo
Enter Mr. Moui Nhe, who was born in a village beside Tram Chim. Following the reunification of Vietnam in 1975, Mr. Muoi Nhe became the leader of
Dong Thap Province, one of Vietnams 38 provinces and is the one that
contains what used to be the wetland area of concern. Mr. Moui did not have
the luxury of a natural history or ecology studies and much of his life was spent
in the armed services fighting the Japanese, the French, and the Americans.
Realizing the former importance of the Tram Chim both for aquatic wildlife
and for fishing and lumbering, Mr. Moui Nhe decided to convert one-quarter of
the Tram Chim basin back to its former condition. After the war 32 km of dikes
were built around 14,000 acres of former wetland to prevent monsoon rains
from spilling into the drainage channels during the dry season. Groves of
Melaleuca were planted and the restoration began and canals were constructed
around a 5800-ha portion of the former Plain of Reeds.
163
Fig. 6.8a and b Overhead photos of the water control structure and dikes engineered to
recreate the hydrology. Photo credit: Thanh Vo
In contrast, the Eastern Sarus has not been protected across its Southeast
Asian range and is endangered on the mainland, although since 1964 when the
subspecies was first observed in northern Australia, its numbers have increased
into the thousands on the island continent. Researchers in China, Thailand, and
the Philippines have not recently found any Eastern Sarus Cranes and asked for
the International Crane Foundations assistance in helping to restore these
164
enormous birds. The discovery of the Eastern Sarus at Trim Tram, in 1986, was
the only confirmed record of the subspecies in its traditional range at that time
and peaked the ICFs interest in Tram Chim. George Archibald, executive
director of ICF, first heard about the Eastern Sarus Crane in the delta from a
paper presented at a conference in China by Le Dien Duc from the Center for
Natural Resources and Environmental Studies in July 1987.
At this point George Archibald connected with Charles Luthin, who formerly worked with ICF, went to graduate school at the University of Wisconsin
and then served 5 years with the Brehm Fund for the International Conservation of Birds in West Germany. While working with the Brehm Fund, Mr.
Luthin was able to join forces with Vietnams leading conservationist, Professor
Vo Quy at the University of Hanoi, in implementing a plan to locate and
conserve a whole spectrum of endangered water birds including the Giant
Ibis, Lesser Adjutant Stork, and Eastern Sarus Crane.
Under the leadership of Professor Vo Quys deputy, Professor Le Dien Duc,
a three-man Wetland and Waterbird Working Group (WWWG) started a
search that resulted in the 1986 discovery of Mr. Muoi Nhe and his cranes.
The Brehn fund has continued to provide financial support vital to development and conservation in Vietnam.
In January 1988, a three-person team from the United States George
Schaller of the New York Zoological Society, ICF Trustee Abigail Avery, and
George Archibald joined the WWWG on a weeklong exploration to Tram
Chim. During this expedition, the team surveyed the vast expanses of wetlands,
did rough crane counts, surveyed the status of the dikes, and did local conservation education programs in schools. During this trip, plans were laid for an
education center that was constructed in Tam Nong at the edge of the Tram
Chim Sarus Crane reserve, with the support of the Brehm Fund. The following
program was also developed:
Research needs were identified such as the need to determine the natural
hydrology of the wetland and map the distribution of sulfate soils and then
the need to identify what other areas should be restored.
Sarus Cranes should be carefully studied throughout the year to determine
habitat needs.
Need for dike repair and sluice gates along the dikes, which could then be
managed to restore the original hydrologic conditions of the wetland.
Plans were also laid for a visit of the three members of the WWWG and a
local official from Tan Nong, Mr. Ngo Quoc Thang, for a one-month study
visit to the United States. This was done and the WWWG with Mr. Moui Nhe
in 1988 did include two field trips to Horicon Marsh in 1988 and 1989. Members
of the WWWG and Ngo Quoc Thang visited ICF in 1988, and Muoi Nhe and
Le Dien Duc visited ICF in 1989. Plans were also made for a co-sponsored (ICF
and Vietnam) Crane Workshop near Tram Chim, with delegates invited from
all Asian Nations, which had or still have cranes. By 1990, another 1200 ha of
impoundment was added to the reserve. The dikes retained monsoon rainwater
165
across the wetland and precluded forest fires while large tracts of the planted
rear mangrove seedlings grew.
With the return of wetter conditions, many species of native wetland flora
invaded or emerged from the dormant seed bank. Native fauna also rebounded.
For example, the Eastern Sarus Crane (as mentioned, G. a. sharpi), blacknecked stork (Xenorhynokus asiatious), and Bengal Florican (E. bengalensis)
were all thought lost from southeast Asia but returned once conditions
improved (Brehm Fund for International Bird Conservation 1987, Archibald 1988). With the discovery of native species, Vietnamese scientists convinced local authorities to prohibit agricultural development, outlaw wildlife
hunting, and protect the area as a nature reserve called Tram Chim (Duc 1989).
Although these initial steps taken to revitalize the wetland were a tremendous success, the productivity of the wetland plateaued quickly. The diked
perimeter isolated water inside Tram Chim from water outside the reserve.
Stagnant standing water restricted wildlife usage, stunted vegetative growth,
and prevented regeneration of flora and fauna (Kiet 1991). Finally, as the
human population of the Mekong Delta swelled to more than 13.5 million
people, intense pressure was placed on the wetland to either produce abundant
natural resources or be converted to rice agriculture. Thus by 1990 the restoration process had reached a critical juncture.
166
Vietnam was important and needed help, but some delegates saw the reserve, its
management, and their mission from a different perspective.
In 1989, there were incompatible plans and management actions displayed
all over the reserve. Canals were being dug both inside and outside the preserve
with no coordination and sometimes at cross-purposes. The first agreement in
1990 was a moratorium on all canal digging and other management actions so
that there was time to study and understand what was going on. It was part of
the funding agreement with the Brehm Fund, so there would be time to study
the issues, develop a coordinated management plan, and provide funds for the
water gates. There was also funding from the National Wildlife Federation.
The tensions and frictions between different parties were many and complicated. Such tensions were behind the scenes of the 1990 and 1991 meetings as
well as the negotiations on how the preserve should be managed. First, there
was the North Vietnam vs. South Vietnam tensions or central government vs.
local autonomy. For instance, local government was upset about the costs
associated with establishing the educational center with only partial funding
from foundations and the central government.
There were many ideas about how the preserve should be managed.
Mr. Moui Nhe wanted initially to see the area set aside as a kind of historic
park. This was thwarted by the influx of people moving into the area, planting
crops, and planting rear mangrove. Some of the vegetation burned and more
canals were dug, and the dikes were started in 1984. Some wanted to cut the
wetland into four equal parts, each with a different management goal. Some
wanted to restore the entire area, and ICF was interested in wetland restoration
and crane habitat. Others, such as the Mekong River Commission, were interested in water quality management and preventing the acid sulfate soils from
causing problems. The University of Hanoi WWWG was interested in tying all
management options to optimization of crane breeding and production.
All these different perspectives existed during the 1990 meeting and erupted
full force in 1991 at the management meeting. A couple of factors were critical
in preparation for the 1991 meeting for which some form of a management plan
was an anticipated product (Jeb Barzen 1996). One factor was the visit of
Mr. Moui Nhe to ICF back in 1989. The key experience was the visit to Horicon
Marsh in Wisconsin where a drainage ditch with attendant ecological problems
was shown to the Vietnamese and discussed on site.
The second factor, prior to the 1991 meeting, was intense probing discussions
between ICF and the different parties as to why certain management actions
(e.g., digging ditches) were done or proposed. It was often found that there was
no strong rationale or basis for digging some of the ditches or other management actions. Often repeated questioning yielded different answers, no strong
logic, or a history of local understandings.
The workshop program had been planned to use Tram Chim as a practical
example for conservation projects and issues in southern Asia. Probably the
more important goal was persistence in learning to work together and to
recognize that people needed to sustain themselves as well as preserve cranes.
Hydrological Restoration
167
In the actual meeting the Vietnamese were concerned about fire and the survival
of the rear mangrove trees, as well as fisheries and wildlife habitat. One of the
critical issues was the proposed digging of ditches in the middle of the marsh.
Mr. Moui Nhe was reminded of what he had seen and experienced at Horicon
Marsh in 1989 that the drainage ditch there did not work and caused ecological harm. This parallel logic, confirmed by the elder statesman and local
leader, was also tied to the notion that once you dig the ditches some of the
consequences are irreversible. But you can always try something else first and if
that does not work go back to the ditches.
So the second agreement was signed in 1991, a loose management plan was in
place, and detailed hydrological studies continued. Detailed hydrological studies started in 19891990 dry season and the first years data were used at the
1991 management meeting. Next steps coming out of the workshop included
the following:
Hydrological Restoration
Throughout this process, hydrological restoration was deemed to be the primary mechanism by which the physical, chemical, and biological recovery of
the wetland could be facilitated. Four years of hydrological restoration activity
at the Tram Chim Reserve are summarized by Beilfuss and Brazen (1994).
These two investigators started by trying to understand the hydrological and
water quality processes of the wetland prior to degradation. Much information
was obtained from interviews with long-term residents of the area, review of
available literature, interpretation of archival military aerial photos, and examination of pristine remnants of the Plain of Reeds remaining in Cambodia. The
latter proved difficult because of the ongoing political situation. Interviews with
the local elders and reviews of published studies suggested that the dominant
force for the Plain of Reeds was the same hydrological processes occurring over
the entire Mekong Delta. These forces are the seasonal monsoon rainfall,
combined with overbank flooding of the Mekong River plus overload sheet
flow from Cambodia annually flood with 23 m of standing water followed by
receding waters followed by the 6-month dry season. Aerial photos revealed the
bisecting of numerous shallow streams and canals. Excessive drainage dropped
the regional water table more than 1 m below the wetland substrate during the
dry season and decreased the total period of standing water inundation from 7
to 5 months.
To supplement and verify the qualitative understanding of the pre- (natural)
and post-disturbance wetland water regime, quantitative measurements of
168
minimize the amount of physical labor and time required for water gate
operation and maintenance;
169
The water gates use gravity flow to permit maximum inflow and outflow of
surface water during the flooding season. Gates at Tram Chim were located at
four points where large natural steam channels intersect the reserve dikes.
Surface waters move to and from areas across the reserve through these stream
networks.
The restoration strategy implemented at Tram Chim attempts to mimic the
natural and hydrological cycle and can be described in seven steps. The timing
of these steps varies among years as the timing and magnitude of flooding in the
Mekong Delta vary. The following steps represent an average based on 30
years of region-wide data:
1. Prior to the onset of the rainy season in late April to early May the water
gates are closed. No standing water and at a minimum height.
2. Water gates remain closed as the rainy season begins in May. Evapotranspiration rates decrease and water table fluctuates near the surface. Ponded
waters in depressions increase and reserve water levels rise slowly to the
surface, while canal waters increase rapidly as the Mekong River branches
reach bankful discharge.
3. The water gates are opened when non-channelized overbank floodwaters
(low in sediment and acidic material) from the Mekong River reach the
reserve between June and August. The wetland water table rises sharply
and most of the reserve is undated by early July.
4. From August through October precipitation increases substantially relative
to evapotranspiration and the entire Plain of Reeds is inundated below 23 m
of floodwaters. The water gates remain open throughout this period as the
Mekong River flood wave is passed through the wetland.
5. By early October, floodwaters begin to recede through the stream networks
and drain through the water gates to the surrounding floodplain. The rainy
season diminishes through December.
6. The gates are closed when the water level above the reserve soil substrate is
equal to the average depth of 2030 cm that was ponded across the wetland
prior to the channelization of the Plain of Reeds. Timing depends on the
influence of tropical typhoons and annual fluctuations in the basin-wide
levels.
7. From December through February, the water gates remain closed and surface water movement in the wetland ceases. Water levels in the surrounding
drainage canals continue to decline, causing the degraded floodplain substrate to desiccate. Within the reserve, evapotranspiration increases steadily
beneath the floating vegetation mats, while precipitation almost ceases. This
completes the cycle of hydrologic restoration.
After the hydrologic study was done and the water gates installed, there was
a third agreement in 1992. This agreement placed two entities in charge of the
reserve, the reserve staff and a private company. The private management
company had two objectives; to make money from utilization of preserve
resources and habitat preservation. There was tension between these two
170
goals and between the company and preserve staff. Things were not going well.
There were massive floods in 1991 and some of the dikes were damaged.
Funding was negotiated with the Mekong River Commission and the dikes
were repaired.
ICF staff came back in 1992 to teach prescribed burning and vegetation
management techniques. They found Vietnamese digging holes in the newly
fixed dikes in order to harvest the fish sold to them by the company. There
was a substantial confrontation but the water was drained out, causing exposure to acid soils and most of the fish died before they could be harvested. The
company lost face, but the real issue was that the preserve needed national
status (Barzen 1991), which in turn would provide legitimization for restoration
and preservation management. The counterweight of national status was that
the local provincial government did not want to have the central government
tell them what to do the northsouth issue again.
In 1993 an addendum was added to the 1992 agreement, dissolving the
private company, making the reserve a sole proprietorship of the reserve staff
plus a major push for national status. It should be understood that the Vietnamese had been working on national recognition since 1988, and this agreement
merely provided the final inputs for national recognition. The Tram Chim was
declared a national preserve in 1994.
In 1993 and 1994 there were fires but the waters were high preventing much
damage. In 1994, it was very dry. In 1995, the new preserve manager drew down
the water too much. It should be noted that this is difficult to judge, as there
were few staff gauges or accurate survey for baseline elevation conditions.
There was much fire following this drawdown. The popular perception was
much loss of political face. Although no long-term ecological damage was
done, there was a substantial reduction of forest cover in some areas, but the
vegetation came back as did the cranes. There is a new preserve manager who
now is more meticulous in terms of management but has a rougher time with
interpersonal relations. So it goes.
171
United States, with thesis research conducted at Tram Chim. Field training in
Vietnam has focused upon teaching various data collection and analysis techniques to reserve staff and local villagers.
ICF realizes that in addition to working with Vietnamese conservationists
and academics, the long-term hydrological restoration of Tram Chim will only
be successful if it is understood and supported by the political leaders at all
levels and by inhabitants living near the reserve. ICFs work with educating
officials and community members about the importance of a monitoring and
evaluation strategy is very important to continue restoration processes.
In the summer of 1994, the wetland hydrologist from ICF, Rich Beilfuss,
traveled to Australia with four Vietnamese colleagues, Thai Van Vinh, Ngo
Thinh Thang, Nguyen Huu Thien, and Phan Trong Thinh (the director, vice
director, ecologist of Tram Chim National Reserve, and the ecologist for the
Vietnam Wetlands Program, respectively). With financial support from the
John D. and Catherine T. MacArthur Foundation and the Asian Wetlands
Bureau, they spent a month learning about the Australian equivalent of the
Plain of Reeds at Kadadu National Park. Training experiences were supplied by
Roger Jaensch of the Asian Wetland Bureau, Dr. Max Finlayson, one of
Australias top wetland experts, Dr. Jeremy Russell-Smith, and the Australian
Nature Conservation Agency Staff with three goals in mind:
172
scientists/managers experienced ecotourism and educational programs appropriate to tropical wetland conservation.
One outcome of this training visit was the new relationship forged between
Australian and Vietnamese colleagues. A second group of wetland managers
from Laos, Cambodia, Thailand, and Vietnam traveled to northern Australia
for training. This may well be the start of a permanent training program for
tropical wetland management.
There has been little monitoring of vegetation except for Mimosa pigra
control (Son et al. 2001, Thi et al. 2001), but there has been monitoring for
water birds. There are now staff gauges for monitoring water levels in cooperation with the Mekong River Commission.
During the spring of 1994 it was declared that Tram Chim is a national
reserve (The Central Government of Vietnam 1994, Thanh 2003) the first
wetland national reserve in the Mekong Delta and the first protected area for
cranes in Vietnam. This is also an important step toward recognizing the
importance of wetlands for the survival of people and wildlife. Education and
training, however, are still desperately needed to help Vietnam manage the
Tram Chim and its resources wisely. ICF realizes that the future of Tram
Chim and other wetlands in Vietnam depends as much on wise resource
management (including people) as they do on wise ecological management.
Vietnam must struggle to feed and clothe its increasing population by tapping
every resource available. There is till much pressure from outside the preserve
for more utilization of preserve resources.
In addition, there may be new threats, which may alter the hydrology of the
entire Mekong River basin. The four Mekong River Commission countries,
Cambodia, Laos, Thailand, and Vietnam, are considering massive schemes for
dams, barrages to harness the Mekong for flood control, and hydroelectric
production for export (Lohmann 1990, Quang 2002).
The important outcome of the three agreements, and the training to date, is
increasing institutional capacity to address all the management issues facing the
Tram Chim National Preserve. There is still outside pressure to more intensely
manage the national reserve for various products and uses. This was the subject
of a fourth meeting/planning session in August 1996. This time it will be various
Vietnamese factions debating issues with organizations like the ICF in the
background ready to lend technical support if needed.
On December 29, 1998, the government transformed the Tram Chim Nature
Reserve into Tram Chim National Park according to Decision No. 253/QDTTg of the Prime Minister, dated December 29, 1998. A management board has
been established for Tram Chim National Park.
The establishment of Tram Chim National Park has two major purposes:
(1) to conserve the typical wetland ecological system of the lower Mekong
Delta, the flooded zone of Dong Thap Muoi; and (2) to conserve historical,
cultural, and scientific value which can sever the scientific research for wise use
of wetland for national benefit and contribute to the environmental and ecological conservation of South East Asian region.
Conservation Issues
173
Currently the national park has 81 permanent staff and within that, 53 staff
members are forest rangers, the others are scientists and administrative staff.
The administration includes five functional divisions: Organizational and
Administration; Planning and Accounting; the Scientific and Environmental
Research; the Forest Protection Unit; and the Environmental Education and
Eco-tourism Center (Tram Chim 2006).
Conservation Issues
Tram Chim now has national park status (Thanh 2003), which confers a
relatively high degree of protection; however, several threats remain, such as
pressure from local peoples livelihood activities, pollution from surrounding
rice farms, and the changes of water affecting biological dynamics of the
ecosystem.
Tram Chim National Park is located in the intensive rice production areas of
the Mekong Delta. It borders five communes with a total population of about
41,000 people. Most of them are rice farmers. Local livelihoods are based on
rice production in the dry season, and fishing and collecting natural products in
the flood season.
The establishment of Tram Chim National Park and the construction of a
long enclosure dike system lead to the reduction of livelihood opportunities for
the local population. The frequent encroachment of local people into the
national park to hunt, collect firewood and other wild products could be
considered a conservation conflict issue. The park is surrounded by intensive
rice cultivation, which heavily uses pesticides and fertilizers, which have a
substantial impact on the integrity of the wetland ecosystem of the national
park. Examples of such impacts are pollutant discharge and alteration of
natural water levels (Buckton et al. 1999).
In 2000, the national park management board began constructing six canals
inside the national park, the construction of which could have fragmented the
natural habitat and altered the water regime, leading to changes in habitat.
However, construction of the canals was halted after only two were completed.
The construction of the enclosure dyke system, about 71 km long, has isolated
the national park from the whole ecological system, which directly affects the
hydrological dynamic and biological links between the park and the external
system of the Mekong Delta.
The construction of canals is not, perhaps, the major threat to the Sarus
Crane population at Tram Chim. The most important factor in maintaining
suitable habitat, for this species, is appropriate management of the water level
at the site. In 2000, a partial drawdown was carried out, and, in 2001, a full
drawdown took place, which facilitated natural vegetation recovery. It is hoped
that appropriate water-level management will result in an increase in the crane
population at Tram Chim. The most recent management effort in Tram Chim
174
has been a focused effort to control M. pigra, a very aggressive exotic vegetative
species (Thi et al. 2001, Son et al. 2001, Walden et al. 2002).
Tram Chim meets the criteria for designation as a site of international
importance for wetland conservation under the Ramsar Convention. Currently, Tram Chim National Park is one of the most important wetland sites
in Mekong Delta and the lower Mekong region.
Summary
175
Summary
Currently there is ongoing ecosystem assessment of the Downstream
Mekong River Wetlands (Thong 2005). Stage 1 was from May 2003 to
February 2004, and stage two from February to the end of 2004. The
purpose of this study is to look at the state of biodiversity for the region
and pressures on this biodiversity. A summary paper by Torrell and Salamanca (2005) points out that the most prominent pressures on Mekong
Delta wetlands are rice production and associated large-scale water control
structures, shrimp aquaculture, and the inadequacy of current institutional
arrangements. The latter being that wetlands are neither land nor water and
thus fall through the Vietnamese land tenure and regulatory jurisdictional
system they belong to no one (see Cai et al. 2005). It should be noted that
Tram Chim National Park is second of all prioritized wetland conservation
sites in the Mekong Delta.
This an extremely interesting story of many actors as we can see from the
stakeholders listed above. Perhaps the main message is that different actors,
ICF, WWG, and local residents, can develop meaningful wetland management strategies if all parties are actively engaged in management negotiations, learn from each other, and learn of other wetland management
possibilities by seeing them work. This still a very fragile situation that
can be aggravated by both natural conditions and human resource needs.
The management scheme can be upset both by extreme monsoon-induced
flooding and by extreme dry conditions and fires. Local people need the rice
and fish production to survive; thus more pressure will be exerted in this
direction. One of the keys, from this authors perspective, is to develop local
management strategies that incorporate adaptive management and learning
progressive management techniques from Australia or other hydrologically
and ecologically relevant situations. This was done initially, thanks to the
local Vietnamese community leadership and ICF. The question is, can this
continue and support sustainable wetland management for Tram Chim
Nature Preserve?
176
Acronyms
ERISS: Environmental Research Institute Supervising Scientist
ICF: International Crane Foundation
WWWG: Wetland and Waterbird Working Group
References
Alger, W. N., P. M. Kelly, and N. H. Ninh (eds.). 2001. Living with Environmental Change,
Social Vulnerability, Adaptation, and Resilience in Vietnam. London: Rutledge, 314pp.
Archibald, G. W. 1988. Vietnam cranes thrive at Tram Chim. ICF Bugle, 14: 45.
Barzen, J. A. 1991. Restoration mixes science, people and luck in Vietnam. The ICF Bugle, 17:
23.
Barzen, J. 1996. Phone interview (April 1996).
Beilfuss, R. D. 1991. Hydrological restoration and management of tram Chim Wetland
Reserve, Mekong Delta, Vietnam. Unpublished Thesis, University of Wisconsin, Madison, 259pp.
Beilfuss, R. D. 1994. ICF, Vietnam, and Australia Build Wetland Network. The ICF Bugle,
20: 1, 46.
Beilfuss, R.D. 1996. Written comments on earlier chapter manuscript.
Beilfuss, R. D. and J. A. Brazen. 1994. Hydrological wetland restoration in the Mekong Delta,
Vietnam. In W. J. Mitsch (ed.) Global Wetlands: Old and New, pp. 453468. The Netherlands: Elsevier Science B.V.
Berg, H. 2002. Rice monoculture and integrated rice-fish farming in the Mekong Delta,
Vietnam-economic and ecological considerations. Ecological Economics, 41: 95107.
Buckton, S. T., N. Cu, H. Q. Quynh, and N. D. Tu. 1999. The Conservation of Key Wetland
Sites in the Mekong Delta. Hanoi: Bird Life International Vietnam Program.
Buckton, S. T. and R. J. Safford. 2004. The avifauna of the Vietnamese Mekong Delta. Bird
Conservation International, 14: 279322.
Cai, H. H., D.T. Ngo, N. An, and T. T. Giang, 2005. The legal and institutional framework
and the economic values of wetlands in the Mekong River Delta. In Millennium Ecosystem
Assessment: Downstream Mekong River Wetlands Ecosystem Assessment, Vietnam. Hanoi
City, Vietnam: Institute of Geography, National Center for Natural Science and Technology, and at http://www.millenniumassessment.org/en/subglobal.mekong.aspx
Claire-Ashton, E., N. T. B. Nhi, and T. Nielsen. 2005. Research Priorities for the Mekong
Delta Environmental Status and Future Requirements. Workshop at Cantho University,
College of Agriculture, Cantho City, Vietnam, 72pp.
Do, T. N. and J. Bennett. 2005. An Economic Valuation of Wetlands in Vietnams Mekong
Delta: A Case Study of Direct Use Values on Camau Province. Environmental Management and Development, APSEQ Occassional Paper no. 8, The Australian National University at http://hdl.handle.net/1885/43111
Doug, V. N., E. Maltby, R. Tafford, T.-P. Tuong, and V.-T. Xuan. 2003. Status of the
Mekong Delta; agricultural development, environmental pollution and farmer differentiation, In M. Torrell, A. M. Salamanca, and B. D. Ratner (eds.) Wetlands Management in Vietnam; Issues and Perspectives, pp. 2529. Penang, Malaysia: World Fish
Center.
Duc, L. D. 1989. Eastern Sarus Cranes in Indochina. Proceedings 1987 International Crane
Workshop, pp. 317318. Qiqihar, China, International Crane Foundation, Wisconsin.
Duc, L. D., H. V. Thang, and G. W. Archibald. 1989. Biology and Conservation of the Eastern
Sarus Crane in Vietnam. Madison, Wisconsin: Rome Publications, 9pp.
References
177
178
Management in Vietnamese Wetlands; Weed control and Occupational Health and Safety
Issues, pp. 110-116. Tran Chim National Park, Vietnam.
Tanaka, M., T. Sugimura, S. Tanaka, and N. Tamai. 2003. Flood-drought cycle of Toule Sap
and Mekong Delta area observed by DMSP-SSM/1. International Journal of Remote
Sensing 24(7): 14871504.
Thanh, N. C. 2003. Socio-economic situation, management, rational utilization and development potentials of Tram Chim, a Wetlands Ecosystem Conservation National Park. In
Torrell et al. (eds.) Wetlands Management in Vietnam, Issues and Perspectives, pp. 7580.
Penang, Malaysia: World Fish Center.
The Central Government of Vietnam. 1994. Decision of the Prime Minister on the Recognition
for Tram Chim National Wetland Reserve of Tam Nong District, Dong Thap Province. The
Central Government, Hanoi, 2pp.
Thi, N.T. L., T. Triet, M. Storrs, and M. Ashley. 2001. Determining suitable methods of
control of Mimosa pigra in Tram Chin National Park Vietnam. Strategic Weed Management in Vietnamese Wetlands; Weed Control and Occupational Health and Safety Issues,
pp. 9195. Tran Chim National Park, Vietnam.
Thong, M. T. 2005. Millennium Ecosystem Assessment: Downstream Mekong River Wetlands
Ecosystem Assessment, Vietnam. Hanoi City, Vietnam: Institute of Geography, National
Center for Natural Science and Technology, and at http://www.millenniumassessment.
org/en/subglobal.mekong.aspx
Torrell, M. and A. M. Salamanca. 2005. Wetlands management in Vietnams Mekong delta:
An Overview of the pressures and responses. In Wetlands Management in Vietnam, Issues
and Perspectives, Penang, Malaysia: World Fish Center, pp. 116 and at http://www.
millenniumassessment.org/en/subglobal.mekong.aspx
Tram Chim National Park. 2006. Basic facts about Tram Chim National Park. Internal
introduction document.
Trong, N. X. 1990. History of the Dong Thap Moui. Paper presented at the Sarus Crane and
wetlands workshop, Tamnong, Vietnam, 3pp.
Trong, N. X. 1991. The History of Creating the Tram Chim Reserve. Paper presented at the
Sarus Crane and Wetlands workshop. Tamnong, Vietnam, 3pp.
Van Mensvoort, M. E. F. 1996. Soil knowledge for farmers, farmer knowledge for soil
scientists: The case of acid sulfate soils in the Mekong Delta, Vietnam. Wageningen
University Dissertation abstract no. 2112, 5pp.
Van Zalinge, N., P. Degen, C. Pongsri, S. Nuov, J. G. Jensen, H, V. Hao, and X. Choulamary.
2003. The Mekong River System. Second International Symposium on the Management of
Large Rivers for Fisheries (Phnom Phen, 1114 Feb. 2003), 17pp.
Walden, D., C. M. Finlayson, R. van Dam, and M. Storrs. 2002. Information for risk
assessment and management of Mimosa Pigra in Tram Chim National Park, Vietnam.
In J. Rovis-Herman, K. G. Evans, A. L. Webb, and R.W.J. Pigen (eds.) Environmental
Research Institute of the Supervising Scientist Research Summary 1995-2000, Supervising
Scientist Report 166. Darwin NT: Department of Environment and Heritage, Environment Australia.
Wassermann, R., N. X. Hien, C. T. Hoanh, and T. P. Tuag. 2004. Sea level rise affecting the
Vietnamese Mekong Delta; Water elevation in the flood season and implications for rice
production. Climatic Change 66(12): 89107.
White, I. 2002. Water Management in the Mekong Delta; Changes, Conflicts and Opportunities. International Hydrological Program, Technical Documents in Hydrology no. 61,
Paris: UNESCO, 66pp.
Chapter 7
Background
This case study concerns the formation of the Great Lakes Wetlands Policy Consortium which was a bilateral action group formed in 19891990 to negotiate and
coordinate environmental NGO policy positions on protection management and
restoration of wetlands in the Great Lakes drainage basin. This includes the states
of Wisconsin, Illinois, Michigan, Indiana, Ohio, and New York plus the province of
R.C. Smardon, Sustaining the Worlds Wetlands,
DOI 10.1007/978-0-387-49429-6_7, Springer ScienceBusiness Media, LLC 2009
179
180
Ontario in Canada. The major player in this case study is the Tip of the Mitt
Watershed Council located in Michigan. They organized the policy consortium and
obtained the grant for to do the activity and are most active with follow-up. Other
actors are individual environmental advocate groups in the United States and
Canada as well as regulatory agencies in both countries.
The Great Lakes drainage basin contains 95% of the surface water of North
America (see Figs. 7.1 and 7.2). It covers nearly 300,000 miles2 in eight states
and two Canadian provinces and boasts a rich variety of freshwater wetland
communities. Prior to European settlement, however, there were wetlands
stretching from the western edge of Lake Erie clear across Ohio, into Indiana,
and covering the southern edge of Ontario. Agricultural conversion and shoreline development have reduced wetland acreage in the Great Lakes basin
drastically. An estimated 6080% of pre-settlement wetlands in this region
have been lost and 80100% along intensely urbanized coastline.
The Great Lakes region remains an industrial heartland and home for
40 million people, including 30% of the US population and 70% of the Canadian
population. Efforts to protect wetlands in a region dominated by industrial
Fig. 7.1 Great Lakes watershed and large wetland areas. Drawn by Samuel Gordon and
adapted from Environment Canada and USEPA, 2000. Great Lakes Atlas
The Resource
181
Fig. 7.2 Open lake edge marsh. Photo credit: Canadian Wildlife Service
The Resource
Marshes, shrub/scrub, and forested wetlands occur along the margins of the Great
Lakes and throughout the watersheds. Wetlands along the margins of the Great
Lakes are located primarily in areas protected by wave action including bays, the
entrances to rivers, and behind spits and barriers. These marshes are globally unique
in that their plant communities and species composition have adapted to high water
level fluctuations, wind and ice action (Bedford 1992, Burton et al. 2002, Geis 1985,
Herdendorf 2004a, Keddy and Fraser 2000, Tilton and Schwegler 1978).
Some wetlands are located along the open coast in shallow water areas in
semi-protected zones (see Figs. 7.2, 7.3, 7.4, and 7.5). Upper watershed wetlands
are located along rivers, streams, and smaller freshwater lakes, and in isolated
pockets. These wetlands tend to be coniferous or hardwood swamps, shrub
carr-heaths, and bogs (see Fig. 7.6).
Wetlands in the Great Lakes drainage basin are valued (see Tilton and
Schwegler 1978) for contributions to water quality (especially riverine and
lacustrine marshes), hydrology and flood dissipation (especially upper watershed
swamps), shoreline protection (limited), human use (especially marshes), primary production and diversity (especially marshes), rare and endangered species
(especially swamps, bogs, and fens), and peat (carbon) accumulation (especially
inland swamps, fens, and bogs).
There have been a number of studies assessing biophysical attributes
and classifying Great Lakes wetlands and their connecting water bodies
182
Fig. 7.3 St. Lawrence River marsh. Photo credit: New York Sea Grant
Fig. 7.4 Emergent marsh vegetation. Photo credit: Canadian Wildlife Service
The Resource
183
Fig. 7.5 Typical embayment wetland along Lake Ontario shore. Photo credit: New York Sea
Grant
Fig. 7.6 Northern coniferous swamp. Photo credit: Canadian Wildlife Service
Herdendorf 2004, Smith et al. 1991) and the State of the Great Lakes
Ecosystem (SOLRC) reports were done by Dodge and Kavetsky (1995)
and Maynard and Wilcox (1997).
In general, many coastal wetlands are subject to change over periods of
time, but many emergent wetland vegetative communities are dominated by a
few species. This is even truer for embayment wetlands and those along
connecting waterways where water levels are controlled or very less than the
184
The Resource
185
1978). Great Lakes wetlands also provide habitat for waterfowl, especially
ducks and geese, other birds, and a number of animals (see Figs. 7.7, 7.8, and
7.9). These areas are important regionally during migration, especially between
the Atlantic Coast and inland locations in northern Canada. Waterfowl rest
186
and feed in these areas, especially lake edge wetlands. According to Hummel
(1981) 42 bird species are totally dependent on southern Ontario wetlands,
26 bird species are partially dependent, 16 mammal species are dependent,
and 20 reptile species are heavily dependent. Glooschenko et al. (1988) found
high occurrences of five out of six bird guilds in Great Lakes wetlands
including divers, dabblers, waders, gulls and terns, and passerines. The
largest numbers of dabbling and diving ducks use a corridor passing over southeastern Michigan and northern Ohio. Similarly, numbers of Canada, snow and
blue geese are highest in fall migration corridors, which pass through Saginaw
Bay of Lake Huron, Green Bay of Lake Michigan, and Grand Traverse Bay
of Lake Michigan (Crowder and Bristow 1988, Prince et al. 1992,Tilton and
Schwegler 1978).
Wetland ecosystems of the Great Lakes region are also valuable as waterfowl
production areas. The following birds are examples of the variety of species
nesting in wetland habitats: black-crowned night herons (Nycticorax nycticorax),
marsh hawk (Circus cyaneous), great blue heron (Ardwa herodias), short-billed
marsh wren (Cistothorus platensis), red-winged blackbird (Agelaius phoniceus), as
well as numerous species of ducks, and to a lesser extent, geese.
Coastal Great Lakes wetlands are important breeding grounds for
muskrat (Ondatra zibethica), beaver, otter, and other mammals and habitat
for fish eating mammals such as raccoon, otter, and mink (see Fig. 7.10).
Information on mammals exists for some locations but not consistently
throughout the Great Lakes wetlands (Crowder et al. 1986, Herdendorf
and Hartley 1980).
Threats
187
Threats
Historical threats: Historically wetlands have been destroyed or degraded by the
following:
Fills: Filling of wetlands has been particularly serious at the mouths of rivers
and in urban areas (e.g., Chicago, Milwaukee, Toronto, Buffalo). Large
areas of waterfront are typically filled wetlands. However, fills have also
taken place in some other areas to facilitate development or provide protection from coastal erosion (see Fig. 7.11).
188
Fig. 7.12 Wetland drainage for agriculture. Photo credit: New York Sea Grant
Fig. 7.13 Dredging for marina use. Photo credit: New York Sea Grant
Threats
189
Dikes: Dikes to provide flood protection and to create waterfowl impoundments have been constructed in some areas along the Great Lakes. The dikes
are a mixed blessing as they affect wetlands hydroperiods or cut off wetlands
from adjacent waters but also provide them protection from storm damage.
Water pollution: Water pollution has taken the form of both direct point
sources of pollution from industrial and commercial operations and nonpoint sources of pollution from agricultural runoff, stormwater, and other
sources. Pollutants include sediment, excess nutrients, and toxic trace metals,
and organic pollutants (Crowe et al. 2004) (see Fig. 7.14).
Fig. 7.14 Water pollution from dumping in wetlands. Photo credit: New York Sea Grant
190
Fig. 7.15 Flooding and stabilization of water levels. Photo credit: New York Sea Grant
Non-point, and to a lesser extent, point sources of pollution have been reduced,
but some new pollution continues to occur. In addition, non-point sources of
pollution continue, essentially unabated, resulting in contaminated wetland
sediment and vegetation. Work is continuing on phosphorus budgets (Mitsch
and Reeder 1997, Reeder 1994). Mercury, especially, remains a concern for its
availability for fish and fish eating birds (Pijanowski et al. 2002). More recent
concerns arise from persistent organic chemicals and endocrine disruptor
affects on wildlife (Fox 2001).
Maintenance dredging: Navigational dredging continues, particularly in urban
areas. A number of proposals have been made for new marinas or expanded
marinas.
Invasion of exotic species: The Great Lakes continue to be susceptible to
unwanted invasion of exotic species from zebra mussels (Bowers and
de Szalay 2004, Hudson and Bowen 2002, Leach 1995, Mills et al. 1993,
Schloesser et al. 2006) to unwanted plant species such as purple loose strife
(Zedler and Kercher 2004) and common reed (Wilcox et al. 2003).
Global warming: Includes aggravation of water level and exotic species
affects above plus vegetative community shifts and long-term carbon storage
issues (Armentano and Menges 1986, Crowley 1990, Hartmannn 1990,
Magnuson et al. 1998, Mortsch and Quinn 1996, Smith 1991).
Protection Policies
Until two decades ago, no or little protection was provided to wetlands of the
Great Lakes. Since then a variety of measures have been adopted at national,
state and provincial, and local levels, but the effectiveness of these measures
Protection Policies
191
Regulations
In the United States, the US Army Corps of Engineers provides some control of
fills and other structures in wetlands along the margins of the Great Lakes and
in wetlands along the major rivers and streams and in watersheds through the
Section 404 program. However, smaller fills and many types of drainage have
not been regulated. This program, subject to various types of conditions, has
typically issued permits. There is no comparable federal permitting program in
Canada, but there is a Federal Policy on Wetlands Conservation and the
Canada Fisheries Act does intend to protect fish and wildlife habitat in both
inland and marine waters.
In the United States, most (Wisconsin, Minnesota, Michigan, New York,
Pennsylvania) but not all the states have adopted wetland regulatory programs,
which require permits for specified activities. However, drainage is not extensively regulated. In addition, many states limited the types or sizes of wetlands
subject to regulation (e.g., the New York program applies only to wetlands
12.4 acres in size and larger). In Canada, a general wetland policy has been
adopted at the provincial level by Ontario, which has jurisdiction over all Great
Lakes wetlands except for the St. Lawrence. However, implementation is up to
local governments.
In the United States many local governments have also adopted wetland
protection regulations, particularly in Wisconsin, Michigan, Pennsylvania, and
Minnesota; as noted above, regulation of wetlands is solely local government
responsibility in Ontario (Smith et al. 1991).
Despite the rather broad scope of regulations already in place (particularly in
the United States), the effectiveness of implementation is questionable. There
are a fair number of exemptions to the existing regulations; regulations are in
some instances, not enforced; the effectiveness of compensation (restoration/
creation) measures to compensate for losses is highly questionable, the typical
balancing approaches utilized for permits result in gradual, cumulative losses.
Lack of manpower, staffing, and budgets are all problems for implementing
agencies.
Tax Incentives
There are both provincial and federal tax incentive programs in Canada
(see Loftus et al. 2004) and some tax incentive programs in the US states.
There is also a tax incentive for US landowners if they donate land to a land
192
trust or not-for-profit under the US Federal Income tax code. The increase in
land trust activity in the last 20 years, partially because of this measure, in the
United States has been substantial.
Acquisition/Securement
The national, state, and local governments in some instances have acquired selected
wetland areas, although there seems to be more activity in non-government
organizations moving toward acquisition of wetlands for habitat management,
heritage values, or interpretation potential. There are many programs (see
Loftus et al. 2004) in Ontario that include acquisition, dedication, agreements,
co-management, land use allocation, and extension outreach. Much of the wetland
acquisition in the United States is connected to major NGOs such as Ducks
Unlimited, Nature Conservancy, Audubon, and local land trusts.
Restoration
Some wetland restoration efforts have occurred in both regulatory and nonregulatory contexts mainly in urban settings such as Toronto Harbor and
Chicago and others are proposed as part of long-term pollution abatement
such as Hamilton Harbor. In the United States, both the US Fish and Wildlife
Service and Natural Resource Conservation Service have wetland creation,
restoration, and enhancement programs that have been very effective throughout the Great Lakes drainage basin. There has been more ongoing research in
general on wetland restoration (Barry et al. 2003, Kreiger 2003, Lundholm and
Simser 1999, Wang and Mitsch 1998, Wilcox 1999) and a very concentrated
research on Cootes Paradise March restoration in Hamilton Harbor (ChowFraser 1998, 2005, Chow-Fraser et al. 2004, Wei and Chow-Frazer 2005).
Thus we have the wetland resource, past threats, current threats, and regulatory programs. Now the question is what was the role of non-government
organizations in the midst of the Great Lakes wetland management context.
193
194
administrative rule making was going to make these wetland regulations and
this same joint legislative committee had been previously challenged on constitutional grounds, e.g., mixing legislative and executive functions and powers.
There was a need to balance environmental and industrial interests as part
of the rule-making process. The council was called upon to provide two of the
four environmental representatives as part of this process. There were four
environmental and four industry representatives.
One of the councils environmental representatives, Stephen Brown, stated
that at that time he felt that the environmental representatives were outgunned
and at an extreme resource disadvantage. The industry representatives had
lawyers and specialists that were constantly being cycled in as the issues came
up the environmentalists had few resources. Stephen Brown and Gail Gruenwald (past executive director of the council) prepared papers on such issues as the
feasible and prudent alternatives test which is a complex issue. Definitions were
problematic and difficult to discuss and negotiate. Non-consensus plus the ad hoc
process convinced some that the environmental community was not prepared.
Environmentalists at the state level were not ready to negotiate policy. They
needed a think tank to solicit policy. Most environmental advocate groups were
focused on micro issues and needed resources to allow people to come together.
Stephen Brown stated that it was this feeling of being unprepared and at a
resource disadvantage, which motivated him to write the grant with Gail Gruenwald to the Mott Foundation for the Great Lakes Wetlands Policy Consortium.
The Mott Foundation was a little doubtful that the council was ready to take
on this level of international multigroup discussions on wetland policy. But, the
councils experience with wetland issues with the earlier Michigan rule-making
negotiations served them well. They knew the issues, but they took a position
outside the existing regulatory arenas and focused on a vision of how ecosystems
management should happen. Stephen Brown and Gail Gruenwald also did lots of
recruiting while developing the proposal to the Mott Foundation to get letters of
support from many of the participating organizations.
195
the other groups and discuss wetland policy issues. Stephen Brown initially laid
out what he thought were the major issues. The group as a whole decided to
reorient, but ended up with some of the same issues.
The group after reviewing the major issues broke into subgroups to work on
four areas:
Regulatory issues
Incentives
Public outreach
International policy linkages
Regulatory issues were not popular, yet were some of the major issues. The
organizers tried to maintain working groups and to promote discussion of issues.
Funds were provided for meetings, but did not provide for release time between
meetings. Finding time for individuals to work on project tasks was a real problem
with a resultant high degree of variation in input. Teams would develop their own
style and personalities which made it difficult to coalesce material together.
Many participants had strong ideas about what should or should not be
done. An example was the vision statement. Its purpose was to make a public
splash and influence policy, whereas others felt that it was better to work behind
the scenes and this public imaging was counterproductive.
Stephen Brown pulled much of the material for the drafts together himself.
They also got a small group together to work on the regulatory issues in
Chicago. They mostly worked in small groups to finalize text and was sent
out to larger working groups for review. They asked regulators to respond but
did not get much response.
The big issue in the end was how to release the recommendations and which
groups would sign. As was stated before the National Association of Conservation
Districts did not sign and the Freshwater Foundation was also concerned about
their role and the implications of signing off on the recommendations. Much time
has spent stating the role of the organizations in the development of guidelines and
recommendations.
The Final Report of the Great Lakes Wetlands policy Consortium ended
up with a Vision Statement, Wetland policy Issues and Recommendations for Change
and an Action Agenda (Gruenwald 1990). The recommendations had the following
structure and are included in summary form as an appendix to this chapter:
A. Improving regional coordination and planning
1. International recommendations
2. Recommendations for provinces, states, and local government
3. Recommendations for non-governmental organizations
B. Increasing incentives for preservation
1. Direct and indirect payments
2. Income and property tax incentives
3. Other incentives
196
Implement monitoring to find out which action items were done by which
groups
197
A lot of the recommendations and action agenda are policy oriented where is
the enforcement? or could some of the agenda be more enforcement oriented
After the committees were dissolved step 2 was implementation, which contains
some interesting strategies. One such strategy is the creation of an implementation
committee made up of two government agencies, the Canadian Wildlife Service
and the Ontario Ministry of Natural Resources, and two NGOs, the Federal of
Ontario Naturalists and the Nature Conservancy. The committee is chaired be
someone from an NGO and its job is to track the process on deliverables utilizing
the milestones and actions in the plan.
The other strategy for implementation was to formalize progress on the action
plan within legislation, the Canada-Ontario Agreement, which in turn formalizes
progress on the International Joint Commissions Water Quality Agreement
between the United States and Canada. A third strategy was to market Great
Lakes Wetlands Conservation Plan as not a new program, but an ongoing program. As part of this strategy, use of existing resources and partnerships between
NGOs and government was used to underwrite the plan. During the critical phase
of implementation, Canada, like the United States was undergoing a phase of
198
199
Conservancy of Canada. Other major partners include the Eastern Habitat Joint
Venture off the North American Waterfowl Management Plan and the Great
Lakes Stewardship Fund.
In addition to protection of several thousand hectares of wetlands in the
Great Lakes basin, accomplishments of the first Action Plan include the production of wetlands publications, displays and facilitation of workshops, and the
development of Temperate Wetlands Restoration Workshop and Training
course. All of this activity is detailed in four progress reports for 19942001,
19972001, 20012003, and 20032005 which are available at the Great Lakes
Wetlands Conservation Action Plan web site at http://www.on.ec.gc./wildlife/
wetlands/glwcap-e.cfm. The latest progress report from 2003 to 2005 is
summarized in Table 7.1. As one can see there has been substantial progress
made under each of the eight strategies within the GLWCAP. Also notice the
similarities of these strategies to the initial recommendations of the Great Lakes
Wetlands Policy Consortium (Brown 1990) and pp.199200 of this chapter.
Table 7.1 Great Lakes wetlands conservation action plan (GLWCAP) progress as of 20061
Strategy 1: Publicize information concerning wetland protection, rehabilitation, policies, and
regulations and encourage involvement by individuals, groups, corporations, and industries
in all aspects of Great Lakes wetlands protection and rehabilitation
Milestones
1.1 Publicize wetland values to society, to water, and to wildlife in order to
encourage wetlands conservation. This may involve developing, publishing
and distributing brochures, educational packages, and status reports
1.2 Produce and distribute communication packages targeted to
corporations, agriculture (landowners), industry and development
interests, school curriculum, and municipal and regional governments
1.3 Expand distribution network through web-based information and like links
1.4 Provide a publicly accessible, web-based basic wetland attribute and
mapping resource (e.g., provide Ontario Coastal Wetlands Atlas online)
Progress
75%
75%
75%
100%
Strategy 2: Conduct and facilitate study of wetland functions, status, and trends to improve
understanding, communicate values, and set priorities for protection and rehabilitation.
Develop an accessible, computerized database for coastal Great Lakes wetlands
Milestones
2.1 Establish an ad hoc interagency data management group or technical
coordination team
2.2 Create/maintain an integrated computer database for coastal wetlands
of the lower Great Lakes and expand to include the remainder of the
Great Lakes basin (e.g., Ontario Great Lakes Coastal Wetland Atlas,
plans for interior Ontario wetlands, bi-national coastal outcomes from
Great Lakes Coastal Wetlands Consortium)
2.3 Continue wetland health monitoring at a variety of spatial and temporal
scales including maintenance and enhancement of a bi-national Great
Lakes wetland monitoring program (e.g., community-based Marsh
Monitoring Program and Great Lakes Coastal Wetlands Consortium
indicators work)
Progress
50%
75%
50%
200
50%
50%
25%
25%
Strategy 3: Determine priority securement sites and the most effective techniques to secure
those sites. Undertake wetlands securement at priority sites involving publicly owned lands to
demonstrate innovative securement strategies. Undertake extension and stewardship
activities with private landowners to protect the area and function of existing Great Lakes
basin wetlands and achieve the no loss long-term goals
Milestones
Progress
3.1 Secure 6,000 ha of wetland (8890 ha pervious plus 3993 ha in
100%
20032005 = 12,883 ha overall)
3.2 Promote and facilitate improved responsible wetland protection and
25%
management (strategy 4) on Crown lands by all provincial and federal
government agencies/owners. Identify opportunities by documenting
location and ownership of all provincially owned lands with wetlands to
complement existing federal report
3.3 Convene an experts workshop to identify, map, and describe biodiversity
75%
investment areas and to develop basin-wide conservation blueprint for
priority securement
3.4 Identify, promote, and assist activities of conservation authorities
25%
and municipalities to maintain and improve, where necessary, the
security and management of other publicly owned lands
3.5 Promote and facilitate responsible wetland protection and management
50%
(Strategy 4) on private lands by landowners through extension and
stewardship programs such as organizing workshops to promote local
initiatives
Strategy 4: Undertake rehabilitation projects and priority sites. Pursue opportunities for
wetland rehabilitation/creation through existing programs, including Remedial Action Plans
and the Eastern Habitat Joint Venture. In the long term consider ecological and watershedbased goals to achieve an overall increase in the area and function of wetlands in the Great
Lakes basin
Milestone
Progress
4.1 Rehabilitate/create 6000 ha of wetland
75%
4.2 Strengthen and enhance wetland rehabilitation and management
50%
expertise through training and technology transfer to rehabilitation
practitioners
4.3 Establish management plans on 6000 ha of secured or rehabilitated
75%
wetland, based on federal, provincial or non-government guidelines
as appropriate. Develop and refine guidelines as needed
201
202
75%
50%
Strategy 8: Evaluate the action plan components, including a careful assessment of individual
techniques and their application
Milestone
Progress
8.1 Share partners (e.g., Nature Conservancy, Conservation Ontario,
100%+
Ducks Unlimited, Ontario Nature, Ontario Ministry of Natural Resources,
Environment Canada) annual work plans within the implementation team
8.2 Report on program progress at least twice during the lifespan of the
100%
action plan
8.3 Regular review of the program by all implementation team partners
100%+
1
Source: Environment Canada 2006.
On the US side the Great Lakes Legacy Act was passed in 2005 which
provides funding for cleanup of contaminated sediment site hit spots as
part of remedial action planning process (see Hartig and Thomas 1988) for
the Great Lakes. There is legislation pending in the US Congress for restoration
of the Great Lakes ecosystem, which is similar to those efforts proposed for the
Chesapeake and San Francisco Bay or Columbia or Kissimmee Rivers. Such
legislation would be strengthening of existing programs plus some new programs. Some of these programs would address the wetlands stresses addressed
in the beginning of this chapter.
Summary
Great Lakes wetlands protection activities have sometimes taken the same paths
the North American Waterfowl Treaty and different paths the Great Lakes
Wetlands Policy Consortium and outcomes. Both examples illustrate different
strategies and tools used by NGOs international, national, and state/local.
For the North American Waterfowl Treaty, both in the United States and in
Canada, Ducks Unlimited played a key role in developing and getting the treaty
adopted. Once adopted in the United States. Canada and Mexico, federal,
provincial, and state agencies played key roles in implementation such as the
USFWSs Partners in Wildlife Program or NRCSs Wetland Reserve Program.
It also helped that specific waterfowl populations stopped declining and started
increasing, essentially validating the treaty and attached support programs.
The contrast of outcome results from the Great Lakes Wetlands Policy
Consortium is interesting. In Canada, we have a steady and focused implementation of the Great Lakes Wetlands Conservation Action Plan with great
Summary
203
204
Acronyms
COA: Canada-Ontario Agreement
GLWCAP: Great Lakes Wetlands Conservation Action Plan
LaMP: lakewide management plan
NEMCOG: Northeast Michigan Council of Governments
NRCS: Natural Resources Conservation Service
SWANCC: Solid Waste Agency of Northern Cook County vs. US Army
Corps of Engineers
UMBS: University of Michigan Biological Station
US F&WS: US Fish and Wildlife Service
References
Interview with Cam Davis March 11, 1996.
Interview with Nancy Patterson March 15, 1996.
Interview with Gail Gruenwald February 1996.
Interview with Stephen Brown, February 14, 1996.
Amacher, G. S., R. J. Brazee, J. W. Bulkey, and R. A. Moll. 1989. Application of Wetland
Valuation Techniques: Examples from Great Lakes Coastal Wetlands. National technical
Information Service, Springfield, VA as PB90-112319/AS, E. Lansing: Michigan Institute
of Water Research.
Armentano, T. V. and E. S. Menges. 1986. Patterns of change in the carbon balance of organic
soil wetlands of the temperate zone. The Journal of Ecology, 74(3): 755774.
Barry, M. J., R. Bowers, and F. A. de Szalay. 2003. Effects of hydrology, herbivory and
sediment disturbance on plant recruitment in a Lake Erie coastal wetland. The American
Midland Naturalist, 151(2): 217232.
Bedford, K. W. 1992. The physical effects of the Great Lakes on tributaries and wetlands, a
summary. Journal of Great Lakes Research, 18: 571589.
Booth, R. K. 2001. Ecology of testate amoebae (protozoa) in two Lake Superior coastal
wetlands: Implications for paleoecology and environmental monitoring. Wetlands, 21(4):
564576.
Botts, P. 1997. Spatial pattern, patch dynamics and successional change: Chironomid assemblages in a lake Erie coastal wetland. Freshwater Biology, 37(2): 277286.
Bourdaghs, M., C. A. Johnston, and R. R. Regal. 2006. Properties and performance of
the floristic quality index in Great Lakes coastal wetlands. Wetlands, 26(3):
718735.
Bowers, R. and F. A. de Szalay. 2004. Effects of hydrology on Unionids (Unionidae) and
Zebra mussels (Dreissenidae) in a Lake Erie coastal wetland. The American Midland
Naturalist, 151(2): 286300.
Brazner, J. C., S. E. Campana, and D. K. Tanner. 2004. Habitat fingerprints for Lake
Superior coastal wetlands derived from elemental analysis of yellow perch otoliths. Transactions of the American Fisheries Society, 133(3): 692704.
Brown, S. 1990. Preserving Great Lakes Wetlands: An Environmental Agenda: The Final
Report of the Great Lakes Wetlands Policy Consortium. Conway, MI: Tipp of the Mitt
Watershed Council, 78 pp.
Burton, T. M., C. A. Stickler, and D. G. Uzarski. 2002. Effects of plant community
composition and exposure to wave action on invertebrate habitat use of lake Huron
coastal wetlands. Lakes and Reservoirs: Research and Management, 7(3): 255269.
References
205
Burton, T. M., D. Uzarski, and J. Genet. 2004. Invertebrate habitat use in relation to fetch
and plant zonation in northern Lake Huron coastal wetlands. Aquatic Ecosystem Health
and Management, 7(2): 249267.
Canada Wildlife Service. 2002. Where Land Meets Water: Understanding Wetlands of the
Great lakes. Downsview, ON: Environment Canada, Canadian Wildlife Service.
Cardinale, B. J., V. J. Brady, and T. M. Burton. 2004. Changes in the abundance and diversity
of coastal wetland fauna from the open water/macrophyte edge toward shore. Wetlands
Ecology and Management, 6(1): 5968.
Champagne, A. (ed.). 1981. Proceedings of the Ontario Wetlands Conference. Toronto:
Federation of Ontario Naturalists.
Chow-Fraser, P. 1998. A conceptual ecological model to aid restoration of Cootes Paradise marsh,
a degraded coastal wetland of Lake Ontario, Canada. Wetlands Ecology & Management,
6(1): 4357.
Chow-Fraser, P. 2005. Ecosystem response to changes in water level in lake Ontario
marshes: Lessons from the restoration of Cootes Paradise Marsh. Hydrobiologia,
539(1): 189204.
Chow-Fraser, P., V. Lougheed, V. le Thiec, B. Crosbie, L. Simser, and J. Lord. 2004. Longterm response of the biotic community to fluctuating water levels and changes in water
quality in Cootes Bay Marsh, a degraded coastal marsh of Lake Ontario. Wetlands
Ecology and Management, 6(1): 1942.
Chubb, S. L. and C. R. Liston. 1986. Density and distribution of larval fishes in Pentwater
marsh, a coastal wetland on Lake Michigan. Journal of Great lakes Research, 12(4): 332343.
Crowley, T. E. II. 1990. Laurentian Great Lakes double CO2 climate change hydrological
impacts. Climate Change, 17: 2747.
Crowder, A. A. and J. M. Bristow. 1988. The future of waterfowl habitats in the Canadian
lower Great Lakes wetlands. Journal of Great Lakes Research, 14: 115127.
Crowder, A. A., B. McLaughlin, R. D. Weir, and W. J. Christie. 1986. Shoreline fauna of the
Bay of Quince. Canadian Special Publication of Fisheries and Aquatic Sciences, 86: 190200.
Crowe, A. S., S. G. Shikaze, and C. J. Ptacek. 2004. Numerical modeling of groundwater flow
and contaminant transport to Point Pelee marsh, Ontario, Canada. Hydrologic Processes,
18(2): 293343.
Danz, N. P., R. R. Regal, G. J. Niemi, V. J. Brady, T. Hollenhorst, L. B. Johnson, G. E. Host,
J. M. Hanowski, C. A. Johnston, T, Brown, J. Kingston, and J. R. Kelly. 2005. Environmentally stratified sampling design for the development of Great Lakes environmental
indicators. Environmental Monitoring and Assessment, 102(13): 4165.
Dodge, D. and R. Kavetsky. 1995. Aquatic Habitat and Wetlands of the Great Lakes. 1994
State of the Lakes Ecosystem Conference (SOLEC) Background paper. Environment
Canada and US Environmental Protection Agency EPA 905-R-95-014.
Environment Canada. 1995. Amphibians and Reptiles of the Great Lakes Wetlands; Threats
and Conservation. Environment Canada, 12 pp.
Environment Canada 2006. Great Lakes Wetlands Conservation Action Plan Highlights
Report 2003-2005. Toronto, Ontario: Environment Canada, 24 pp. and at http://www/
on.ec.gc.ca/wildlife/publications-e.html
Farrell, J. M. 2001. Reproductive success of sympatric Northern Pike and Muskellunge in
an Upper St. Lawrence River Bay. Transactions of American Fisheries Society, 130(5):
796808.
Finklestein, S. A., M. C. Peros, and A. M. Davis 2005. Lake Holocene paleoenvironmental
change in a Great Lakes coastal wetland: integrating pollen and diatom data sets. Journal
of Paleolimnology, 33(1): 112.
Fox, G. A. 2001. Wildlife as sentinels of human health effects in the Great Lakes/St. Lawrence
Basin. Environmental Health Perspectives, 109(Supp. 6): 853861.
Glooschenko, V., J. H. Archibold, and D. Herman. 1988. The Ontario wetland evaluation
System: replicability and bird habitat selection. In Hook et al. (eds.) The Ecology and
206
Management of Wetlands, Vol. 2, pp. 115127. Portland, OR: Timber Press and Croom
Helm Ltd., Publishers.
Geis, J. W. 1985. Environmental influence on the distribution and composition of wetlands in
the Great Lakes. In H. H. Prince and F. M. DItri (eds.) Coastal Wetlands, pp. 1531.
Chelsea, MI: Lewis Publishers.
Gottgens, J. F., B. F. Swartz, R. W. Kroll, and M. Eboch. 1998. Long-term GIS-based
records of habitat changes in a Lake Erie coastal marsh. Wetlands Ecology and Management, 6(1): 517.
Gruenwald, G. 1990. Recommendations of the Great Lakes Wetlands policy Consortium. In
J. Kusler and R. Smardon (eds.) Wetlands of the Great Lakes; Protection and Restoration
Policies: Status of the Science, pp. 1718. Berne, NY: Association of Wetland Managers.
Hartig, J. H. and R. L. Thomas. 1988. Development of plans to restore degraded areas in the
Great Lakes. Environmental Management, 12: 327347.
Hartmannn, H. C. 1990. Climate change impacts on Laurentian Great Lakes levels. Climatic
Change, 17: 4968.
Hecnar, S. J. 2004. Great Lakes wetlands as amphibian habitats. Aquatic Ecosystem Health
and Management, 7(2): 289304.
Herdendorf, C. E. 2004a. Morphometric factors in the formation of Great Lakes Coastal
wetlands. Aquatic Ecosystem Health & Management, 7(2): 179198.
Herdendorf, C. E. 2004b. Great Lakes estuaries. Estuaries, 13(4): 493503.
Herdendorf, C. E. and S. M. Hartley (eds.). 1980. A Summary of the Knowledge of Fish and
Wildlife Resources of Coastal Wetlands of the Great Lakes of the United States. Vol. 1:
Overview. U.S. Fish and Wildlife Service, Twin Cities, MN, 468 pp.
Holmes, J. A. and T. H. Whillans. 1984. Historical review of Hamilton Harbour Fisheries.
Canadian Technical Report Fish and Aquatic Science, No. 1257, 117 pp.
Hook, T. O., N. M. Eagan, and P. W. Webb. 2001. Habitat and human influences
on larval fish assemblages in northern Lake Huron coastal marsh bays. Wetlands,
21(2): 281291.
Host, G. E., J. Schuldt, J. H. Ciborowski, L. B. Johnson, T. Hollenhorst, and C. Richards.
2005. Use of GIS and remotely sensed data for a priori identification of reference areas for
Great Lakes coastal ecosystems. Journal of Remote Sensing 26(23/10): 53255342.
Hudson, P. L. and C. A. Bowen. 2002. First record of Neoergasilus Japonicus (Poecilostomatoida: Ergasilidae), a parasitic copepod new to the Laurentian Great lakes. Journal of
Parasitology 88(4): 657663.
Hummel, M. 1981. Wetland wildlife values. In A. Champagne (ed.) Proceedings of the Ontario
Wetlands Conference, pp. 2732. Toronto: Federation of Ontario Naturalists.
Hwang, S. and R. Health. 1999. Zooplankton bacterivory at coastal and offshore sites of Lake
Erie. Journal of Plankton Research, 21(4): 699719.
Jaworski, E: C. N. Raphael, P. J. Mansfield, and B. B. Williamson. 1999. Impact of Great
Lakes Water Level Fluctuations on Coastal Wetlands. National Technical Information
Service, Springfield VA as PB-296403, Institute of Water Research, Michigan State
University.
Jean, M. and A. Bouchard. 1993. Riverine wetland vegetation: Importance of small-scale
environmental variation. Journal of Vegetation Science, 4(5): 609620.
Jean, M. and A. Bouchard. 1991. Temporal changes in wetland landscapes of a section of the
St. Lawrence River, Canada. Environment Management, 15(2): 241256.
Keddy, P. and L. H. Fraser. 2000. Four general principals for the management and conservation
of wetlands in large lakes: The role of water levels, nutrients, competitive hierarchies and
centrifugal organization. Lakes and Reservoirs: Research and Management, 5(3): 177185.
Keddy, P. and A. A. Reznicek. 1986. Great Lakes vegetation dynamics; the role of fluctuating
water levels and buried seed. Journal of Great Lakes Research, 12(1): 2536.
Keough, J. R., M. E. Sierszen, and C. A. Hagley. 1996. Analysis of a Lake Superior coastal
food web with stable isotope techniques. Limnology and Oceanography, 41(1): 136146.
References
207
Klarer, D. M. and D. F. Millie 1992. Aquatic macrophytes and algae at Old Woman Creek estuary
and other Great Lake coastal wetlands. Journal of Great Lakes Research, 18(4): 622633.
Klarer, D. M. and D. F. Millie. 1994. Regulation of phytoplankton dynamics in a Laurentian
Great lakes estuary. Hydrobiologia, 286(2): 97108.
Kreiger, K. A. 2003. Effectiveness of a coastal wetland in reducing pollution in a Laurentian
Great Lake: hydrology, sediment, and nutrients. Wetlands, 23(4): 778791.
Kreiger, K. A., D. A. Klarer, R. T. Heath and C. A. Herdendorf (eds.). 1992. Special Issue
on Coastal wetlands of the Laurentian Great lakes. Journal of Great Lakes Research,
18(4): 521768.
Kusler, J. and R. C. Smardon. 1990. Introduction and Key Recommendations. In J. Kusler
and R. Smardon, (eds.) Wetlands of the Great Lakes: Protection and Restoration Policies;
Status of the Science, pp. 25. Berne, NY: Association of Wetland Managers.
Leach, J. H. 1995. Non-indigenous species in the Great Lakes: were colonization and damage
to ecosystem health predictable? Journal of Aquatic Ecosystem Stress and Recovery,
4(2): 117128.
Leslie, J. K. and C. A. Timmins. 1991. Distribution and abundance of young fish in Chenal
Ecarte and Chematogen Channel in the St. Clair River delta, Ontario. Hydrobiologia,
219(1): 135142.
Liston, C. R. and S. Chubb. 1985. Relationships of water level fluctuations and Fish. In H. H.
Prince and F. M. DItri (eds.) Coastal Wetlands, pp. 121140. Chelsea, MI: Lewis
Publishers.
Loftus, K. K., R. C. Smardon, and B.A. Potter. 2004. Strategies for the Stewardship and
conservation of Great Lakes Coastal wetlands. Aquatic Ecosystem Health and Management, 7(2): 305330.
Lougheed, V. L. and P. Chow-Fraser. 2001. Development and use of a zooplankton index for
wetland quality in the Laurentian Great Lakes Basin. Ecological Applications, 12(2): 474486.
Lundholm, J. T. and W. L. Simser. 1999. Regeneration of submerged macrophyte populations
in a disturbed Lake Ontario coastal marsh. Journal of Great Lakes Research, 25(2): 395400.
Lyon, J. G., R. D. Drobney, and C. E. Olson. 1986. Effects of Lake Michigan water levels on
wetland soil chemistry and distribution of plants in the straits of Mackinac. Journal of
Great Lakes Research, 12(3): 688700.
Mackenzie, R. A. and J. L. Kaster. 2004. Temporal and spatial patterns of insect emergence
from a lake Michigan coastal wetland. Wetlands, 24(3): 688700.
Mills, E. L., J. H. Leach, J. T. Carlton, and C. L. Secor. 1993. Exotic species in the Great
Lakes: a history of biotic crises and anthropogenic introductions. Journal of Great Lakes
Research, 19: 154.
Munawar, M. (ed.). 2004. Special Issue: Coastal Wetlands of the Laurentian Great Lakes;
Health, Integrity and Management. Aquatic Ecosystem Health and Management, 7(2):
169333.
Magnuson, J. J., K. E. Webster, R. A. Assel, C. J. Browser, P. J. Dillon, J. G. Eaton, H. E.
Evans, E. J. Fee, R. I. Hall, L. R. Mortsch, D. W. Schindler and F. H. Quinn. 1998.
Potential effects of climate changes on aquatic systems: Laurentian Great lakes and
Precambrian shield region. Hydrological Sciences, 11(8): 825871.
Manny, B. A. 1984. Potential impacts of water diversions on fishery resources in the Great
lakes. Fisheries, 9(5): 1923.
Maynard, L. and D. Wilcox. 1997. Coastal Wetlands, Background paper for the State of the
Lakes Ecosystem Conference 1996. Environment Canada and US Environmental Protection Agency EPA 905-R-95-015b
McLaughlin, D. B. and H. J. Harris. 1990. Aquatic insect emergence in the Great Lakes
marshes. Wetlands Ecology and Management, 1(2): 111121.
McNicholl, M. K. 1985. Avian wetland habitat functions affected by water level fluctuations.
In H. H. Prince and F. M. DItri (eds.) Coastal Wetlands, pp. 8798. Chelsea, MI: Lewis
Publishers.
208
Mitsch, W. J. and B. C. Reeder. 1997. Nutrients and hydrologic budgets of a Great Lakes
coastal freshwater wetland during a drought year. Wetlands Ecology and Management,
1(4): 211222.
Mortsch, L., J. Ingram, A. Hebb, and S, Doka (eds.). 2006. Great lakes Coastal Wetland
Communities: Vulnerability to Climate Change and Response to Adaptation Strategies,
Final Report. Coastal Zone Project A592-A. Faculty of Environmental Science. University of Waterloo, Canada.
Mortsch, L. D. and H. F. Quinn 1996. Climate scenarios for Great Lakes ecosystem studies.
Limnology and Oceanography, 41(5): 903911.
National Wetlands Working Group. 1981. Wetlands of Canada. Map, Ecological Land
Classification Series No. 14, 1:7,500,000. Ottawa: Environment Canada, Lands
Directorate.
Niemi, G., D. Wardrop, R. Brooks, S. Anderson, V. Brady, H. Paerl, C. Rakocinski, M.
Brouwer, B. Levinson, and M. McDonald. 2004. Rationale for a new generation of
indicators for coastal waters. Environmental Health Perspectives, 11(9): 979986.
Patterson, N. 1992. Great Lakes Protection and Rehabilitation: Rising to the Challenge.
Great Lakes Wetlands, 3(4): 13, 11.
Patterson, N. J. and T. H. Whillans. 1985. Human interference with natural water level
regimes in the context of other cultural stresses on Great lakes wetlands. In H. H. Prince
and F. M. DItri (eds.) Coastal Wetlands, pp. 209251. Chelsea, MI: Lewis Publishers.
Pijanowski, B. C., B. Shellito, S. Pithadia, and K. Alexandridis. 2002. Forecasting and
assessing the impact of urban sprawl in coastal watersheds during eastern Lake Michigan.
Lakes and Reservoirs: Research and Management, 7(3): 271285.
Price, S. J., D. R. Marks, R.W. Howe, J. M. Hanowski, and G. J. Niemi. 2005. The
importance of spatial scale of conservation of anuran populations in coastal wetlands of
Western Great Lakes, USA. Landscape Ecology, 20(4): 441454.
Prince, H. H. 1985. Avian communities in controlled and uncontrolled Great lakes wetlands.
In H. H. Prince and F. M. DItri (eds.) 1985. Coastal Wetlands, pp. 99119. Chelsea, MI:
Lewis Publishers.
Prince, H. H., P. I. Padding, and R. W. Knapton 1992. Waterfowl use of the Laurentian Great
Lakes. Journal of Great Lakes Research, 18: 673699.
Prince, H. H. and F. M. DItri (eds.). 1985. Coastal Wetlands. Chelsea, MI: Lewis Publishers.
Reeder, B. C. 1994. Estimating the role of autotrophs in nonpoint source phosphorous
retention in a Laurentian Great Lakes coastal wetland. Ecological Engineering, 3(2):
161169.
Ridgley, R. 1985. Ontario Commercial Fishing Industry, Statistics on Landings. Toronto,
Canada: Ontario Ministry of Natural Resources.
Sager, P. E., S. Richman, H. J. Harris, and G. Fewless. 1985. Preliminary observations on the
seiche-induced flux of carbon, nitrogen and phosphorus in a Great Lakes coastal marsh.
In H. H. Prince and F. M. DItri (eds.) Coastal Wetlands, pp. 5968. Chelsea, MI: Lewis
Publishers.
Schloesser, D. W., J. L. Metcalfe-Smith, W. P. Kovalak, G. D. Longton, and R. D. Smithee.
2006. Extirpation of freshwater mussels (Bivalia: Unionidae) following the invasion of
Dreissenid mussels in an interconnecting river of the Laurentian Great Lakes. The American Midland Naturalist, 155(2): 307320.
Shear, H., N. Stadler-Salt, P. Bertram, and P. Horvatin. 2003. The development and implementation of indicators of ecosystem health in the Great Lakes Basin. Environmental
Monitoring and Assessment, 88(13): 119151.
Smith, J. B. 1991. The potential impacts of climate change on the Great Lakes. Bulletin of the
American Meteorological Society, 72(1): 2128.
Smith, P. R. G., V. Glooschenko, and D. A. Hagen. 1991. Coastal wetlands of the Canadian
Great lakes; inventory, current conservation initiatives and patterns of variations. Canadian Journal of Fisheries and Aquatic Sciences, 48(8): 15811594.
References
209
Stephenson, T.D. 1990. Fish reproductive utilization of coastal marshes of Lake Ontario near
Toronto. Journal of Great Lakes Research 16(1): 7181.
Tilton, D. L. and B. R. Schwegler. 1978. The values of wetland habitat in the Great Lakes
basin. In P. E. Greeson, J. R. Clark, and J. E. Clark (eds.) Wetland Functions and Values:
The State of Our Understanding, pp. 267277. Minneapolis, MN: American Water
Resources Association.
Tip of the Mitt Watershed Council. Undated (a). Michigan Wetlands: Yours to Protect.
Conway Michigan: Tip of the Mitt Watershed Council, 16pp. appendices.
Tip of the Mitt Watershed Council. Undated (b). Our Valuable Wetland Resource. Conway
Michigan: Tip of the Mitt Watershed Council, VHS color video 27 minutes
Tip of the Mitt Watershed Council. Undated (c). Citizens the Essential Link in Wetland
Protection. Conway Michigan: Tip of the Mitt Watershed Council, VHS color video 28
minutes.
Tip of the Mitt Watershed Council. Undated (d). Wetlands of the Great Lakes. Conway
Michigan: Tip of the Mitt Watershed Council, VHS color video 13 minutes.
Tip of the Mitt Watershed Council. Undated (e). Wetland Regulation in Michigan: The
Citizens Role. Conway Michigan: Tip of the Mitt Watershed Council, VHS color video
27 minutes.
Uzarski, D., T. Burton, and J. Genet. 2004. Validation and performance of an invertebrate index of biotic integrity for Lakes Huron and Michigan fringing wetlands
during a period of lake level decline. Aquatic Ecosystems Health and Management,
7(2): 269288.
Wang, N. and W. J. Mitsch. 1998. Estimating phosphorus retention of existing and restored
coastal wetlands in a tributary watershed of the Laurentian Great Lakes in Michigan,
USA. Wetlands Ecology and Management, 6(1): 6982.
Wei, A. and P. Chow-Fraser. 2005. Untangling the confounding effects of urbanization and
high water level on the cover of emergent vegetation in Cootes Paradise Marsh, a degraded
coastal wetland of lake Ontario. Hydrobiologia, 54(1): 19.
Whillans, T. H. 1987. Wetlands and aquatic resources. In W. C. Healy and R. R. Wallace (eds.)
Canadian Aquatic Resources, Canadian Bulletin of Fisheries and Aquatic Sciences,
215: 321256.
Wilcox, D. 1993. Effects of water level regulation on wetlands of the Great Lakes. Great Lakes
Wetlands 4: 12, 11.
Wilcox, D. 2004. Implications of hydrologic variability on the succession of plants in Great
lakes wetlands. Aquatic Ecosystem Health And Management 7(2): 223231.
Wilcox, D., J. E. Meeker, P. L. Hudson, B. J. Armitage, M. G. Black, and D. G. Uzarski.
2002. Hydrologic variability and application of index of biotic integrity metrics to wetlands: A Great Lakes evaluation. Wetlands, 22(3): 588615.
Wilcox, D. and T. H. Whillans, 1999. Techniques for restoration of disturbed coastal wetlands
of the Great lakes. Wetlands, 19(4): 835857.
Wilcox, K. L., S. A. Petrie, L. A. Maynard, and S. W. Meyer. 2003. Historical distribution and
abundance of Phragmities australis at Long Point, Ontario. Journal of Great lakes
Research, 29(4): 664680.
Williams, D. C. and J. G. Lyon. 1991. Use of geographic information system database to
measure and evaluate wetland changes in the St. Marys River, Michigan. Hydrobiologia,
219(1): 2226.
Whyte, R. S., D. A. Francko, and D. M. Klarer. 1997. Distribution of floating-leaf macrophyte
Nelumbo lutea (American water lotus) in a coastal wetland in lake Erie. Wetlands,
17(4): 567573.
Zedler, J. and S. Kercher. 2004. Causes and consequences of invasive plants in
wetlands: Opportunists, and outcomes. Critical Reviews in Plant Sciences 23(5):
431457.
210
Chapter 8
Introduction
This case study addresses the different roles of NGOs in management to two of
the most important coastal estuaries in the Yucatan Peninsula, Mexico. These
two biosphere reserves sustain an estimated 24,000 Caribbean flamingos that
migrate between R a Celestun (wintering site) and R a Lagartos (breeding site).
Both sites are also wintering sites for thousands of migratory waterfowl, which
explains much of the international interest. Both sites are at the Neotropical
edge and illustrate management issues typical of subtropical North and Central
America. Although the Mexican government agencies play the dominant role in
day-to-day management of these two biosphere reserves; international,
national, and regional NGOs play major roles in research management decisions as well as management support. It should be noted that Amigos de Sian
Kaan, a regional Mexican NGO, collaborates in the management of the Sian
Kaan Biosphere Reserve on the Caribbean side of the Yucatan Peninsula, but
the author is much more familiar with the other two estuaries, R a Celestun and
R a Lagartos.
Regional Context
The Yucatan Peninsula branches off the eastern coast of Mexico to form
the southern coast of the Gulf of Mexico (Fig. 8.1). Mexico, Belize, and
Guatemala all possess territory on the peninsula. The peninsulas location
and a historic lack of transportation and communication links kept the
Yucatan well isolated from mainland Mexico until relatively recently. The
isolation accounts for many of the peninsulas natural and cultural differences from mainland Mexico. Transportation facilities on the northern
coast of the Yucatan Peninsula have modernized rapidly with the growth
of several economic activities. In the past, henequin or sisal was the most
profitable product. More recently, however, tourism has overtaken all
R.C. Smardon, Sustaining the Worlds Wetlands,
DOI 10.1007/978-0-387-49429-6_8, Springer ScienceBusiness Media, LLC 2009
211
212
Fig. 8.1 Map of the Yucatan Peninsula and major biosphere reserves. Drawn by Samuel
Gordon and adapted from Cartographic Laboratory, Department of Human Ecology,
CINVESTAV, Merida, Yucatan, Mexico
213
214
environmental protection though was still low on the political agenda. When
the de la Madrid administration took over in late 1982 it expressed an interest in
environmental matters and in 1988 introduced a revised version of environmental quality regulations which strengthened Mexicos environmental policy.
While Mexico has reached a stage where it is beginning to consider ecological
concerns in coastal management, it has only recently addressed the need for
cooperation between its federal agencies and the need for a comprehensive plan
for its coastal resources (Silva and Delvestre 1986). This is due in part to
Mexicos recent adoption of sectoral planning (Chavarria 1988).
The R a Lagartos and R a Celestun Preserves were designated Protected
Wildlife Refuges in 1979 and then upgraded to special biosphere reserves in
1988 under Mexicos Environmental Protection Law of 1982 (Chavarria 1988).
215
many countries. Mexico, in order to protect both its economic and its ecological
resources, has become quite active in coastal management (Euan-Avila 2002,
Clark 1991, Rivera-Monroy et al. 2004, Yanez-Arancibia et al. 2004).
Conflicting resource uses and their impact of coastal estuarine wetland
complexes are some of the reasons why we have seen increasing activity of
international, national, and regional NGOs in Mexico as well as academic
institutions. Many of the NGO actors can be characterized by their roles. For
instance CINVESTAV (Centro de Investigacions y Estudios Avanzados) is the
research university that ends up doing many of the field studies on wetland
systems as well as impacts studies within the coastal zone. Program for Nature
(PRONATURA Peninsula de Yucatan AC) has been involved with assisting
with both ecotourism development and reserve management support both at
R a Celestun and R a Lagartos as well as other reserves like Calakmul in the
Campeche. Ducks Unlimited (DUMAC) has been involved in on-site research
on migratory waterfowl both in R a Celestun, where they have a research
station, and in other coastal sites largely with funding from the North American
Waterfowl Treaty (NAWT). The NAWT also supports research activities of
CINVESTAV and PRONATURA. Also involved in technical assistance is the
USDI, Fish and Wildlife Service, and the National Park Services Office of
International Affairs. Other International NGOs like Wetlands International,
IUCN, Audubon Society, and the Nature Conservancy support PRONATURAs activities for three parks with the Parks In Peril Program (Andrews
et al. 1998). Biosphere Management Plans have been formulated for many of
these two biosphere reserves with funds provided by the World Bank. So there
are many actors international, national, and regional but little coordination
or collaboration at times.
Climate
The Koppen climate classification system lists the northern part of the Yucatan
as tropical wet/dry, AW (Wilson 1980). This area receives approximately
216
100150 cm of rain annually, with most of the rain falling during the wet season
between June and November (Murgia 1989b). Rainfall on the peninsula is
heaviest in the south. Temperatures vary little, remain between 23 and 288C
(Wilson 1980). The warm climate and the timing of the dry season with the peak
tourist season in the temperate northern countries help make the coasts of the
Caribbean Yucatan popular tourism destinations. North winds (nortes) affect
the Rio Lagartos area from November to March (Anon 1989a). Hurricane
season lasts from June to November (Murgia 1989b, Anon 1989a) and develop
at 138 north latitude. When warming has started in the insular region pf the
Antilles, hurricanes are formed, some of long duration and extraordinary
power, if formed in the months of August, September, and October. Some
cross the Yucatan Peninsula through Cozumel or Cancun, or Chetamal or
through the north coast from where they reach the states of Tamaulipas,
Veracruz, and the southwest coast of the United States.
Geomorphology
From the Maya mountains in Belize, surface elevation decreases as the Yucatan
Peninsula stretches northeast. The landform is relatively flat and the northern
tip is only slightly above sea level (Wilson 1980, Valdes 1988). Due to the
peninsulas predominately limestone composition there is little surface water
(Wilson 1980, Wilson and Williams 1987). What little there is exists in sinkholes
or coastal lagoons (Wilson 1980, Wilson and Williams 1987, Perry 1991). There
are eight large lagoons on the coast of the northern Yucatan Peninsula, of which
R a Celestun and R a Lagartos are the largest two (Wilson and Williams 1987,
Correa et al. 1989).
A coastal barrier island called the R a Lagartos Peninsula borders the northern coast protecting inland areas from the physical forces of the gulf and storms.
The same type of formation occurs on the gulf side of R a Celestun. This land is
composed of white unconsolidated calcareous beach sand, which is deposited
by ocean and gulf currents along the coast (Sauer 1967, Wilson 1980, Wilson
and Williams 1987, Perry 1991). This sand is derived from the erosion of coral
reefs parallel to the eastern coast of the Yucatan Peninsula (Valdes 1989). The
sand is deposited by a westward long shore current (Perry 1991). This movement of sand seems to have reached an equilibrium, the result of which is that
the R a Lagartos Peninsula has not changed much in centuries (Ibid.). The same
general phenomena can be said for the R a Celestun.
217
218
Fig. 8.2 Cross sections of cenote (a), aguada (b), and pentene (c). Drawn by Samuel Gordon
and adapted from Scott Moan, 1992. Ecotourism in the Yucatan Peninsula; Ecotourism
potentials for the Ria Lagartos Wildlife Reserve. Unpublished masters project, SUNY
College of Environmental Science and Forestry, Syracuse, NY, p. 106
219
Beards forest classification system (1944), Wilson classifies the northern Yucatan as primarily deciduous seasonal forest with some scrub forest areas present.
The deciduous seasonal forest is typically composed of two low tree stories, one
reaching 20 m, the second 310 m. Epiphytes are scarce, probably due to low
rainfall (Wilson 1980). Scrub forest is primarily found closer to the coast where
there is less rain. Trees reach approximately 7 or 8 m, with a dense understory of
evergreen and deciduous shrubs (Ibid.). Much of the coastal vegetation is
unique in its composition because of the environmental stresses along the
Yucatan Peninsula (Rejmankova et al. 2007).
Ra Lagartos Preserve
The R a Lagartos Wildlife Preserve was named for the many crocodiles that
once were present in the lagoons water. The preserve is located on the northern
tip of the Yucatan Peninsula in the state of Yucatan, Mexico (see Fig. 8.3). The
site is 210 km from Merida. It lies between 21 260 and 21 380 northern latitudes
and 87 300 and 88 150 eastern longitudes (Murgia 1989b).
Fig. 8.3 Vegetative communities and towns within Ria Lagartos Wildlife Preserve. Drawn by
Samuel Gordon and adapted from Scott Moan, 1992. Ecotourism in the Yucatan Peninsula;
Ecotourism potentials for the Ria Lagartos Wildlife Reserve. Unpublished masters project,
SUNY College of Environmental Science and Forestry, Syracuse, NY, p. 111
220
in width (northsouth) (Murgia 1989b, Correa et al. 1989). The true boundaries
encompass an area of 55,350 ha (Andrews et al. 1998). The R a Lagartos lagoon
is the second largest of the northern Yucatans eight coastal lagoons and is
approximately 285 km from the largest lagoon, R a Celestun. The Ria Lagartos
lagoon is approximately 3 m in depth at its deepest point (Correa and Boege
1989, Correa et al. 1989). The lagoon is separated from the Gulf of Mexico by a
vegetated barrier island (Murgia 1989b, Correa et al. 1989). This barrier has two
major inlets, the Boca San Felipe and the R a Lagartos inlet. The Boca San
Felipe is the natural mouth of the lagoon, while the R a Lagartos inlet was
constructed in order to allow the fishermen of R a Lagartos town easier access
to the gulf. These inlets are major points of water exchange between the lagoon
and the Gulf of Mexico.
The preserve is bounded on the northern side by the Gulf of Mexico Yucatan
Channel. The preserves western limits begin at San Felipe, a small fishing
village that exists within the reserve. There are other villages in the preserve,
Rio Lagartos, Las Colorados, and El Cuyo (see Fig. 8.3). There is also a salt
extraction plant and a gravel mining facility within the preserves boundaries as
well as land use for agriculture and cattle raising. The eastern border of the
preserve is the state boundary separating the Yucatan from Quintana Roo states.
Ranches and agricultural land, part of which are separated from the preserve by
Federal Ruta 295, edge the southern boundary. This road borders the reserve in
the southwest and cuts northeast through the preserve to Playa Cacunito.
Ra Celestun
The R a Celestun is part of the natural heritage of the municipality with the
same name. It was declared Wildlife Refuge by federal act in 1979 with an area
of 59,130 ha and about 79% is marsh, 11.5% includes the sandy strip of
Celestun and Punta Arenas, less than 8% include the area of the lagoon of
R a Celestun and the estuary Yalton and the large petenes with more than 150
m in diameter are just 2% of the area. Its importance lies, among other
attributes, in the great ornithological variety, above all, in the shore birds and
wetland species such as herons, ducks, seagulls, and migratory birds that come
from the north of the United States and Canada during the winter. Of special
interest is the fact that this is also a feeding area for the Mexican pink flamingo
(Andrews et al. 1998, Espino-Barrios and Baldassarre 1989a and b).
The coastal strip is distinguished by the almost total absence of slopes and
topographic contrasts, besides the minimal undulations of small coastal dunes
in the sandy strip. They are flat and low terrain, which allow infiltration of the
saline mantles from the sea, the freshwater springs, and the rainfall to accumulate. The slope of the land within an average distance of 6 km inland is 0.013%
in R a Celestun; to the south of this strip the landforms become slightly
undulated.
221
The length of the lagoon is approximately 22.5 km and its average width is
approximately 1.25 km with a maximum of 2.24 km and a minimum of 0.48 km.
Its area is 28.24 km2. Its rectangular shape is long with a northeastsouthwest
orientation. The linkage with the Gulf of Mexico is through an opening
(mouth), 0.46 km wide, located in the southernmost part of the lagoon. It
consists of a tidal channel that goes through all its length. Its depth varies
from 3.5 m near the mouth to 0.5 m in the inner area, with an average of 1.5 m,
which is the navigable portion of the lagoon.
In the middle of its length, there is a bridge that connects the village of
Celestun with Merida. Out on the tidal channel, there are very shallow areas
that become exposed when the tide is low, showing the existence of microalga
and seaweeds.
222
Ra Lagartos Vegetation
The biota of the R a Lagartos Preserve is very diverse due to the Yucatan
Peninsulas location at the overlap of the Neartic and Neotropical zones
(Correa et al. 1989, Boo 1990). There are at least nine vegetative community
types (mangrove, low thorny forest, coastal dune scrub, petenes, savanna,
hammocks, cattails, sawgrass, and mudflats). For a typical cross section of
vegetation units within the preserve see Fig. 8.4. Approximately 280 plant
species have been identified in the R a Lagartos Preserve (Correa et al. 1989;
Murgia 1989a, Sprunt et al. 1989). Due to the preserves unique environment
Fig. 8.4 Cross section of vegetation within Ria Lagartos Wildlife Preserve.
Source: Scott Moan, 1992. Ecotourism in the Yucatan Peninsula; Ecotourism potentials for
the Ria Lagartos Wildlife Reserve. Unpublished masters project, SUNY College of Environmental Science and Forestry, Syracuse, NY, p. 113
223
some of these species are endemic to the area and have highly specialized
adaptations (Anon 1989a, Comtreras-Espimosa and Warner 2004, Correa
et al. 1989, Lara-Dominguez et al. 2005, Lugo et al. 1988, Murgia 1989a,
Rejmankova et al. 1995).
The protection from the gulfs waves and tidal action offered by the R a
Lagartos Peninsula has allowed a low halophytic mangrove vegetation to
establish itself on the shores of the R a Lagartos lagoon (see Fig. 8.4). This
vegetation unit fringes much of the lagoon and is composed predominately of
red mangrove (Rhizophora mangle), black mangrove (Avicennia germinans),
white mangrove (Laguncularia racemosa), and buttonwood (Conocarpus erectus). The mangrove is one of the principle sources of organic production in the
lagoon (Bianchi et al. 1999, Navarrete and Olivia-Rivera 2002, Reyes and
Merino 1991, Rivera-Monroy et al. 1998, Rivera-Monroy and Twilley 1996,
Sprunt et al. 1989, Young et al. 2005). The particulate and dissolved organic
matter from the mangrove is utilized by the second principal source of organic
production in the preserve, microorganisms suspended in the water column.
Both of these sources provide organic matter for the source of production in the
lagoon, the benthic algal mat. This mat acts to store reduced organic matter and
provides mineral nutrients for primary production and it is surmised that this is
the primary recycling mechanism in the lagoon (see Fig. 8.5).
Fig. 8.5 Close up of mangrove root systems. Photo credit: Rick Newton
In places the mangrove vegetation blends into haloxerophytic dune vegetation composed of sea grape (Coccoloba uvifera), prickly pear cactus (Opuntia
dillenii), sea rocket (Cakile lanceolata), and the threatened Chit (Thrinax
radiata) and Kukaa palm (Pseudophoenix sargentii) (Sauer 1967). This coastal
dune vegetative component of the region has been called the most floristically
224
complex section of vegetation on the Gulf coast of Mexico (Sauer 1967). This
dune vegetation is important because it stabilizes coastal landforms and establishes the conditions for a successional progression of vegetation types on the
R a Lagartos Peninsula. Dune vegetation stabilizes the substrate base, collects
organic material, adds organic material to the developing soil layer, and provides protection from wind and salt spray.
Moving inland from the shore of the lagoon, glycophytic forest species
displace mangrove vegetation along the decreasing salinity gradient (Sprunt
et al. 1989). Mounds of taller vegetation mark the presence of freshwater
petenes among the mangroves or low thorny forest typical to the preserve
(Murgia 1989b, Wilson and Williams 1987). Species, which are important
food sources for many waterfowl in the Yucatans coastal lagoons, are muskgrass (Chara spp.) and widgeongrass (Ruppia maritima). These plants, however,
are found only in limited quantities in the R a Lagartos Preserve due to high
salinity and wind scouring.
225
226
R a Celestun in the area known as Los Petenes in Campeche. Petene vegetation is usually related to a cenote or freshwater spring. The ecosystem
balance is maintained between the contribution of freshwater and the intrusions of saline water from the bottom. Its main characteristic is the presence
of species that are less common in areas with saline water such as Manilkara
achras, gumbo limbo (Bursera simaruba), Malvaviscus arboreus, fig (Ficus
tecolutensis), pond apple (Annona glabra), and Sabal yapaamong others, and
they can reach up to 25 m or more in height.
Inland from the lagoon, on limestone, there are extensive communities of old
scrub forest with cactaceascandelariformes (Miranda, 1958) with species such as
Beaucarnea pliabilis, Thevetia ovata, Frangipani (Plumeria obtusa), gumbo
limbo (B. simaruba), beard grass (Gymnopodium ovalifolium), Ceiba aesculifolia,
Cordia dodecandra, Guaiacum sanctum, Enterolobium cyclocarpum, Lemaireocereus griseus, and N. gaumeri among others.
Inside the lagoon, the underwater vegetation is very interesting, in that the
macrobenthos cover approximately 80% of the lagoon. Unlike any other water
bodies of the state, the microalga dominates (more than 70% of the biomass),
whereas seaweeds are about 10% of the biomass. The most prominent species
are muskgrass (Chara fibrosa) and Batophora oerstedii up estuary. In the middle
and down estuary there are Diplantera wrightii, Manatee grass (Syringodium
filiforme), and Chaetomorpha linumon the lagoon edges form very dense carpets (Herrera-Silveira 1987). Near the mouth, the dominant species is turtle
grass (Thalassia testudinum).
Ra Lagartos Fauna
The R a Lagartos Preserve has many diverse migratory and some endemic
animal species (Murgia 1989b, Sprunt et al. 1989). This diversity is due to
geographic location, diversity of habitats, and interspersion of vegetative communities. It is also a coastal area where saline and freshwater systems meet
terrestrial systems. Adding to the abundance of wildlife in the preserve is the
fact that the preserve acts as an island of refuge and a corridor for wildlife
movement along the Yucatans developing northern coast. Many species have
been driven from their natural ranges by logging, agriculture, and residential
development concentrated in the Ria Lagartos Preserve.
Mammals: There are over 20 species of mammals occurring in the preserve,
of which the jaguar (Felis onca) is hunted for its pelt and alleged attacks on
livestock and people. Also the once plentiful white-tailed deer (Odocoileus
osceola), which has been extensively hunted in the region, is of special concern
(Correa et al. 1989). Other species include the raccoon (Procyon lotor), gray fox
(Urocyon cinereoargenteus), armadillo (Dasypus novemcinctus), and peccary
(Tayassu spp.). None of these species are wholly wetland dependent. Also of
concern is the Tapir population levels which have been heavily hunted in the
227
past (Brooks et al. 1997). Bat populations are found throughout the peninsula
in forest islands (Montel et al. 2006).
Reptiles: The lagoons and beaches of the R a Lagartos Preserve offer habitat
to over 20 species of reptiles (Barron and Correa 1989). Of special note, the
hawksbill (Eretmochelys imbricata) and green sea turtles (Chelonia mydas) are
endangered species, which use the coastal waters to feed and the preserves
beaches to lay their eggs. The Moreletts crocodile (Crocodylus moreletti) and
the American crocodile (Crocodylus acutus), for which the preserve was named,
are also present although their numbers are greatly reduced due to hunting and
habitat loss (Hurley 2005, Platt and Thorbjarnason 2000). The American
crocodile is extremely rare. Some amphibians such as the Rio Grande Leopard
frog are of concern (IUCN 2000).
Birds: The most abundant and spectacular group of wildlife in the preserve is
the avifauna. Over 260 species of birds occur in the region and some of these
species migratory and resident use the lagoon (Andrews et al. 1998, Murgia
1989b, Anon 1989b, Barron and Correa 1990, Correa and Garica 1991, Correa
et al. 1989, Withers 2002, Woodin 2004). The quantity and diversity of birds
using the preserve is the primary reason for the R a Lagartos lagoon system
being named a wildlife preserve by the Mexican government in 1979 and a
wetland of international significance under the Ramsar Treaty in 1986.
It is believed that the high primary productivity of the lagoon system, the
close proximity of so many varied vegetative communities, and its strategic
location on the eastern flyway account for the large number of birds using the
preserve. Indeed, the entire coastal lagoon region of the Yucatans north coast
has been called one of the most strategically located waterfowl habitats in all of
Mexico (Andrews et al. 1998, Batilori 1990). Sprunt et al. (1988) have stated,
Without access during the spring migrations to sites such as Ria Lagartos,
whole species may be lost (1989:3). However, it has been noted that R a
Lagartos harbors relatively small percentage of certain types of waterfowl
(most notably ducks and geese) as the scouring action of the wind and the
lagoons high salinity inhibits the growth of favorable plant foods (Batilori
1990).
The various vegetative communities of the R a Lagartos Preserve provide
food and habitat for many species of migratory birds. The Jaribu stork (Jaribu
mycteria), the turquoise-browed mot mot (Eumomota superciliosa), and the
occasional Peregrine falcon (Falco peregrinus) are three of the more rare species,
which use the preserve seasonally (Murgia 1989a, Anon 1989a, Correa et al.,
1989). The preserve also is home to many species of water birds (Ramo and
Busto 1993, Thompson and Baldassarre 1990, Withers 2002, Woodin 1994)
including the brown pelican (Pelecanus occidentalis) (see Fig. 8.6), white pelican
(Pelecanus erythrorhynchos), roseate spoonbill (Ajaia ajaja), and two species of
cormorants (Phalacrocorax spp.), to name just a few. The preserve is also the
only place in the continental Americas where the Greater Flamingo (Phoenicopterus ruber) nests (Espino-Barrios and Baldassarre 1989a,b, Murgia 1989b,
Sprunt et al. 1989, Correa et al. 1989, Hernandez and Barron 1989, Schmitz and
228
Fig. 8.6 Brown pelicans at Celestun outlet. Photo credit: Richard Smardon
229
230
conditions, the egg will not be submerged. Each flamingo then lays one egg on
top of its nest (Barron and Correa 1989, Hernandez and Barron 1989, Schmitz
and Baldassarre 1992a,b). After the fledglings mature they leave with adult
flamingos for Rio Celestun in August.
In addition to the aforementioned species, many species of fish, lobster, crab,
shrimp, and shellfish use the preserves lagoon and coastal waters and mangrove as habitat during some point of their cycle.
Fauna of Ra Celestun
The area is very important in terms of the variety of shorebirds, resident and
migratory (see Fig. 8.8). Among the nesting birds are olivaceous cormorants
(Phalacrocorax olivaceus) and black-billed whistling duck (Dendrocygna autumnalis). All year-round species are brown pelican (P. occidentalis), white pelican
(P. eythrorhynchos), darters (Anhinga), least bittern (Ixobrychus exilis), wood
stork (Mycteria americana), roseate spoonbill (A. ajaja), and lttle blue heron
(Egretta caerulea) (Thompson and Baldassarre 1990, Withers 2002). The
lagoon is an important feeding area for the American flamingo (Phoenicopterus
ruber ruber) with a population of 15,00020,000 individuals from the nesting
colony of R a Lagartos (Espino-Barrios and Baldassarre 1989a,b).
There are more than 13 species of migratory ducks and two local species: bluewinged teal (Anas discors), lesser scaup (Aythya affinis), Nareca americana,
231
232
Petenes were also important because they provided suitable conditions for
desirable plant species (Wilson and Williams 1987). Canals were often built to
reach petene areas. Remnants of canal systems and the existence of certain nonnative plant species such as banana (Musa spp.), sapodilla (Manilkara zapota),
avocado (Persea americana), tropical red cedar (Cedrela mexicana), and mahogany (Swietenia macrophylla) are good indicators of early settlements (Wilson
and Williams 1987).
Archaeological evidence suggests that the R a Lagartos area has been inhabited for more than 1,500 years (Anon 1989a). The porous limestone subsurface
and low amount of rainfall however made it difficult for early settlers to
produce anything but salt and honey (Wilson 1980). Salt production was an
important activity and during the pre-Columbian period, the area became an
important salt supplier and successful trading center (Correa et al, 1989). Isla
Cerritos, an island off the tip of what is now the R a Lagartos Preserve, became
an important seaport for the empire of Chechen Itza because it was a defensible
place to store large quantities of salt (Garret 1989and personal conversation
with Raul Murgia 1989).
With the arrival of the Spanish, the exploitation of Mexican resources for the
old world began. Logging and some mining were the most economically important activities carried out under Spanish influence. Exploitation of natural
resources continued as Mexico gained independence. Henequin production
and other agricultural crops were important (Wilson 1980). Campeche wood
(H. campechianum) was logged for the chemical substance hemantin, used in the
dying and the chicle tree (A. zapota), was important for supplying chicle for
chewing gum (Cesar-Dachary and Arnaiz 1984, Correa et al. 1989, Anon
1989a). Mining continued and grew in importance with addition of a newfound
resource, oil that is being developed just north of the Yucatan Peninsula in
Campeche and Tabasco states in wetland areas.
233
required permits to fish for lobster and to receive low-interest government loans
to purchase fishing boats and freezer facilities (Murgia 1989b). This greatly
increased fishing activity within the preserve for octopus, lobster, shrimp,
sharks, mojaria, mullet, and drum (Andrews et al. 1998). Most fishing is
conducted in the open sea.
Today, Rio Lagartos and San Felipe are the two most productive fishing
towns in the preserve (see Figs. 8.9a and b). In Rio Lagartos 84% of the
economically active population earns its living from fishing (SPP 1989). In
San Felipe 64% of the population fishes (SPP 1989), El Cuyo is third in fishing
activity, and Las Colorados a distant fourth (SPP 1989). Presently, fishing in the
preserve supports about 1,400 families (Andrews et al. 1998, Correa et al. 1989,
Sprunt et al. 1988).
Most of the fishing is done from 16 to 24 foot skiffs with outboard motor
(Arellano-Torres et al. 2006, Faust and Sinton 1991). There are usually no more
than two men to a boat, and they fish the gulf close to shore. During the nortes
(strong northerly winds) fishing must be limited to the lagoon for safety
(Andrews et al. 1998, Anon 1989a). Approximately 60 tons of shrimp is caught
a year (Correa et al. 1989, Sprunt et al. 1989). This activity is done exclusively on
the lagoon and may be done with smaller boats (Murgia 1989b). Lobster fishing
occurs farther offshore in the Gulf of Mexico and the fisherman use larger
boats.
The usual catch is pollack, red grouper, octopus, lobster, mojaria, mullet,
drum, and shark (Andrews et al. 1998, Murgia 1989b). In 1984, 3,231 tons of
234
Fig. 8.9b Fishing boats in San Felipe on Ria Largartos. Photo credit: Richard Smardon
235
needed. The work force dropped from 600 employees in the 1950s to approximately 400 in the 1970s and has continued to drop to just over 200 employees
(Faust 1991). In 1988, Hurricane Gilbert destroyed most of the salt processing
plant and the town of Las Colorados. Presently, the Roches have re-established
the salt factory (Anon 1989a, Murgia 1989b, Faust 1991) and have constructed
a pier to load cargo vessels for shipment to Japan.
Modern methods for the solar extraction of salt entail closing off large
sections of the lagoon with walls made of sand and wood creating pools of
standing water called salt charcas (Andrews et al. 1998, Perry 1991). These
pans allow evaporation to create a salt gradient, which increases toward the
bottom of the pool. The less saline water is then pumped off the top layers and
the salt is collected and put into piles for the final drying stages (personal
conversation with Raul Murgia 1989). Besides the industrial salt operation
there is also a traditional co-op style salt extraction enterprise in the R a
Lagartos Preserve, which supports approximately 40 families (Murgia 1989b,
Sprunt et al. 1988).
Tourism: Early tourism in the Yucatan Peninsula focused on the beaches of
the Caribbean coast, primarily Cancun and Cozumel. Any visits farther inland
were usually short side trips from resort areas. However, as transportation
becomes more convenient and as interest in the environment grows, increasing
numbers of tourists are traveling beyond the beaches, seeking out the peninsulas natural and cultural attractions.
The R a Lagartos Wildlife Preserve, with its endemic flora and fauna, has
begun to attract people interested in nature experiences (see Fig. 8.10). Birders
Fig. 8.10 View of Ria Lagartos outlet from Hotel San Felipe. Photo credit: Richard Smardon
236
often pass through the area looking to fill their bird lists with some rare species,
which inhabit the preserve. In fact fisherman often earn extra money by bringing tourists by boat to see the flamingos and other bird species which inhabit the
mangroves. In an attempt to keep tourists in the area longer, a 20-room hotel,
the Maria Nefertiti (now closed), was built in the town of Rio Lagartos and
there is now a hotel in San Felipe. Along with the foreign tourists there are many
Mexican tourists who visit from the interior regions of the peninsula. Many of
these tourists have summer homes in the Rio Lagartos Preserve. Most of these
homes are along the lagoons shore and are only used during the hot summer
months when school is out. The primary attractions for these tourists are the
beaches and the rural atmosphere (Meyer-Arendt 1991, Moan 1992, Murgia
1989b, Murgia et al. 1991).
Agriculture
Agriculture in the Yucatan has undergone many changes through the centuries.
During the early Mayan civilization, people practiced subsistence farming and
also produced food for the Mayan lords. Crops consisted mostly of corn, beans,
squash, and chili peppers. In more modern time, henequin and chicle (forest
crop) were very important crops to the world market and made many plantation owners rich. However, as synthetic substitutes were found, the crops
quickly lost their competitive value. Today most of the people living in rural
Yucatan still practice at least some form of subsistence-level farming (Andrews
et al. 1998, Faust 1991).
Farming: As the human population in the preserve has grown, traditional
family practices have changed. Families that once fished and practiced subsistence farming have begun to specialize. While some fish, others farm and sell the
produce to those who no longer grow their own. In R a Lagartos 12% of the
economically active population practices farming (SPP 1989). In San Felipe
8.8% of the population farms (SPP 1989).
Cattle ranching: Land that has been cleared for lumber and is no longer
productive for farming purposes is abandoned or put to use for cattle grazing.
Cattle ranches compose most of the land south of the R a Lagartos Preserve. In
R a Lagartos town, 4% of the economically active population practices cattle
ranching (SPP 1989). In San Felipe, 2.7% of the population practices cattle
ranching on 37% of the towns land (SPP 1989) and this is steadily increasing.
As of 1995 an estimated 7,000 ha had been cleared for grazing (Andrews et al.
1998).
Other industries: Along with the growth in fishing, salt extraction, agriculture, and cattle ranching, the expected growth of service industries has
occurred. A ship builders yard, a sawmill, a gravel quarry, restaurants, stores
and gas stations have all opened (Murgia 1989b).
237
Residential Growth
The urban growth within the preserve influences and is influenced by the
preserves economic growth. Early populations moved to the area in order to
fish and extract salt. As these economic activities became increasingly profitable, more people moved to the preserve. The failure of economic industries
inland contributed to the growing population on the coast. Statistics show that
most of the people moving to the coastal towns come from interior areas within
the state of Yucatan (SPP 1989). Most of these migrants are displaced workers
who moved into a specific town for family reasons (i.e., marriage, or moving in
with family members to find work) (SPP 1989).
Town development is not actively planned within the preserves. As in most of
the Yucatans coastal towns, development follows a functional T formation
(Murgia 1989b). Early migrants, in an attempt to be as close as possible to the
shore for fishing and salt operations, would create a road to the lagoons shore
and settle near it, the most desirable sites being on the shore and next to the
main road. For a time development builds along the coastline in each direction,
until the town limits are met, then begins to form along the central road
perpendicular to the coast. In this way, the towns begin to form a T shape.
There is some provision for government control over development in the
preserve. This is carried out by two planning documents, the Esquema de
Desarollo Urbana (Plan for Urban Development) and the Plan Director.
The Plan for Urban Development is a technical advisory document. This is only
a guideline and has no legal ramifications. This document is required for towns
smaller than 2,500 persons. This can become a legal tool for town development
if it is voted on and passed as such by leading town officials although there is
rarely incentive to do so. The Plan Director is required for all towns with
populations greater than 2,500 people. This is the legal administrative document and is a legally binding development guideline (from personal discussions
with Alfredo Alonzo 1989).
At present SAHOP (Ministry of Human Settlements and Public Works) has
drawn up Esquemas for San Felipe, Rio Lagartos, and El Cuyo in R a Lagartos
Biosphere Reserve and in Celestun, but they have been largely ignored (from
personal discussions with Alfredo Alonzo 1989). There will be no need to
develop Plan Directors for each town until they reach 2,500 inhabitants. At
present much of the urban activity in the Ria Lagartos area is presided over by
various ejidos. The ejido structure is a rural communal unit similar to a small
town (Uphoff 1985). These ejido units were a concept developed by revolutionaries such as Emiliano Zapata after the Mexican revolution (Chavarria 1988).
The new government gave express rights to rural communities to use designated
areas of public land (often areas taken back from Spanish colonists offspring) in
order to live and farm. Areas of land were often granted to family units with the
stipulation that they live on and work the land (similar to the Homestead Act in
the United States).
238
239
Fig. 8.11a Launching point for ecotourism boat tours from Celestun. Photo credit: Richard
Smardon
240
Fig. 8.11b Boardwalk within Celestun mangrove constructed for ecotourism. Photo credit:
Richard Smardon
241
242
243
flora and fauna as well as the establishment of breeding grounds, nurseries, and
other aquatic reserves.
Two years later, with the election of President Zedillo in 1994, agencies were
again renamed and responsibilities redistributed. For the first time an independent government ministry was established for the management of natural
resources including forests, fisheries, biosphere reserves, and other protected
areas. It was called the Secretara de Medio Ambiente, Recursos Naturales y
Pesca (SEMARNAP) and had a clear mandate to combine environmental
protection with management of natural resource use, including forests and
fisheries. For the 6-year presidential term, SEMARNAP was headed by a
young female biologist, Julia Corrabias. It employed many enthusiastic young
biologists in the drafting of legislation and in the establishment of management
plans for protected areas and other programs for protecting biodiversity.
In 2001, newly elected President Fox slightly modified the name to SEMARNAT (Secretar a para el Manejo de Recursos Naturales), moving the oversight
of fishing (and related activities) to the agricultural ministry. He also followed
tradition in replacing the political appointees running the agency with those of
his own administration. The SINAP formed in 1988 by the LEEGEPA lasted
until 2000 when it was renamed and reconstituted by President Fox as the
Nacional de Areas Naturales Protegidas (CONANP, the National
Comision
Commission for Protected Natural Areas), although the name SINAP continues to be used for the list of protected areas and a more restricted list called
SINAP II appears to refer to those areas involved in a new program of the
World Bank that involves both funding and supervision (Smardon and Faust
2006).
The CONANP continues SINAPs previous responsibilities for the supervision and integration of protected natural areas. Since the early 1990s, SINAP
objectives included building capacity in each protected area for recreation,
culture, research, and citizen involvement (Perez-Gil and Jaramillo-Monroy
1992). With CONANP there is a clearer focus on the protection of these legally
delimited areas while priority regions have been established for projects of
regional sustainable development; these are to involve indigenous groups and
other rural communities in the design, ownership, and operation of productive
activities of a sustainable nature (http://conanp.gob.mx, April 24, 2002, page 2
of Que es Conanp?).
The nine categories originally used by the SINAP to classify protected areas
have been transformed by CONANP into five, reflecting new international
guidelines: Biosphere Reserves (31), National Parks (66), Natural Monuments
(4), Areas for the Protection of Natural Resources (1), and Areas for the
Protection of Flora and Fauna (23). Many of these protected areas were
established in populated areas that have both cultural importance and longstanding histories of resource use, such as are the case in our study area of the
Yucatan Peninsula.
The last two decades of the twentieth century were critical not only in the
establishment of laws and government agencies dealing with environmental
244
issues but also in the formation of private organizations and civil associations, which are increasingly referred to as NGOs. These groups began
successfully promoting the establishment of protected areas and sometimes
participated in efforts to manage them. Significant examples for Yucatan
include
Autonoma
de Yucatan (UADY, Autonomous University of Yucatan), also in
Merida. El Colegio de la Frontera Sur (ECOSUR, The College of the Southern
Border) also does research on resource management and conservation biology
Threats/Management Issues
245
Other Mexican agencies of note for this case study are listed below:
SEPES Ministry of Fisheries provides fisheries and fisherman cooperatives
regulation, fisheries inventory, technical assistance, processing of fishing
products, permits season regulations for capture, and also administers the
budget for infrastructure and equipment (Valdes 1988). This agencys
function is now absorbed into SEMARNAT.
SPP Ministry of Budget and Programming approves the budgets for these
agencies. These agencies all can undertake research projects singly or
jointly in order to gather data to help establish policies and objectives
for protected coastal areas (Valdes 1988).
SECTUR the Ministry of Tourism regulates, promotes, and provides the
financial support for tourism development (Valdes 1988).
Other federal agencies carrying out activities in the Rio Lagartos Preserve
are as follows:
SAHOP The Ministry of Human Settlements and Public Works
CFE Federal Electric Commission
SCT Ministry of Transport and Communications
SARH Ministry of Agriculture
SEMIP Ministry of Industry and Mining
Most of these government agencies and NGOs alike are interwoven into the
management fabric of these two estuarine wetland complexes. To illustrate this
the following section will focus on the major management issues for these two
wetland areas and the respective roles played by the actors listed above.
Threats/Management Issues
Threats to the biosphere reserves include actions related to fisheries production
due to various factors: impact of salt drying and production operations; impact
of tourism activity; impacts of farming, ranching, gravel mining and logging;
and residential development.
246
with two dimensions: (1) many families in the preserve depend on fishing as
their source of income and more and more arrive intending to fish and (2) fish
are a prime indicator of the ecological health of the lagoon and are a food
source for many water birds. Two major contributing factors could include
overfishing (Andrews et al. 1998, Fraga 2006) and changes in hydrology
(Arellano-Torres et al. 2006, Vega-Cendejas et al. 1994) in the lagoon.
It is not clear that the fishermen mainly fish in the coastal waters with recent
decreases in fish catch. However, lobster and octopus catch have recently
increased. The use of the lagoons is mainly directed at crab, shrimp, and
shellfish (comments from J. Andrews 1998and J. Frazer 1996). Better equipment and increased fishing activity by larger numbers of fishermen are putting
increased pressure on fish populations in the area. Also considered a problem is
the focus on only a few species of fish while others are ignored (Murgia 1989b).
Season and catch limits along with protected area restrictions are widely
ignored and difficult to enforce. There are some areas further up the lagoon
to the east that is off limits to fishing.
As the lagoon is primarily a closed system, any change in water quality has
effects on aquatic populations and water quality in the preserve is affected by
land use in the watershed around the lagoon (Barbier and Strand 1998, Clark
1974, Flores-Verdugo et al. 1988, Reyes and Merino 1991, Sklar and Browder
1998). Changes in water temperature, turbidity, available oxygen, salinity,
nutrient content, and confining layer in the water column will directly affect
aquatic species (Young et al. 2005). Factors affecting water quality in the
preserve are as follows:
1. Breaches in the R a Lagartos barrier peninsula caused by hurricanes/tropical
storms and stripping of vegetation and sand by towns, industry, and hotels
which allows water from the gulf to enter the lagoon directly in greater than
normal quantities changing water temperature salinity, oxygen, and nutrient
levels. Larger breaks may allow the physical action of tides and waves to
affect the lagoons aquatic and shore life plus allowing more sand to wash
into the lagoon making it too shallow for boat use which in turn causes the
need for dredging with its attendant impacts.
2. Upland vegetation clearing is significant, in that it causes a number of
problems such as (a) removing a protective filter-like buffer which keeps
excessive nutrients and particulate matter from entering the lagoon, (b)
increasing erosion levels and allowing eroded material to more easily wash
or blow into the lagoon, (c) removal of organic material vital to the nutrient
cycle, and (d) decreasing shoreline stability and allowing for breaching.
Vegetation clearing is caused primarily by the salt operation in some areas
and urbanization near the towns.
3. Increased pollution over time from agricultural pesticide use can cause
hazardous chemicals to build up and affect water quality (Lopez-Carrillo
et al. 1996, Young et al. 2005) especially since the lagoon is a virtually closed
system. Increased human populations in the R as Lagartos and Celestun
Threats/Management Issues
247
248
Permission to obtain land and appropriate title was hastily granted just prior
to the areas Wildlife Preserve designation in 1979 (Correa and Boege 1989).
The salt company owns much of the most important wildlife habitat in the
preserve and they intend to obtain more by buying out smaller landowners in
the preserve. But with the impact of Hurricane Gilberto, the salt company
lost all of its machinery; many of the charcas are still in disrepair, and the
company is in fiscal difficulty (J. Andrews communication 1996, Ramsar
1989).
The salt operation had carried out its activities without consideration of
possible environmental side effects. This is less true today. There is a greater
sense of the need for collaboration. This is because the reserves manager is
more effective, and family members with a better conservation ethic bought
out other family members using bank loans.
For these reasons, the management of the Rio Lagartos Preserve believed in
the past that the salt industry was the most destructive human activity operating
in the preserves ecology (from personal conversations with CINVESTAV,
SEMARNAP, and PRONATURA 1989). Today there is more concern
about the amount of land converted to cattle ranching (Andrews et al. 1998,
Kaplowitz 1998).
The operation of a large-scale solar salt production facility in the Rio
Lagartos Preserve has affected the hydrology of the preserve in many ways in
the past, which is also critically linked to fisheries production including changes
in water quality caused by breeches in the R a Lagartos Peninsula and pumping
of water into the charcas also affects water quality in the lagoon.
Breaches caused by vegetation destruction allow greater than normal circulation to the Gulf of Mexico. These flows combined with damming affects of the
charcas raise water levels to the east of the charcas narrowest point. These
Threats/Management Issues
249
changes are exacerbated by periods of high storm-driven rainfall. The combination of artificially high water levels and early spring storms has devastated
flamingo-nesting colonies for three nesting seasons (19891991) (personal communication with Jesus Garcia-Barron 1989). Note, there are differing opinions
concerning this issue.
The salt company has also built saltpans in areas where prime nesting islands
were located (by Mulsunilo), forcing the flamingos and other bird species
(roseate spoonbill, egrets, and cormorants) to move to less desirable sites.
There have also been observations that heavy equipment used to haul salt
disturbs nesting and feeding birds, impeding nesting success (Murgia et al.
1989b). Most of the original breeding sites have been lost to the combined
impacts caused by the salt company (Correa and Boege 1989, Hernandez and
Baron 1989, and from personal conversations with Jesus Garcia Barron 1989).
In 1988 Hurricane Gilbert wiped out the salt operation. The owners of the
salt operation wanted to greatly expand and were in the process of acquiring
loans to rebuild the operation. Leaders of the fishing industry were worried
about the affect of the expanded operation on fish productivity in the lagoon
and preserve management was worried about long-term ecological impacts on
the preserve as described above.
Relations between the biosphere reserve management, the salt company, and
the fishermen have never been amicable. A confrontation between the three
parties made this relationship more tenuous in 1990 (Faust and Sinton 1991).
After the Hurricane Gilbert, the estuary system suffered some degradation as a
result of the hurricane and reconstruction activities. Some of the reconstruction activities have in fact involved considerable unofficial expansion.
Biosphere reserve management believed that the factory had plans to expand
the salt ponds in order to produce 1 million tons of salt by 1995. The Secretary
for Ecology and Urban Development (then SEDUE) was attempting to stop the
operation from unofficial expansion. In the summer of 1990, resistance by the
salt operation owners to an injunction against expansion resulted in SEDUE
(now SEMARNAP) locking up the pumps for the evaporation ponds. The
operation then shut off the communitys freshwater supply that runs through
factory pipes. In the end, the community of Las Colorados interpreted
SEDUEs action as a threat to their jobs and their domestic water supply. At
that time, a group of academics working with the author, Professors Faust and
Sinton plus students, were branded as SEDUE spies by some of the salt
workers union members, and it was decided to withdraw temporarily from
the village. The salt works owners creating a conflict situation also pitted the
salt workers union against the fishermens associations.
The two principal sources of revenue for workers were from work in the salt
operation, with 148 employees, and from fishing there are 105 fisherman and
perhaps 100 young men who help them. In contrast to the 105 fishermen in Las
Colorados, there are 406 in San Felipe, 920 in Rio Lagartos, and 710 in El Cuyo
(Faust and Sinton 1991). At that point both the fishing and salt operation jobs
were endangered.
250
Members of the San Felipe and Rio Lagartos fishing cooperatives strongly
supported SEDUEs injunction against salt operation expansion. The closing
of the salt operation in July 1990 resulted not only in distrust of outsiders
connected with SEDUE but also in general distrust between salt operations
workers and fisheries. Salt factory workers accused fishermen of wanting to
destroy their jobs, while fisherman grumbled that, if the federal government
were not going to enforce its own laws and prevent ecological and hydrologic
disturbances, there would be nothing left to do but dynamite the salt factory
(Faust and Sinton 1991).
By the end of summer 1990, however, CINVESTAV staff facilitated communication between the two groups, and in September 1990 there were constructive meetings in R a Lagartos among factory workers, owners, union
leaders, fisherman, and preserve administrators. There has been an agreement
to work together for mutual goals of sustainable development for all parties.
The question remains whether sustainable development can include everyones definition of that concept. It should also be pointed out that CINVESTAV has had the long-term working relationship with many of the parties and
has built up a level of trust with villagers, salt workers, and fishermen so that
they were in a good position to be the mediator for the dispute.
Although the salt company has expanded its operation, indeed, the two large
charcas (basins) have not been rehabilitated since Gilberto. The company has
constructed a pier to allow it to ship export salt. The company argued that
without the pier, there would be unemployment and it could not survive. Export
sales would absorb 250,000500,000 tons produced annually (J. Andrews communication 1996).
Threats/Management Issues
251
(freshwater upwellings), the mangroves, and petrified forest. The lagoon is very
long so boat tours can include more features or less depending on what one
wanted to spend. Tourists also go into the village of Celestun for lunch at
several of the seafood restaurants. There was very little accommodation for
overnight stays. Today this has changed. There is a major visitors center at the
bridge, large numbers of covered boats and guides plus increased accommodations within the village of Celestun.
What PRONATURA and SEMARNAP have done since 1988 is work to
organize the local fishermen and others wanting to conduct boat tours into two
associations. They sometimes fight over fares but generally get along. PRONATURA also helped them to get government loans to obtain tour boats with
canopies for shade and adjustable outboard motors. PRONATURA has also
worked with the associations to develop a code of conduct for the guides, e.g.,
standard fares, not to get too close to the flamingos, observe boat speeds in
certain areas, provide ecological information to the tourist. PRONATURA has
also worked with local village leadership such as Maria de Carmen, a hotel
operator in Merida and Celestun, to improve the amenities of the village, e.g.,
pick up the garbage and improve the beachfront facilities. In addition there
have been several collaborative projects with the SUNY College of Environmental Science and Forestry to assist with ecotourism development in both R a
Celestun and Lagartos (Galicia and Baldassarre 1997, Moan 1992, Smardon
2006).
Disturbance of Wildlife
Wildlife provides one of the attractors necessary to ecotourism and as a food
source for local people. However, impacts on the wildlife may result from even
these non-consumptive uses:
Tourist activity may disturb major species (such as the flamingos) limiting
their feeding or breeding success or forcing the species to change their habits
or location (Arengo and Baldassarre undated, Galicia and Baldassarre 1997,
Yosef 2000). One example is the ecotourists inducing the guide to get the
boat close to the flamingo flock while they are resting or feeding on brine
shrimp on the lagoon shallows. They will spook and the whole flock moves
to a different location. With the new guide association with code of conduct
and quieter motors, this is less of an issue than before, but still occasionally
happens.
Increased tourism may degrade or destroy resources needed by a particular
species, particularly activity on open beaches needed by sea turtles to lay eggs
at night or use of bright lights, which disorients sea turtles. This is somewhat of an issue at both R as Lagartos and Celestun where the beaches are
used by sea turtles. There are egg-gathering programs run by SEMARNAP
in cooperation with CINVESTAV and PRONATURA in both places plus
252
Threats/Management Issues
253
Impacts of Development
Bridge development: There are two bridges in the Rio Lagartos Preserve, which
enable the citizens of Los Colorados and El Cuyo to move from the mainland
onto the R a Lagartos Peninsula. The causeway to El Cuyo has caused some
major problems for the flamingo populations in an area of the preserve. The
causeway approaches sit too low over the water and during heavy rains it
backs up the water in the eastern end of the lagoon, as a dam would. Unfortunately, the heavy rains also seem to coincide with the peak flamingo-nesting
season during July and August. Floods caused by the backed-up water have
254
devastated islands full of nesting flamingos (Correa et al. 1989). This was first
noticed in1983 (Correa and Boege 1989). There is one bridge in the R a
Celestun Preserve connecting to the coastal town of Celestun and was recently
rebuilt.
Development on the barrier islands: The towns of Los Colorados and El Cuyo
are built on the R a Lagartos Peninsula, which forms the reserves northern
limit. Construction and continued activity on the island have destroyed vast
stretches of the islands dunes and vegetation. This has compromised the dunes
ability to withstand wind and wave erosion, lowering the protection value of the
barrier island from storms and tides and increasing the chances of breaching
(Clark 1991). There does not appear to be as much of similar modification near
R a Celestun.
This location also places the inhabitants of these towns at extreme risk
to tropical storms and hurricanes. There is no protection between the Ria
Lagartos Peninsula and the gulf. The full force of potential storms could
hit the towns causing flooding, destroying houses, and wiping out the
bridges the only escape route. In 1988, during Hurricane Gilbert, Las
Colorados and El Cuyo suffered the most damage (Ramsar 1989, Sprunt
et al. 1988). R a Celestun was also hit further up the peninsula. Studies
by Jauregui and Cruz (1980) show that 25 hurricanes have struck the
northeastern coast of the Yucatan Peninsula and that 47 have passed
within 250 km of the coast since 1886.
Increased amounts of waste particularly garbage and sewage are a problem.
Many Towns people still throw their trash out their back door (traditional
Mayan way) and it is not as organic because of the packaging and plastics, so it
is not decomposing. This buildup of garbage allows places for mosquitoes to
breed, can help spread disease throughout the community, and attracts vermin
and scavengers (Andrews et al. 1998, Smardon 1991). The primary species,
which act as scavengers in this situation (i.e., raccoon, turkey, vulture, and
rats), are some of the same species, which prey on flamingo eggs and young.
Supplying food for these scavengers increases their populations, further threatening flamingo-nesting success. This increased waste also increases the opportunity for bacteria such as Salmonella spp. and E. coli to grow. These bacteria
have been implicated in a number of flamingo deaths (Hernandez and Barron
1989, Anon 1989b), although some biologists dispute this. During a period of
3 years from 1993 to 1996, there have been cases of cholera in Celestun
(J. Andrews communication 1996).
Increasing amount of sewage is becoming a problem in the Rio Lagartos
Preserve. Disposal of sewage is taken care of primarily by outdoor latrines.
Many of these latrines empty into stagnant pools of standing water creating
prime disease vector conditions. The waste quickly enters the porous limestone
subsurface polluting sources of freshwater and adding large amounts of organic
material to the lagoon and raising BOD (biological oxygen demand) levels
(Batilori undated and Young et al. 2005).
Threats/Management Issues
255
According to the 1990 census, less than 30% of the houses of Celestun were
registered having septic systems. Although the septic systems might work
properly, the soil is not suitable for that use because of its permeability; thus
it becomes direct contamination of the water bodies. There are still wells with
fresh spring water within the village to which people go when there is no potable
water supply, which is piped overland into the village (whenever there are
failures in the system such as leaks in the pipes or pump problems). The phreatic
level of the water is less than 2 m. The water has a salty flavor and it is necessary
to boil it. Gastrointestinal diseases and dehydration are very common in
infants. The direct inflow into the lagoon is a serious problem because its length
of stay in the system is very high (about 50 days, Batilori, 1988). Thus, the
pollutants stay for long periods of time propitiating eutrophication, especially
in the northeast area of the lagoon.
Increased water use: With an increase in population comes an increased need
for potable water. As the population in the R a Lagartos Preserve has risen, it
has added to the increased drain on cenotes and petenes caused by increasing
economic needs. Overdrawing from these freshwater sources located in the
preserve is causing saltwater intrusion which makes them unfit for drinking
(Andrews et al. 1998, Correa and Boege 1989).
Introduction of exotic species: A pressing problem for both the R as Lagartos
and Celestun Preserves is the introduction of domestic animal species. Many of
the townspeople have pigs, chickens, and dogs, which run loose throughout the
towns. These animals could become potential competition for native wildlife.
Pigs and goats will eat a wide variety of vegetation and could cause problems for
vegetation management in the preserve. In the future, the preserve management
wished to introduce peccaries or tapirs (Tapis terrestris) to the preserve; they
may have to compete with the escaped domestic animals. Similarly, reintroduction of the white-tailed deer, jaguar, and other mammal species may be jeopardized by packs of wild dogs.
Many of these community development problems are within the domain and
control of the preserve towns themselves. There are federal mandates for planning and land use control, but realistically these have little effect. For townspeople in the two biosphere reserves, their only meaningful resources and
influences have been the NGOs. So, for instance, CINVESTAV has been
doing community education in towns such as Los Colorados for years
educating both children and townspeople about ecologically sound practices
addressing waste management, water management, ecotourism development,
and counter messages to combat wildlife poaching of sea turtles, deer, and
birds. For Celestun, PRONATURA has been working with town leadership
to develop methods of addressing waste collection and recycling, community
development, counter poaching messages, and even English classes for children
and grownups. Such strategies are gradually working to build trust and action
infrastructure within the communities themselves rather than top-down
management plans and decrees from the Mexican government agencies,
which had been the norm before.
256
Institutional Analysis
If we look at both R a Lagartos and R a Celestun Preserves collectively, there
are some major issues, which permeate all the management issues we have
reviewed thus far. These issues affect government agencies and NGO roles as
well. They are
Institutional Analysis
257
258
Acronyms
259
long-term work with the villages of San Felipe and Rio Lagartos to develop a
place for local knowledge as part of resource decision making. Management of
fisheries and other aquatic resources has, in some places, moved toward comanagement or common pool resource model (Begossi and Brown 2003) as
exemplified by the local marine reserve creation in San Felipe.
So, in summary, on the surface it would appear that CINVESTAV and
PRONATURA are playing subsidiary support roles for the government agencies such as SEMARNAP. There are divisive issues of whose interests are being
served. Some maintain (Frazier 2006) that the NGOs are merely maintaining an
image to further future funding. Others are maintaining that these same NGOs
are fighting to survive, given the funding shifts by major international NGOs
and granting foundations (Andrews 2006).
In reality, these NGOs are getting results and involvement of preserve
residents in projects that directly benefit them. Even more important is the
level of trust local residents and government agencies alike place in the NGOs.
This is illustrated by CINVESTAVs role as a mediator in the dispute between
the fishermen, preserve management, and salt workers in R a Lagartos and
PRONATURAs sponsored projects in R a Celestun, which got local residents
involved in activities that they previously would not. These same NGOs lend a
sense of continuity for either community or preserve management, because as
everyone in Mexico knows, elections and resultant restructuring of government
agencies create constant change and shifts in program direction and goals.
Acronyms
CICY: Center for Scientific Investigations of the Yucatan
CINVESTAV: Centre de Investigacions Y Estudios Avanzados
CONABIO: National Commission for Knowledge and Use of Biodiversity
CONANP: National Commission on Protected Areas
CPE: Federal Electric Commission
CZM: Coastal Zone Management
DUMAC: Ducks Unlimited of Mexico
ECOSUR: The College of the Southern Border
FONHAPO: Trust Fund of National Peoples Rooms
GEF: Global Environmental Facility
INE: National Institute of Ecology
IUCN: International Union for the Conservation of Nature
ISYSA: Yucatans Industrial Salt Society
LEEGEPA: Mexicos General Law for Environmental Protection
NAWT: North American Waterfowl Treaty
PROFERA: Federal Prosecutor for Protection of the Environment
PRONATURA: Program for Nature
260
References
Albert, L. A. 1996. Persistent pesticides in Mexico. Reviews of Environmental Contamination &
Toxicology, 147: 144.
Alonzo, G. M. 2007. Science and NGOs: Collaboration for the conservation of groundwater
resources in the Yucatan Peninsula. In NAS, Sustainable Management of Groundwater in
Mexico: Proceedings of a Workshop, pp. 97101. Washington, DC: NAS, Science and
Technology for Sustainability Program.
Andrews, J. M. 2006. Shifts of strategies and focus of the conservation efforts of PRONATURA on the Yucatan Peninsula: A personal history. Landscape and Urban Planning, 74:
193203.
Andrews, J. M., R. M. Von Bertrab, S. Rojas, A. S. Mendez, and D. A. Rose. 1998. Mexico:
Ria Celestun and Ria Lagartos Special Biosphere Reserves. In K. Brandon, K. H. Redford, and S. E. Sanderson (eds.) Parks in Peril People, Politics and Protected Areas, pp.
78105. Washington, DC: The Nature Conservancy and Island Press.
Anon. 1989a. Ecological Evaluation of the Rio Lagartos Wildlife Preserve, Yucatan, Mexico.
Merida, YUC: CINVESTAV-IPN Working Paper.
Anon. 1989b. Phoenicoterus Ruber Ruber in the Yucatan. Merida, YUC: CINVESTAV-IPN
Working Paper.
Arellano-Torres, A., R. Perez-Castaneda, and O. Defo. 2006. Effects of a fishing gear on an
Artesanal multispecific penaeid fishery in a coastal lagoon of Mexico: Mesh size, selectivity and management implications. Fisheries Management & Ecology, 13(5): 309317.
Arengo, F. and G. Baldassarre. undated. American Flamingos and Ecotourism on the Yucatan
Peninsula, Mexico. SUNY College of Environmental Science and Forestry, Syracuse, NY,
11 pp.
Barbier, E. B. 1993. Sustainable use of wetlands. Valuing tropical wetlands benefits: Economic methodologies and applications. The Geographic Journal, 159(1): 2232.
Barbier, E. B. and I. Strand. 1998. Valuing mangrove-fishery linkages A case study of
Campeche, Mexico. Environment and Resource Economics, 12(2): 151166.
Barron, J. and J. Correa. 1990. Los Flamencos en Mexico. Merida, YUC: CINVESTAV-IPN
Working Paper, 35 pp (in Spanish).
References
261
262
References
263
264
ParksWatch. 2002. Park Profile Mexico Ria Celestun Biosphere Reserve. ParksWatch at
http://www.parkswatch.org
Perry, E. C. 1991. Hydrologic, Hydrogeologic, and Geochemical Study of Rio Lagartos Lagoon,
Yucatan, Mexico. An unpublished research proposal, University of Illinois, Urbana.
Platt, S. G. and J. B. Thorbjarnason. 2000. Population status and conservation of Morelets
Crocodile. Biological Conservation, 96(1): 2129.
Ramo, C. and B. Busto. 1993. Resource use by herons in a Yucatan wetland during the
breeding season. Wilson Bulletin, 105(4): 573586.
Ramos-Miranda, J., L. Quinicu, D. Flores-Hernandez, T. Do Chi, L. Ayala-Perez, and A.
Sosa-Lopez. 2005. Spatial and temporal changes in the nekton of the terminus lagoon,
Campeche, Mexico. Journal of Fish Biology, 66(2): 513530.
Ramsar Convention. 1989. Ramsar Advisory Missions: Report No. 12. Ria Lagartos, Mexico
(1989). Gland, Switzerland: Ramsar Bureau.
Ramsar Convention. 2000. Handbook 5: Establishing and Strengthening Local Communities
and Indigenous Peoples Participation in the Management of Wetlands: Annex: Case Studies
on Local and Indigenous Peoples Involvement in Wetland Management. Gland, Switzerland: Ramsar Convention Bureau.
Rejmankova, E., K. O. Pope, M. D. Pohl, and J. M. Rey-Benayas. 1995. Freshwater wetland
plant communities in Northern Belize: Implications for paleaecological studies of Maya
wetland agriculture. Biotropica, 27(1): 2836.
Rejmankova, E., K. O. Pope, R. Post, and E. Maltby. 2007. Herbaceous wetlands of the
Yucatan peninsula: communities at extreme ends of environmental gradients. Hydrobiologia and Hydrographie, 81(2): 223252.
Reyes, P. J. 1986. Las Technologicas de Ecodesarrollo como Alternativa a los desequilibrios del
Proceso de Urbanizacion en la Peninsula de Yucatan. Proquesta para el uso del Sitema
Integral de Reciclamiento de Desechos Organicos en Celestun, Yucatan. Tesis Profesional,
Facultad de Arquitectura, U. A. N. L., Mexico (in Spanish)
Reyes, E. and M. Merino. 1991. Diel dissolved oxygen dynamics and eutrophication in a
shallow well-mixed tropical lagoon (Cancun, Mexico). Estuaries, 14(4): 372381.
Rivera-Monroy, V. H., C. J. Madden, J. W. Day, R. R. Twilley, F. Vera-Herrera, and H.
Alvarez-Guillen. 1998. Seasonal coupling of a tropical mangrove forest and an estuarine
water column: enhancement of aquatic primary productivity. Hydrobiologia 379(13): 4153.
Rivera-Monroy, V. H. and R. R. Twilley. 1996. The relative role of denitrification and
immobilization in the fate of inorganic nitrogen in mangrove sediments. (Terminos
Lagoon, Mexico). Limnology and Oceanography, 41(2): 284296.
Rivera-Monroy, V. H., R. R., Twilley, D. Bone, D. L. Childers, C. Coronado-Molina, I. C.
Feller, J. Herrera-Silveira, R. Jaffe, E. Mancera, E. Rejmankova, J. E. Salisbury, and E.
Weil. 2004. A conceptual framework to developing long-term ecological research & mgmt.
objectives in the wider Caribbean region. BioScience, 54(9): 843856.
SAHOP 1982. (Secretaria de Asentamientos Humanos Y Obras Publicas) Ley General de Bienes
Nacionales, Dario Oficial, Viernes 8 de Enero de 1982, Mexico, pp. 1433 (in Spanish).
Sauer, J. 1967. Geographic Reconnaissance of Vegetation Along the Mexican Gulf Coast. Baton
Rouge; LSU Press.
Schmitz, R. A. and G. A. Baldassarre. 1992a. Contest asymmetry and multiple bird conflicts
during foraging among non-breeding American flamingos in Yucatan, Mexico. Condor,
94: 254259.
Schmitz, R. A. and G. A. Baldassarre. 1992b. Correlates of flock size and behavior of foraging
American flamingos following Hurricane Gilbert in Yucatan Mexico. Condor, 94: 260264.
Silva, M. and I. Delvestre. 1986. Marine and coastal protected areas in Latin America: A
preliminary assessment. Coastal Management, 15(1): 311345.
Sklar, F. H. and J. A. Browder. 1998. Coastal environmental impacts brought about by
alterations to freshwater flow in the Gulf of Mexico. Environmental Management, 22(4):
547562.
References
265
266
tropical habitat heterogeneity (Southern Gulf of Mexico). Journal of Fish Biology, 33:
191200.
Yanez-Arancibia, A., A. L. Lara-Dominguez, J. L. Rojas-Galaviz, D. J. Zarate Lomeli, G. J.,
Villalobos, and P. Sanchez-Gil. 2004. Integrating science and management on coastal
marine protected areas in the Southern Gulf of Mexico. Ocean and Coastal Management,
42(2): 319344.
Yanez-Arancibia, A., A. L. Lara-Dominguez, and J. W. Day. 1993. Interactions between
mangrove and seagrass habitats mediated by estuarine nekton assemblages: coupling
primary and secondary production. Hydrobiologia, 264: 112.
Yosef, R. 2000. Individual distances among Greater Flamingos as indicators of tourism
pressure. Waterbirds: The International J. of Waterbird Biology, 23(1): 2631.
Chapter 9
267
268
bilateral aid agencies in North America with major programs affecting water
resources include the US Agency for International development (USAID),
Canada International Development Agency (CIDA), and the Organization
for Economic Cooperation and Development (OECD) which has finalized
Guidelines for Aid Agencies for Improved Conservation and Sustainable
Use of Tropical and Subtropical Wetlands;
non-governmental conservation organizations that have major freshwater
programs in the Latin American Caribbean region include World Wide
Fund for Nature (World Wildlife Fund), Wetlands International, and the
International Union for the Conservation of Nature (IUCN), as well as
Conservation International and the Nature Conservancy.
Specific regional Caribbean programs include
269
Examples of specific mangrove flora and fauna are described within this
case study and the previous case study (Chapter 8) as well as in Cardona and
Botero (1998), Chapman (1976), Jimenez (1992), Lugo (1990), and Lugo et al.
(1981), Yanez and Lara (1999).
270
Fig. 9.1 Location of St. Lucia within the Greater Caribbean Region. Map drawn by Samuel
Gordon adapted from CIA Web site http://www.cia.gov/cia/publications/factbook/reference.maps/central.america.htm
Specific ecological and human consumptive functions include (see Fig. 9.2)
fish and crustacean habitat (Delgado and Stedman, Faunce and Serafy 2000,
Pauly and Yanez 1994, Ramsunda 2005, Sheridan and Hayes 2005, Verweij
et al. 2006, Yanez et al. 1994);
avian migratory habitat (Frederick et al. 1997, John 2004, Lefebvre et al.
1994, Wunderle and Waide 1994);
food web connections to microbes, fish, and animals living outside the
mangal (Farnsworth 1998, Lopez et al. 1988, Odum 1982, Twilley et al.
1992, Yanez et al. 1993, 1999, Pauly and Yanez 1994, Yanez et al. 1983,
FAO 1994);
food web and nutrient connections between mangals, estuarine waters, seagrass communities, coral reefs, mangrove lagoons, other marine ecosystems,
floodplains, and montane communities (Chen and Twilley 1999, Ellison
2002, Odum 1982, Lugo 1986, Lopez et al. 1988, Twilley et al. 1992, Yanez
et al. 1993, 1994, Jimenez 1994a);
absorb upland nitrogen inputs to protect seagrass beds from coastal eutrophication (Chen and Twilley 1999, Feller 1996, Feller et al. 1999, Valiela and
Cole 2002);
271
Fig. 9.2 The mangrove-nutrient exchange system. Drawn by Samuel Gordon and adapted
from Scott Moan, 1992. Ecotourism in the Yucatan Peninsula; Ecotourism potentials for the
Ria Lagartos Wildlife Reserve. Unpublished masters project, SUNY College of Environmental Science and Forestry, Syracuse, NY, p. 112
use for subsistence food and fiber and local livelihoods (Bacon 1993,
Baptiste 2008, Emerton 2005, Ewel et al. 1998, FAO 1994, Kovacs 1999) as
well as aesthetic and cultural values (Baptiste 2008, Sanoja 1992, Smardon
2006, Turbey 2004);
as carbon sinks (Twilley et al. 1992).
Conversion of mangroves to intensive aquaculture, such as in coastal Ecuador, with attendant loss of habitat ecological services, indigenous peoples
livelihoods plus water quality impacts (Olsen and Arriaga 1989, Twilley 1989)
272
Geographical Context
273
marinas, and aquaculture or strict protection of the area. There have been
efforts to halt degradation of mangroves by community-based (CBO) and
non-government organizations (NGOs) in Trinidad and Tobago, St. Lucia, and
Barbados (Homer et al. 1991). It is St. Lucia that draws our attention because of
the roles of both a community-based association and an NGO the Caribbean
Natural Resources Institute (CANARI) and the case study does serve as
instructional for both problems and opportunities with sustainable use of
mangrove swamps in the Caribbean.
Geographical Context
St. Lucia is located among the Windward Islands on the southern part of the
Antillean archipelago. Its 238 sq. miles (616 km) hosts a population of
approximately 150,000, which is largely concentrated in coastal areas. The
interior of the island is mostly mountainous a testimony to its recent
volcanic origin with numerous valleys and steep ravines cutting through its
slopes to tumble down to the clear waters of the Caribbean Sea on the west
side and the Atlantic Ocean on the east side. St. Lucias climate is largely
influenced by its broken topography and by weather systems of the Atlantic
Ocean, especially in the seasonal passage of hurricanes. The highest part of the
island receives the most rainfall, while coastal areas are much drier. Biological
life zones occur accordingly, with a succession from the rain forests at higher
elevations to xerophytic formations in drier parts, cactus and scrub under
more arid conditions, and typical mangrove, beach, and cliff formations on
the shoreline.
The government of St. Lucia has been heavily involved with integrated
coastal zone planning (Gov. St. Lucia 2004a, 2001b, Walker undated), sustainability planning (Gov. of St. Lucia 2001a), and fisheries management planning
(Gov. of St. Lucia 2001b) since 2000. How these planning activities relate to
mangrove wetland management will be covered in the summary section at the
end of this chapter.
St. Lucia (Fig. 9.3) has about 200 ha of mangrove, and the 60 ha Mankote
mangrove on the southeast coast is the largest of the 14 principal mangrove
areas (Portecop and Benito-Espinal 1985) on the island and only one of two
basin mangroves on the island. Mankote is a basin mangrove cut off from the
sea for much of the year (Fig. 9.4) and floods at least once a year. It contains the
four most common salt-tolerant mangrove species found in the region, white
mangrove (Laguncularia racemosa), red mangrove (Rhizophora mangle), black
mangrove (Avicennia germinans), and buttonwood (Conocarpus erecta) (see
Figs. 9.6 and 9.7).
274
Fig. 9.3 Location map for Mankote mangrove, St Lucia. Map drawn by Samuel Gordon
adapted from CIA Web site http://www.cia.gov/cia/publications/factbook/reference.maps/
central.america.htm
Wetland Ecology
The vegetation on the beach includes Cocos nucifera, Sophora tomentosa, and
Sporobolus virginicus. This beach vegetation grades into salt flat vegetation
behind the sand ridge containing Sesuvium portulacastrum, Fimbristylis spathacea, and Spartina patens. Behind both the salt marsh and beach vegetation are
alternating bands of red mangrove and mixed black and white mangrove. The
mangrove ecology is typical of what we would find in fringe/basin coastal
wetlands throughout the Caribbean (see Lugo 1990, Lugo et al. 1988, Lugo
and Snedaker, 1974, West 1977).
Wetland Ecology
275
Fig. 9.4 Southeastern coast of St. Lucia. Photo credit: Richard Smardon
Fig. 9.5 Overview of Mankote mangrove and surrounding area. Photo credit: Richard Smardon
This particular mangrove has a limited value for fisheries but is quite good
for wildlife. Portecop and Benito-Espinal (1985) note that it is quite rich in bird
species (see Table 9.1), though all are found in small numbers. The most
numerous species is the carib grackle (Quiscalus lugubris), but the little blue
heron (Egretta caerulea) is found in large numbers. Migratory species such as
276
Fig. 9.6 Typical shore/beach vegetation in Mankote mangrove. Photo credit: Richard
Smardon
Fig. 9.7 Red mangrove with deeper water levels in the Mankote mangrove. Photo credit:
Richard Smardon
the spotted sandpiper (Actitis macularia), the northern water thrush (Seirus
noveboracensis), and the great blue heron (Ardea herodias) were also noted on
the site (see also John 2004).
These mangle systems serve the following functions: maintaining coastal
stability, limited fish breeding and nursery, avifauna habitat, silt trap, water
Wetland Ecology
277
Common name
American widgeon
Blue-winged teal
Greater egret
Greater blue heron
Ruddy turnstones
Spotted sandpiper
Lesser scaup
Sanderling
White rumped sandpiper
Silt sandpiper
Western sandpiper
Pectoral sandpiper
Least sandpiper
Semipalmated sandpiper
Willet
Belted kingfisher
Semipalmated plover
Northern harrier
Black-bellied whistling duck
Western reef heron
Snowy egret
Tricolor heron
Merlin
Peregrine falcon
Caribbean coot
Short-billed dowitcher
Hudsonian godwit
Whimbrel
Osprey
Black-bellied plover
Purple gallinule
Sora
278
quality maintenance, and nutrient uptake (Bacon and Alleng 1992, Chen and
Twilley 1998, Ellison 2002, Ewel et al. 1998, Faunce and Serafy 2006, Farnsworth
1998, Sheridan and Hays 2005, Twilley et al. 1992, Verweij et al. 2006). They
contribute to biological productivity by recycling nutrients from leaf decomposition (Chen and Twilley 1999, Feller 1996, Feller et al. 1999, 2003). The diversity of
this habitat type in St. Lucia ranges from a few scattered patches to more diverse
riverine and fringing mangal systems. Mangroves account for about 179.3 ha or
0.29% of St. Lucias biomass.
The Mankote mangrove has been cited as a case study in a number of books
and other studies as a case history of successful wetland management by local
community-based organizations (see Bustos et al. 2004, Hudson 1998, Novelli
and Burns 2006, OECS 2004, Polunin and Curme 1997, Barker and McGregor
1995, World Resource Institute 2000). Specific sources relied upon for the
following Mankote mangrove case history include studies by Geoghegan and
Smith (1998), Homer et al. (1991), Hudson (1998), Renard (1994), Romulus
(1987), Samuel and Smith (2002), and Smith and Berkes (1991, 1993) as well as
interviews with actual mangrove cutters plus Matius Burt, Yves Renard, and
Allen Smith in January 1996.
Early Problems
From 1941 to 1946 Mankote was used by the US military as a site to camouflage
aircraft and dump garbage. You can still see the pits that they used to push the
planes into during the day and hang camouflage-netting overhead. Access was
restricted and no cutting took place.
Charcoal Production
279
Post 1946 local charcoal producers to supply fuel wood to nearby towns,
especially Vieux Fort, used the Mankote. The mangrove continued to be
used as a local dumping area for domestic garbage and industrial waste, as
well as a site for cattle grazing and pig rearing it was the time of benign
neglect.
19791981: A youth agriculture project is undertaken at Aupicon adjacent to
the future Aupicon fuel wood plantation site. While the project disbands before
the Mankote-Aupcion project commences, it serves as an inspiration to the
local charcoal producers to enter into agricultural production later on.
1981: The Ministry of Health, at the request of the nearby Halcyon Days
Hotel, initiates a mosquito eradication program involving extensive spraying
and some clearing of the mangroves. At the same time, the Eastern Caribbean
Natural Area Management Program (ECNAMP), later to become CANARI,
undertakes an extensive survey of the Lesser Antilles and identifies the southeast coast region of Saint Lucia, including the Mankote mangrove, as a
priority site for conservation (see Fig. 9.2). ECNAMP with Yves Renard as a
principal consultant is enlisted by the National Trust and government of St.
Lucia to study the conservation and development requirements of the southeast coast region. It is at this time a group of Vieux Fort Senior Secondary (1991)
students undertook a survey of charcoal producers using the Mankote mangrove.
Charcoal Production
At that time (1981) the students found out that there were nine groups of charcoal
producers, seven of which lived in nearby Pierrot. One of the groups was a whole
family, which would later become more of a tradition involving the children as
well. For the production of charcoal, only two species were used the white
mangrove and the buttonwood. The red and black mangrove wood was not as
good for charcoal production and the red mangrove sites usually had standing
water. The larger branches are cut up and stumps are left to sprout. The branches
are assembled into a pit, which is covered with leaves and earth and set fire. Each
pit can yield an average of bags of charcoal. Each producer has several pits for
a maximum production of 2,700 bags of charcoal per year. A selling price of
$20/bag yielded a total production of $54,000 per year for the whole mangrove.
For 1995, the average production was 162 bags per month, with the price per bag
ranging from EC $2535.
Key problems included the difficulty of working in the rainy season, cutting
of trees reducing the amount of wood available, mosquito eradication, and the
effect of pesticides on workers. Finally since the land belongs to the government
created uncertainty about the availability of land access to work the area in the
future.
Studies undertaken since 1981 document that local people are using the area
extensively for a variety of potentially sustainable purposes. Unlike much of the
280
Charcoal Production
281
each working area is generally known to the others in a given season, but with
use of larger seed/sprouting trees as markers helps to avoid conflicts. Related
individuals often cut in adjacent areas to facilitate exchange of help. Cut stems
are placed in rectangular pits dug in the forest floor, about 46 m long, partially
covered with grass and leaves and then with soil, and then fired for about 3 days
(see Figs. 9.10 and 9.11). The charcoal is then bagged in old flour sacks, each
sack holding about 22 kg and selling for about EC $30 (US $11 in 1992).
Charcoal is retailed in small lots in town markets and rural areas.
Fig. 9.9 Piling up the recently cut stems. Photo credit: Richard Smardon
The three or four producers that started in the early 1960s have increased to
1520 in the early 1990s. From a loose group, the producers with CANARIs
assistance have organized themselves into an informal cooperative. Their cutting rights, tenuous at best until recent years, have been recognized as customary rights, although as of 1992, they still lacked formal rights to use of public
land nor had legal authority to manage resources.
For many St. Lucians, charcoal remains the cooking fuel of choice because
it is slow burning, easy to transport, imparts a pleasant taste to food, can be
purchased in small amounts at low cost, and produces less smoke than fuel
wood. The Mankote mangrove has been the main supply of charcoal to some
1500 residents of Vieux Fort and the surrounding communities in the southeast
of the island. The alternative cooking fuel is bottled gas, but for most households charcoal is at least as important, particularly for longer cooking tasks.
Since charcoal production was a major consumptive use of the mangrove, and
the activities of producers posed a visible and immediate threat to the remaining
forest, conservation planning was directed primarily at charcoal producers.
282
283
animals roaming along the outer parts of the mangrove and overgrazing;
indiscriminate dumping of garbage;
a mosquito eradication program;
dumping of industrial waste;
cleared areas of mangrove and decrease in tree diameter from 6800 to 1300 ;
footpaths cleared in the mangrove.
284
285
Fig. 9.11 Pile of mangrove stems about to be put into the pit. Photo credit: Richard Smardon
286
(Smith and Berkes 1991). CANARI director Renard has also summarized the
lessons learned from a participatory and group organization perspective.
Bird hunting was eliminated soon after the Mankote mangrove was designated a Marine Reserve in 1986. Waste dumping, which was a major degrading
use, has almost stopped due to enforcement actions such as forcing people to
clean up their own dumping. The producers usually report dumping and
enforcement is by the St. Lucia Department of Fisheries. The same mechanism
is used to enforce illegal cutting by nonmembers. Occasional grazing still occurs
at the mangrove edges but is not perceived as a threat. The use of the mangrove
for scientific and educational purposes started in the 1980s and the visitor tours
in the early 1990s. According to Pantin et al. (undated), the major stress on
mangrove systems in St. Lucia is illegal mangrove cutting and dumping leading
to habitat destruction, degradation of the resource base, and aesthetic impacts
affecting tourism.
287
Fig. 9.13 Interpretative entry sign for the Mankote mangrove. Photo credit: Richard Smardon
Fig. 9.14 Habitat interpretation sign along the Mankote mangrove trail. Photo credit:
Richard Smardon
288
Fig. 9.15 Interpretative sign for Mankote mangrove vegetation. Photo credit: Richard Smardon
289
290
The Mankote practice is simply based on going to a location which has goodsized stems of white mangrove and buttonbush and cutting in zigzagging strips
before relocating to a new area in the next season. There is no regularized
rotation by producers, no formal rules of allocation (e.g., by lottery), but simply
constant communication, first-comers rights within the group of users, and
mutual respect for one anothers cutting areas.
The net affect of these cutting practices, however, is that a cover of larger
trees cannot be restored at the present rate of cutting. The cutting pressure has
to be reduced and that was the reason for planting the Leucaena fuel wood
plantation outside the mangrove to reduce pressure on the mangrove and to
lengthen the cutting cycle. Together with other alternative rural development
measures, such as agricultural crops, it may be possible to lengthen the cycle
permanently and to allow trees in some areas to mature and restore the mangrove forest. In the mean time, the major issue is getting everyone to leave the
core red mangrove areas alone which has been pretty much a de facto management agreement.
One of the charcoal producers compiles figures for the number of bags produced by each member and submits these to CANARI each month.
291
rural development options and some have not. Most members have an attitude
that, in the long term, things will work out.
This history of participation and working things out eventually led to the
formulation of a plan of co-management of the Mankote mangrove. After the
area was declared a Marine Reserve, the project (CANARI and Producers)
developed a management agreement among the Ministry of Agriculture (Forestry Division) and the National Development Corporation, and the community of harvesters, making them all responsible for the areas management.
While this agreement has not been officially adopted, it is de facto in force.
On the institutional front, the project has demonstrated the need for a diversity
of groups to assume part of the areas management responsibility. However, its
principal weakness has been its inability to formalize the management agreement
among the various government agencies and the community. This is due in part
(according to Renard 1994), to bureaucratic delays, but perhaps more importantly to two sets of negative attitudes toward the co-management approach.
On the one hand, the countrys political directorate does not appear ready
to commit itself to the protection of such an area and remains prepared to
entertain development proposals including construction of a golf course
which would significantly alter the area and its resources. On the other hand,
some of the resource management and conservation agencies remain opposed to the concept of sustainable harvesting and would favor an end to all
extractive uses.
292
shared decision making. Without such support the growers association would
not exist and develop.
The second role of CANARI was that of research by Smith and Berkes (1993).
The major function of research, in this case, was to find out what was working or
not working sustainable or not in regard to the natural functions and reproduction of the mangrove vegetation. This research served to externally validate the
program, e.g., the mangrove grows back after 2 years and stem size is increasing.
It also provides internal feedback to the mangrove charcoal producers, e.g., we
know we are not overcutting with use of certain practices and this ensures a future
supply of mangrove wood.
The third role of CANARI is externalization of the lessons learned from the
mangrove wetland. Can sustainable mangrove production be replicated elsewhere in St. Lucia, in the Caribbean, or elsewhere in the tropical world where
mangrove grows? Toward this goal of extension and training, the project undertook three important training activities that confirmed the Mankote mangroves
value for demonstration and extension. First, a case study was produced that
provided a useful account of the project and identified the lessons learned in its
implementation (Walters and Burt 1991a,b).
Second, a regional workshop on peoples participation in development and
natural resources was hosted by the project. The Caribbean Association, Coordination in Development (CODEL), and the Government of St. Lucia sponsored the workshop. Third, the project served as a case study for a regional
workshop on coastal zone management held in St. Lucia in July 1985 under the
auspices of the Commonwealth Science Council. Both of these events made the
project known to the Caribbean region.
Another workshop was held in August 1998 with funding from the World
Wildlife Fund (Ramsar 2003, WWF 2003). This project used the Mankote mangrove site in Saint Lucia as a model for the preparation and testing of training
modules (Brown et al. 2000). This project has also been used as an OECS case
study for protected areas and associated alternative livelihoods (OECS 2004).
The externalization of the Mankote mangrove story to the Caribbean community has been done by CANARI, but there is greater potential for this project
for extension and training. There is a long-term commitment by CANARI to
continue monitoring as well as assistance to the producers association through
extension and research. Although this is a relatively small mangrove wetland, the
case study is significant because it pertains to the conservation of diversity of fuel
wood resources, which are under pressure in various parts of the world such as
India and Africa.
There are a number of questions that remain concerning the sustainability of
mangrove utilization for such uses in the face of local need for fuel and other
wood products (Ewel et al. 1998, Pons and Fiselier 1991). There have been
questions raised in other evaluations (De Beauville-Scott 2000, Hudson 1998)
about the socio-economic sustainability of such an operation. The other related
issue is the pressure for conversion on the mangrove for another land use related
Acronyms
293
Acronyms
ACAGG: Aupcion Charcoal and Agricultural Producers Group
CANARI: Caribbean Natural Resources Institute
CARICOMP: Caribbean Coastal Marine Productivity Program
CIDA: Canadian International Development Agency
CODEL: Caribbean Association for Coordination in Development
ECNAMP: Eastern Caribbean Natural Resources management Program
IDB: Inter-American Development Bank
IDP: Integrated Development Project
IWRB: International Waterfowl and Wetlands Research Bureau
NDC: National Development Corporation
294
References
Aguilar, R. X. 1994. CODDEFFAGOLF: los defensores de los manglares del Golfo de
Fonseca, Honduras. Revista Forestal Centroamericana, 3(9): 2732.
Bacon, P. R. 1970. The Ecology of the Caroni Swamp. Trinidad: Central Statistical Office, 68 pp.
Bacon, P. R. 1993. Mangroves in the Lesser Antilles, Jamaica and Trinidad and Tobago. In
L. D. Lacerda (cord.) Conservation and Sustainable Utilization of Mangrove Forests In
Latin America and African Regions, pp. 155209. Yokohama, Japan: International Society
for Mangrove Ecosystems and International Tropical Timber Organization Project
PD114/90(F).
Bacon, P. R. 1994. Template for evaluation of impacts of sea level rise on Caribbean coastal
wetlands. Ecological Engineering, 3(2): 171186.
Bacon, P. R. 1999. Wetland rehabilitation in the Caribbean. In. W. Streever and B. Streever
(eds.) An International Perspective on Wetland Rehabilitation, New York: Springer-Verlag.
Bacon, P. R. and G. P. Alleng. 1992. The management of insular Caribbean mangroves in
relation to site location and community type. Hydrobiologia, 247(13): 235241.
Baldwin, J. 2000. Tourism development, wetland degradation and beach erosion in Antigua,
West Indies. Tourism Geographies, 2(2): 193218.
Baptiste, A. K. 2008. Evaluating Environmental Awareness: A Case Study of the Nariva Swamp
Trinidad. Unpublished Dissertation, SUNY College of Environmental Science and Forestry,
Syracuse, NY 204 pp.
Barker, D. B. and D. F. M. McGregor. 1995. Environment and Development in the Caribbean:
Geographical Perspectives. University of West Indies Press, 320 pp.
Bernier, L. P. 2007. Invasion of Caribbean Island Wetlands by Melaleuca quinquenervia:
Ecology and management of Alien Wetlands. In Fort Lauderdale, Florida: USDA Agricultural Research Service Archives 1PLR.
Blohm, C. and F. Pannier. 1989. Manglares. Editorial Ex Libris, Caracas.
Bossi, R. and G. Cintron. 1990. Mangroves of the Wider Caribbean. Nairobi, Kenya: Caribbean Conservation Association, The Pano Institute and United Nations Environment
Programme, 33 pp.
Brander, L. M., J. G. M. Florax, and J. E. Mermaat. 2006. The empirics of wetland valuation: a
comprehensive summary and a meta-analysis of the literature. Environmental and Resource
Economics, 33(2): 223250.
Brown, N. A., Y. Renard, and A. Smith. 2000. A Guide to Teaching Participatory and Collaborative Approaches to Natural Resource Management.Vieux Fort, St. Lucia: CANARI Technical
Report No. 267.
Bucher, E., G. Castro, and V. Floris. 1997. Freshwater Ecosystem Conservation: Towards a
Comprehensive Water Resources Management Strategy, Washington, DC: Inter-American
Development Bank Paper no. ENV-114, 42 pp.
References
295
Bustos, B., N. Borregaard, and M. Stilwell. 2004. The Use of Economic Instruments in
Environmental Policy: Opportunities and Challenges, UN Environmental Program, Division
of Technology, Industry and Economics, Economics and Trade Unit, UNEP Program/
Earthprint, pp. 104106.
Burt, M., interview in Vieux -Fort, St. Lucia, West Indies, January 27, 1996.
De Beauville-Scott, S. 2000. A preliminary assessment of the Basin of the Mankote Mangrove,
Saint Lucia, West Indies. Cave Hill, Barbados: Natural Resource management Program,
Department of Natural Resource management, Faculty of Science and Technology (unpublished Draft).
Cardona, P. and L. Botero. 1998. Soil characteristics and vegetative structure in a heavily
deteriorated mangrove forest in the Caribbean coast of Colombia. Biotropica 30(1): 2434.
Castro, G. 1995. A Freshwater Initiative for Latin America and the Caribbean. Unpublished
Report, World Wildlife Fund, 23 pp.
Chapman, V. J. 1976. Mangrove Vegetation. Valduz, Crammer.
Chen, R. and R. R. Twilley. 1998. Gap dynamic model of mangrove forest development along
gradients of soil salinity and nutrient resources. Journal of Ecology, 86(1): 3751.
Chen, R. and R. R. Twilley. 1999. A simulation model organic matter and nutrient accumulation in mangrove wetland soils. Biogeochemistry, 44(1): 93118.
Cintron, M. G. and Y. N. Schaefer. 1992. Ecology and management of the worlds mangroves.
In U. Seeliger (ed.) Coastal Plant Communities of Latin America, pp. 233258. San Diego,
CA: Academic Press.
Corredor, J. E., R. W. Havarth, R. R. Twilley, and J. M. Morell. 1999. Nitrogen cycling and
anthropogenic impact in the tropical inter-American seas. Biogeochemistry, 46 (13): 163178.
Creary, M. 2003. Methodologies, Tools and Best Practices for Managing information for DecisionMaking on Sustainable Development in the Caribbean SIDS. Kingston, Jamaica: University of
the West Indies, Centre for Environment and Development (UWICED), 27pp.
Davidson, I. and M. Gauthier. 1993. Wetland Conservation in Central America. Report Number
93-3, Ottawa, ON: North American Wetland Conservation Council (Canada), 87pp.
Delgado, P. and S.-M. Stedman. Undated. The US Caribbean Region: Wetlands and Fish;
A Vital Connection. Silver Spring, MD: NOAA Fisheries, Office of Habitat Conservation.
Dinerstein, E, D. M. Olson, D. J. Graham, A. L. Webster, S. A. Primm, M. P. Bookbinder,
and G. Ledec. 1995. A Conservation Assessment of the Terrestrial Eco-regions of Latin America
and the Caribbean. Washington, DC: World Wildlife Fund and World Bank, 129pp plus
maps.
Ellison, A. M. 2000. Mangrove restoration: Do we know enough? Restoration Ecology, 8(3):
219229.
Ellison, A. M. 2002. Macroecology of mangroves: Large-scale patterns and processes in
tropical coastal forests. Trees Structure and Function, 16(23): 181194.
Ellison, A. M. and E. J. Farnsworth. 1996. Anthropogenic disturbance of Caribbean mangrove ecosystems: past impacts, present trends, and future predictions. Biotropica, 28(4A):
549565.
Ellison, A. M. and E. J. Farnsworth. 1997. Simulated sea level change alters anatomy, physiology, growth, and reproduction of red mangrove (Rhizophora mangle L.). Oecologia, 112(4):
435446.
Emerton. L. (ed.). 2005. Values and Rewards: Counting and Capturing Ecosystem Water Services
for Sustainable Development. Sri Lanka, Colombo: IUCN Water, Nature and Economics
Technical Paper no. 1, The World Conservation Union, Ecosystems and Livelihoods Group
Asia.
Ewel, K. C., R. R. Twilley and J. E. Org. 1998. Different kinds of mangrove forests provide
different goods and services. Global Ecology and Biogeography Letters, 7(1): 8394.
FAO (Food and Agriculture Organization). 1994. Mangrove Forest Management Guidelines.
Rome Italy, FAO Forestry Paper 117, 319 pp.
296
Farnsworth, E. J. 1998. Issues of spatial, taxonomic and temporal scale in delineating links
between mangrove diversity and ecosystem function. Global Ecology and Biogeography
Letters, 7(1): 1525.
Faunce, C. H. and J. E. Serafy. 2006. Mangroves as fish habitat: 50 years of field studies.
Marine Ecology Progress Series, 318: 118.
Feller, L. C. 1996. Effects of nutrient enrichment on leaf anatomy of Dwarf Rhizophora
Mangle L. (Red Mangrove). Biotropica, 28(1): 1322.
Feller, L. C., K. L. McKee, D. F. Whigham, and J. P. ONeill. 2003. Nitrogen vs. phosphorous
limitation across an ecoternal gradient in a mangrove forest. Biogeochemistry, 62(2): 145175.
Feller, I. C., D. F. Whigham, J. P. ONeill, and K. L. McKee. 1999. Effects of nutrient
enrichment on within-stand cycling in a mangrove forest. Ecology, 80(7): 21932205.
Frederick, P. C., J. Correa, C. Luthin, and M. Spaulding. 1997. The importance of the
Caribbean coastal wetlands to Nicaragua and the Honduras to Central American populations of water birds and Jabiru storks (Jabiru mycteria). Journal of Field Ornithology,
68(2): 287295.
Geoghegan, T. and A. H. Smith. 1998. Conservation and sustainable livelihoods; Collaborative
management of the Mankote Mangrove, St. Lucia: Community Participation in Forest management. Vieux Fort, St. Lucia: CANARI.
Goodbody, I. and E. M. Thomas-Hope (eds.). 2002. Natural Resource Management for Sustainable Development in the Caribbean. Canoe Press, 416 pp.
Government of St. Lucia. 2004a. Coastal Zone Management in St. Lucia: Policy Guidelines
and Selected Projects. Vieux-Fort: Government of St. Lucia.
Government of St. Lucia. 2004b. Draft Final Report. To Review the Implementation of the
Barbados Programme of Action (BPOA). Vieux-Fort: Ministry of Physical Development,
Environment and Housing, Government of St. Lucia, Executive Summary, pp. 112.
Government of St. Lucia. 2001a. Plan for Managing the Fisheries of St. Lucia. Vieux-Fort:
Government of St. Lucia.
Government of St. Lucia. 2001b. Chapter 3. Current Coastal Area Management Issues. In
Integrating the Management of Watersheds and Coastal Areas in St. Lucia. Vieux-Fort:
Government of St. Lucia, pp. 5081.
Hamilton, L. S. and S. C. Snedaker (eds.). 1984. Handbook for Mangrove Area Management.
Honolulu, HI: United Nations Environment Programme and East-West Center, Environment and Policy Institute, 123 pp.
Homer, F., Y. St. Hill, and Y. Renard. 1991. Management of coastal wetlands: The role
of community based on nongovernmental organizations. Vieux Fort, St. Lucia,
WI: CANARI Communication no. 16, Caribbean Natural Resources Institute
(CANARI), 9pp.
Hudson, B. 1998. A Socio-Economic Study of the Community Based management of Mangrove Resources in St. Lucia. In. Crossing Boundaries. 7th Annual Conference of Intl.
Assoc. for the Study of Common Property. Vancouver, British Columbia, 28pp.
Imbat, D., A. Rousteau, and D. Scherrer. 2000. Ecology of mangrove growth and recovery in
the Lesser Antilles: State of knowledge and basis for restoration projects. Restoration
Ecology, 8(3): 230236.
Jimenez, J. A. 1992. Mangrove forests of the Pacific Coast of Central America. In U. Seeliger (ed.)
Coastal Plant Communities of Latin America, pp. 259267. San Diego, CA: Academic Press.
Jimenez, J. A. 1994a. Los Manglares del Pacifico Centroamericana. Heredia, Costa Rica:
Editorial Fundacion UNA, 336 pp.
Jimenez, J. A. 1994b. Bosques de manglares en la Costa Pacifica de America Central. Revista
Forestal Centroamericana, 3(9): 1317.
John, C. L. 2004. Migrant Bird Records for Saint Lucia, West Indies. Vieux, Fort, St. Lucia:
CANARI.
Kovacs, J. M. 1999. Assessing mangrove use at the local scale. Landscape and Urban Planning,
43: 201208.
References
297
298
Polunin, N. and L. M. Curme. 1997. World Who is Who and Does What in Environment and
Conservation. James and James/Earthscan.
Pons, L. J. and J. L. Fiselier. 1991. Sustainable development of mangroves. Landscape and
Urban Planning, 20: 103109.
Portecop, J. and E. Benito-Espinal. 1985. The Mangroves of St. Lucia: A Preliminary Survey.
Vieux-Fort, St. Lucia, WI: ECNAMP, pp. 43454.
Ramsar. 2003. CANARI Completes WFF Project on Participatory Management Training.
Gland, Switzerland: Ramsar Convention Secretariat.
Ramsunda, R. H. 2005. The distribution and abundance of wetland icthyofauna and exploitation of fisheries of the Godineau Swamp, Trinidad-Case Study. Revista de Biologa Tropical,
53(1): 113.
Renard, Y., interview in Vieux-Fort, St. Lucia, West Indies, January 27, 1996.
Renard, Y. 1994. Community Participation in St. Lucia. Number 2 in Community and the
Environment; Lessons from the Caribbean. Fort-Vieux, St. Lucia: A series by the Panos
Institute and the Caribbean Natural Resources Institute (CANARI).
Rivera-Monroy, V. H., R. R. Twilley, D. Bone, D. L. Childers, C. Coronado-Molina, I. C. Feller,
J. Herrera-Silveira, R. Jaffe, E. Mancera, E. Rejmankova, J. E. Salisbury, and E. Weil. 2004.
A conceptual framework to develop long-term ecological research and management objectives
in the wider Caribbean region. BioScience, 54(9): 843856.
Romulus, G. 1987. Micro-Study of Charcoal Production in the Mankote Mangrove with an
Evaluation of a Conservation Strategy for Sustainable Development. Barbados: Centre for
Resource Management and Environmental Studies, University of West Indies, Cave Hill
Campus.
Rosenberg, J. and L. L. Thomas. 2005. Participating or just talking: Sustainable development
councils and the implementation of Agenda 21. Global Environmental Politics, 5(2): 6187.
Samuel, N. and A. Smith. 2000. Popular Knowledge and Science: Using the Information that
Counts in Managing Use of a Mangrove in St. Lucia, West Indies. Paper Presented at:
Quebec 2000 Millennium Wetland Event, Quebec, 612 August 2000. Fort Vieux, St.
Lucia: CANARI Communication no. 278, 5 pp.
O. A. GuevaraMancera, and G. A. Ulloa-Delgado.
Sanchez-Paez, H., R. Alvarez-Leon,
2000. Hacia la Recuperacion de los Manglares del Carbe de Columbia. Santa Fe de Bogota,
Columbia: Impresos Panamericana, 294 pp.
Sanoja, M. 1992. Wetland Ecosystems and the management of cultural heritage. In A. E. Lugo
and B. Bayle (eds.) Wetland Management in the Caribbean and the Role of Forestry in the
Economy. New Orleans, LA: USDA Forest Service, Southern Forest Station, pp. 6673.
Scott, D. A. and M. Carbonell. 1986. Directory of Neotropical Wetlands. Cambridge, UK:
International Waterfowl and Wetlands Research Bureau, Slimbridge and IUCN.
SEDU, Dept. of Economics, University of West Indies. 2002. Synopsis of the Study of the
Insertion of Environmental Management in Sartorial Polices; The Tourism Case in the
Caribbean. Produced by SEDU, Department of Economics, University of West Indies,
Trinidad and Tobago for Inter-American Development Bank Regional Policy Dialogue,
Washington, DC.
Sheridan, P. and C. Hayes. 2005. Are mangroves nursery habitat for transient fishes and
decapods? Wetlands, 23(2): 449458.
Smardon, R. C. 2006. Heritage values and functions of wetlands in Southern Mexico. Landscape and Urban Planning, 74(34): 296312.
Smith, A., interview in Vieux -Fort, St. Lucia, West Indies, January 26, 1996.
Smith, A. H. and F. Berkes. 1993. Community based use of mangrove resources in St. Lucia.
International Journal of Environmental Studies, 43: 123131.
Smith, A. H. and F. Berkes. 1991. Solutions to the Tragedy of the Commons: Sea urchin
management in St. Lucia, West Indies. Environmental Conservation, 18(2): 131135.
Snedaker, S. C. 1995. Mangroves and climate change in the Florida and Caribbean region:
Scenarios and hypotheses. Hydrobiologia, 295(13): 4349.
References
299
300
Yanez, A. A., A. L. Lara Dominguez, and J. W. Day Jr. 1983. Interactions between mangrove
and seagrass habitats mediated by estuarine nekton assemblages; Coupling of primary and
secondary production. Hydrobiologia, 264: 112.
Yanez, A. A., A. L. Lara Dominguez, and D. Pauly. 1994. Coastal lagoons as fish habitats. In
B. J. Kjerfve (ed.) Coastal Lagoon Processes, pp. 363376. The Netherlands, Amsterdam:
Elsevier.
Chapter 10
Introduction
Faced with a loss of 50% of the worlds wetlands plus increasing stress on the
remaining wetlands (Maltby 1986, Millennium Ecosystem Assessment 2005a),
it is time to review the eight previous case studies for lessons learned and any
wetland management innovations that could be applicable to other wetland
systems and other regions of the world. The focus of this final chapter will be to
address these issues as well as to offer any guidance for sustainable wetland
management from an international perspective.
From Table 10.1 we can see a number of case studies ranging from coastal
estuarine wetlands to riverine systems to lake-related wetland systems. Some
are very large scale wetland systems such as the Wadden Sea (Chapter 2) and the
Great Lakes coastal wetlands (Chapter 7) to relatively small wetland systems
such as the Mankote mangrove (Chapter 9) and Kolkata wetlands (Chapter 5).
Stakeholder Roles
In terms of government stakeholders, we see a range of scale of government
policies from the elaborate Tripartite Wadden Sea Agreement and the US/
Canada/Mexico Great Lakes wetland programs such as the North American
Wetlands Treaty to almost no wetland policy such as Vietnam. Vietnam has one
or two Ramsar wetlands but almost no wetland management policy. In almost
all instances we can see the value of the guidance provided by the Ramsar
Convention and Bureau as well as by the IUCN biosphere reserve program.
International NGOs include World Wildlife Foundation that is very active in
Africa, Europe, Asia, and the Americas. Some international NGOs are quasigovernmental such as the Ramsar Convention Bureau and the IUCN. Others
are more focused such as the International Crane Foundation that highly values
crane habitat maintenance and the World Bank which occasionally provides
funding for the Kolkata wetlands fisheries project or biosphere reserve management plans for Mexico.
R.C. Smardon, Sustaining the Worlds Wetlands,
DOI 10.1007/978-0-387-49429-6_10, Springer ScienceBusiness Media, LLC 2009
301
Intern. Crane
Foundation IUCN
Brehm Fund
WWWG
WWF/Zambia U. of
Zambia
WWF/Greece
Management innovations
Thessaloniki Com on
wetlands Joint Ministerial
Decision (JMD) Red Alert
Prog
local Chiefs dist Councils
Formal partnerships
sugar industry/energy/
ZAMA/chiefs/Tourism
firms
MFCS Multiuse urban
wetlands for PUBLIC
WQ treatment, fisheries,
agri. nature park
Dong Thop Province
Leadership negotiated
mgmt agreement
hydrologic Restoration
302
10 Review of Wetland Management Roles, Functions, and Innovations
CANARI> WWF
(funding)
Ducks Unlimited GL
Wetlands Policy
Consortium
(GLWPC)
PRONATURA
CINVESTAV Town of
San Felipe Town of
Celestun Local fisherman
ACADG ECNAMP
NGOs/CBOs
Management innovations
Stakeholder Roles
303
304
National or regional NGOs provide key support roles such as PRONATURA for biosphere reserve management and ecotourism development in
Mexico or WWF Greeces support of the Red Alert Project in the Axios
River Delta wetlands. There are often issues of who controls the funds and
project management especially between big international NGOs and national/
regional NGOs. For instance in Latin America and the Caribbean, WWF has
shifted their strategic role from direct project management to encourage others
to take on project management and/or funding.
Another key stakeholder is academia or national or state universities. The
role is that of researcher or developer of management technology, which is then
utilized by the government, NGO, or CBO. A good illustration of this is the
early work by the WWWG from Hanoi University on the Saurus Crane habitat
in Tram Chin Nature Reserve in Vietnam or the University of Zambias early
and continuing work on the ecology of Kafue Flats in Zambia.
At the local level, we have community-based organizations, which, to this
author, are the real story with wetland management in many cases. Excellent
examples are the Mudialy Fishermans Cooperative Society that oversees aquaculture production in the Kolkata lagoon wetlands to the Mangrove Producers
Association in the Mankote mangrove in Saint Lucia, West Indies. Sometimes
local initiatives are less formal, such as the leadership shown by the DongThop
Province for restoring parts of the Mekong Delta in Vietnam and the fisherman/residents creating the San Felipe Marine Reserve within the Ria Lagartos
Biosphere Reserve in Mexico.
This brings us to the role of local residents and management of protected areas.
A brief history is presented below but a much more elaborate account of the
international biosphere reserve system management can be seen in Batisse (1996),
McNeeley (1999), UNESCO (1984, 1995), and Smardon and Faust (2006).
305
306
donors that are very much concerned with regional or even international
habitat/species protection issues. A regional or local NGO, in many cases,
must balance habitat/protection goals with local sustainability issues of a
local human resident population. Hence, there is a potential management
conflict. This is well illustrated by the International Crane Foundations work
with Tram Chim Wildlife Preserve in the Mekong Delta, Vietnam, in Chapter 6.
ICF was very much interested in crane habitat restoration while the local
residents were interested in fisheries, rice, and Melaleuca forestry restoration.
It was because of the painstaking negotiations for development of the management plan that all functions were allowed to be realized.
The other major issue is sustainable or wise use of wetlands for food, fiber,
and other human renewable resource use vs. wetland habitat preservation/
restoration (Smart and Kanters 1991). In North America we are much interested in the control of exotic vegetation and species that do not (ecologically)
belong in a particular wetland community type. In many places in the world,
substantially altered wetlands are heavily utilized for food and/or fiber production or may be permanently developed. Examples include the Kolkata wetlands
in Chapter 5, which are used for sewage treatment plus pisciculture plus
agriculture or otherwise lost to land development; or the Mankote mangrove
in Chapter 9, which is heavily utilized for charcoal production when under
constant threat of development of other uses by the local port authority. So the
operative phrase may be use it or lose it for many areas of the world where
there is this constant conversion or development threats.
This type of pressure even happens for Ramsar wetlands. The author was
amazed at the general ecosystem health threats to the Axios River Delta wetlands in Greece in Chapter 4 as well as the Ria Lagartos lagoon in San Felipe,
Yucatan, Mexico, in Chapter 8. Even combining aspects of biosphere reserve
management, Ramsar protection, and other international and national environmental protection measures may not be enough to protect wetlands. Maybe
there should be an international classification system that recognizes a range of
sustainable uses, stakeholders, and ecosystem integrity of the wetland systems
(see Groot 1992, Turner et al. 2000).
307
308
When the author started this effort in 1990, he had no way of knowing if
some of the case studies would result in irresolvable problems and dead ends.
Successful or sustainable wetland management practices could become unsustainable or worse. The author does not think any of the case studies, ended at
the time this book was finished, was truly negative with no redeeming characteristics. Even the direst of situations later resulted in organizations taking
different paths and trying new approaches. This is a very strong message.
References
309
Acronyms
BINGO: Big International NGO
CANARI: Caribbean Natural Resources Institute
CBO: community-based organization
CINVESTAV: Centre de Investigacions Y Estudios Avanzados
ICF: International Crane Foundation
IUCN: Union for the Conservation of Nature
NGO: non-government organization
PRONATURA: Program for Nature
UNESCO: United Nations Program for Environment, Society and Culture
UNEP: United Nations Environment Program
WWF: World Wildlife Fund
WWWG: Wetlands Working Group University of Vietnam
References
Baptiste, A. K. 2008. Evaluating Environmental Awareness: A Case Study of the Nariva
Swamp Trinidad. Unpublished Dissertation, SUNY College of Environmental Science
and Forestry, Syracuse, NY, 204 pp.
Barbier, E. B. 1993. Sustainable use of wetlands: Valuing tropical wetland benefits. The
Geographical Journal, 159: 2232.
Barbier, E. B., M. Acreman, and D. Knowler 1997. Economic Valuation of Wetlands: A Guide
for Policy Makers and Planners. Gland, Switzerland: Ramsar Convention Bureau.
Bardecki, M. J. 1998. Wetlands and Economics: An Annotated Review of the Literature, 19881998. Ontario: Environment Canada.
Batisse, M. 1996. Biosphere reserves and regional planning: A prospective vision. Natural
Resources, 32(3): 2030.
Beltran, E. 1949. La proteccion de la natueraleza: Principias y problemas. Mexico: Secretaria
de Educacion Publica.
Brander, L. M., R. J. G. M. Florax, and J. E. Verman. 2003. The Empirics of Wetland
Valuation: A Comprehensive Summary and Meta-Analysis of the Literature. Institute for
Environmental Studies. Amsterdam: Vrije University.
Bustos, B., N. Borregaard, and M. Stilwell. 2004. The Use of Economic Instruments in
Environmental Policy: Opportunities and Challenges, UNEP, Division of Technology,
Industry and Economics, Economics and Trade Unit, UNEP/Earthprint, pp. 104106.
Costanza, R., R. dArge, R. de Groot, S. Farber, M. Grasso, B. Hannon, K. Limburg, S.
Naeem, R. V. ONeill, J. Paruelo, R. G. Roskin, P. Sutton, and M. van den Belt. 1997. The
value of the worlds ecosystem services and natural capitol. Nature, 387: 253260.
Drijver, C. A. 1991. Peoples participation in environmental projects in developing countries.
Landscape and Urban Planning, 35: 723.
Dudley, N., B. Gujja, B. Jackson, J.-P. Jeanrenaud, G. Oviedo, A. Philips, P. Rosabel, S.
Stolton, and S. Wells. 1999. Challenges for protected areas in the 21st century. In S. Solton
310
and N. Dudley (eds.) Partnerships for Protection: New Strategies for Planning and Management of Protected Areas, pp. 312. London: IUCN and Earthscan.
Dugan, P. J. 1988. The importance of rural communities in wetlands conservation and
development. In D. D. Cook et al. (eds.) The Ecology and management of Wetlands Volume
2; Management Use and value of Wetlands, pp. 311. Portland, OR: Timber Press.
Dugan, P. J. 1990. Wetland Conservation: A Review of Current Issues and required Action.
Gland, Switzerland: IUCN The World Conservation Union.
Dyer, M., and B.V. Vinogrado. 1990. The role of Biosphere reserves in landscape and
ecosystem studies. Natural Resources, 36(1) 1926.
Emerton, L. (ed.). 2005. Values and Rewards: Counting and Capturing Ecosystem Water
Services for Sustainable Development. Colombo, Sri Lanka: IUCN Water, Nature and
Economics Technical Paper no. 1, IUCN The World Conservation Union, Ecosystems
and Livelihood Group Asia, 93 pp.
Environment Canada 2006. Great Lakes Wetlands Conservation Action Plan Highlights
Report 20032005. Toronto, Ontario: Environment Canada, 24 pp and at http://www/
on.ec.gc.ca/wildlife/publications-e.html
Erickson, J. 2006. A participation approach to conservation in the Calakmul Biosphere
Reserve Campeche, Mexico. Landscape Urban Planning, 74(2006): 242266.
Faust, B. B. and R. C. Smardon. 2001. Introduction and overview: environmental knowledge,
rights and ethics: Co-managing with communities. Environmental Science Policy, 4(4/5):
147151.
Frazier, J. 2006. Biosphere reserves and the Yucatan syndrome: Another look at the role of
NGOs. Landscape Urban Planning, 24(2006): 313333.
Gotz, W. N., L. Forthman, D. Cumming, J. di Felt, J. Hilty, R. Martin, M. Murphee, N.
Owen Smith, A. M. Starfield, and M. I. Westphal. 1999. Sustaining natural and human
capitol; villagers and scientists. Science, 283: 18551856.
Government of St. Lucia. 2001a. Plan for Managing the Fisheries of St. Lucia. Vieux-Fort:
Government of St. Lucia.
Government of St. Lucia. 2001b. Chapter 3. Current Coastal Area Management Issues. In
Integrating the Management of Watersheds and Coastal Areas in St. Lucia, pp. 5081.
Vieux-Fort: Government of St. Lucia.
Government of St. Lucia. 2004a. Coastal Zone Management in St. Lucia: Policy Guidelines
and Selected Projects. Vieux-Fort: Government of St. Lucia.
Government of St. Lucia. 2004b. Draft Final Report. To Review the Implementation of the
Barbados Programme of Action (BPOA). Vieux-Fort, St. Lucia: Ministry of Physical Development, Environment and Housing, Government of St. Lucia, Executive Summary, pp. 112.
de Groot, R. S. 1992. Functions of Nature: Evolution of Nature in Environmental Planning,
Management and Decision-Making. Groningen, The Netherlands: Wolters Noordhoff.
Hails, A. J. (ed.). 1997. Wetlands, Biodiversity and the Ramsar Convention: The Role of the
Convention on Wetlands in the Conservation and Wise Use of Biodiversity. Gland, Switzerland: Ramsar Convention Bureau, 71 pp.
Inamdar, A., H. de Jode, K. Lindsey, and S. Cobb. 1999. Capitalizing on nature: Protected
area management. Science, 233: 18561857.
IUCN. 1985. Wetlands Conservation Programme. Gland, Switzerland: IUCN.
IUCN. 1980. The Ramsar Convention: A Legal Review, Conference on the Convention of
Wetlands for International Importance Especially as Waterfowl Habitat. Conf./5, Cagliari,
Italy, Nov. 2429, 1980. Gland, Switzerland: IUCN.
IUCN/IWRB. 1980. The Ramsar Convention: A Technical Review: Conference on the Convention of Wetlands of International Importance Especially as Waterfowl Habitat. Conf. 4,
Cagliari, Italy, Nov. 2429, 1980. Gland, Switzerland: IUCN.
IUCN/IWRB. 1984. Overview of National Reports Submitted by Contracting Parties and
Review of Developments Since the First Conference of the Parties. IUCN/IWRB Doc. C2.
6, Groningen, Netherlands, May 712, 1984.
References
311
312
Index
A
Action Plan for Conservation and Management
of Greek Wetlands, 64
Adamus, P. R., 9
Africa, 4, 5, 15, 93118, 292, 301
Alliance for the Great Lakes, 203
Aquaculture urban wetlands, 125
disease vectors, 126, 155
heavy metals, 110, 126
migratory waterfowl, 126, 161, 215
Wong, T. H. R., 125
Asian urban wetlands, 125
Aupcion Charcoal and Agricultural Producers
Group (ACADG), 283
Australia, 4, 5, 86, 125, 156, 171, 174, 175
Axios Delta case study sources
Athanasiou, H., 65, 70, 78, 80, 81, 82,
83, 84
Gerakis, P. A. et al., 59, 60, 64, 65, 70, 83
Jerrentrup, H. et al., 70, 79, 80, 81
Kazantzidis, S., 70, 73, 80, 83
Konstandinidis, K. A., 65, 79, 81
Nazirides, T. et al., 70
Newly, S., 65, 70, 73
Psilovikos, A., 59, 65, 70
Tsiouris, S. E. and P. A. Gerakis, 8, 70
Valaoras, G., 70
Zalidis, G., 58, 65
Axios Delta current management issues
delta functions, 81
marshes, 82
rice fields, 83
riparian forest, 71, 80, 81, 82, 87
scrubland, 82
Walling, D. E. and B. W. Webb, 77
Axios Delta heronry, 80, 83
Axios Delta human activities
fishing, 74
livestock grazed, 74
principal crops, 74
sand extraction, 74, 80
Axios Delta threats, 74
farmland expansion, 75, 76
grazing, 76, 82
illegal hunting, 58
illegal salt marsh reclamation, 77
sand extraction, 76
unauthorized construction, 76
urban waste and industrial effluents, 75
Axios delta wetland fauna, 72
fish, 72
herons, 72, 73
herpetological significance, 72
mammals, 73, 75
shorebirds, 72
waterfowl, 72
Axios Delta wetland function loss
fish habitat, 9, 77, 79
flood storage and desynchronization, 9, 78
food chain support, 9, 77, 79, 81
groundwater recharge and discharge, 9,
77, 78
sediment trapping, 9, 77, 81
shoreline erosion reduction, 9, 77, 78
wildlife habitat, 9, 77, 79
Axios Delta wetland vegetation
halophytic-salt marsh community, 70
hydrophytic aquatics, 71
reed beds, 71
riparian forest, 71, 81
rush meadow, 70
tamarisk scrubland community, 70, 76, 82
Axios River Delta complex, 57
Aliakmon River, 57, 65, 67, 68, 76, 77, 78,
79, 89
Axios River, 65, 66, 67, 68, 69, 71, 88
Galikos River, 77, 86
Loudias River, 66, 67
313
314
Axios River Delta, Greece, 8, 15, 16, 5789,
302, 304, 306
Axios River Delta impact studies
Albaige, J., 75
Furness, R. W., 75
Ghatzinkolaou, Y. et al., 76
Goutner, V., 75
Goutner, V. et al., 72
Janssens, E. et al., 75
Karageorgis, A. P. et al., 76
Van Gils, J. A. G. and Argiropoulos, P., 76
B
Backes, C., 3637
Balkan peninsula, 65
Bangladesh, 5, 132
Benefits and values of wetlands, 9, 64, 141
Bern Convention, 43, 87
Biosphere reserve history
Action Plan for Biosphere Reserves, 304
economic management policy, 305
Enrique Beltran, 305
international sustainable use classification,
305, 306
management conflicts, 306
new involvement methods, 305
United Nations Environment Program
(UNEP), 278, 289, 293, 304
use it or lose it, 306
valuation of wetland services, 305
wise use vs. habitat, 306, 307
World Congress on National Parks and
Protected Areas, 304305
Bonn Convention, 42, 45, 54
Brace Bridge Nature Park (BBNP), 131, 135,
138, 148
Sewage fed aquaculture, 129, 138
C
Canada-Ontario Agreement (COA), 197, 198
Respecting the Great Lakes Ecosystem,
198
Canadas wetland policy of 1991, 198
Cancun, 212, 216, 235, 240, 250
Caribbean Association, 292
Caribbean flamingos, 211, 215
Caribbean mangrove ecology sources, 274278
Cardona, P. and L. Botero, 269, 293
Chapman, V. J., 269
Cintron, M. G. and Y. N. Schaeffer, 269
Jimenez, J. A., 269, 270, 272
Lugo, A. E., 274
Thom, B. G., 269
Caribbean Mangroves, 269271
Index
environmental settings, 269
human consumptive functions, 270
total mangrove area, 269
Caribbean mangrove stress, 271272
artesian exploration, 272
climate change, 272, 293
exotic plants, 272
infrastructure development, 252
intensive aquaculture, 271
lack of management, 271, 272
land use conversion, 278
oil development, 272
sustainable uses, 272, 273
uncontrolled access, 272
Caribbean Natural Resources Institute
(CANARI), 273, 279, 281, 282, 284,
285, 286, 290, 291, 292, 303, 307
Caribbean Wetland Resource, 269271
forested wetlands, 269
freshwater marshes, 269
mangrove, 269, 270, 271
market and non-market values, 269
seagrass beds, 269, 270
Caspian Sea, Iran, 5
CECs Directorate General XI, 14
Central/South America, 5, 13
Chemical industries, 30, 139
Clearing and drainage, 4
Climate change, 2, 4, 5, 15, 155, 200, 252, 272,
293
Common Wadden Sea Secretariat, 22, 23, 25,
26, 27, 37, 44, 49
joint declaration of, 40, 44, 45, 1982
Community based organizations (CBOs), 13,
131, 278, 304, 308
Conferences of the Contacting parties (under
Ramsar Convention), 41
The Conservation Foundation, 11
Conservation and Management of Greek
Wetlands, 64
University of Thessaloniki, 64
Conservation of seals (Wadden Sea), 42
Cultural services, 2, 15
D
Danish
1992 Planning Act, 40
Act on Nature Protection, 1992, 39
town and country planning, 39, 139
Danish Ministry of the Environment
Nature Conservation Act of 1917, 34, 36
Danish Wadden, 33
Esbjerg, 34
Index
Fano, 34
Romo, 34
Skallingen, 33
Varde A, 33, 44
Das Schwimmende Moor (floating Moor), 31
Downstream Mekong River Wetlands, 175
Ecosystem Assessment (2005), 175
legal/institutional issues, 177
rice production, 173, 175
shrimp aquaculture, 154, 175
water control structures, 163, 175
Dutch Society for the Preservation of the
Wadden Sea, 12, 29, 35
Dutch Wadden, 28
EmsDollart, 30, 44
Lauwersmeer, 29
E
Eastern Saurus Crane rediscovery, 153, 160,
162, 304
Charles Luthin of Brehm Fund, 164
George Archibald of ICF, 160, 164
Le Dien Duc, 164
Professor Vo Quy of University of
Hanoi, 164
East IndiaBangladesh region, 125
East Kolkata lagoon system, India, 16
East Kolkata Wetlands ecological history, 131
East Kolkata Wetlands economic and social
values, 141
aesthetic value, 141, 145
fish production, 141, 146, 149, 175
treating sewage, 141
East Kolkata Wetlands evaluations
Chattopadhyay, S. for World Bank, 145
Indian Institute for management, 145
National Wasteland Development
Board, 145
NEERI (National Environmental
Engineering Research Institute), 136,
141, 142, 145
Zoological Survey of India, 145
East Kolkata Wetlands existing laws, 139
Town and Country Planning
Act, 139
traditional rights of fishing, 139
West Bengal Fisheries Acquisitions Act,
139
West Bengal Inland Fisheries Act, 139
East Kolkata Wetlands historical use, 127, 132
Calcutta Metropolitan Planning
Organization (CMPO), 132
Damodar River, 132
315
East India Company, 132
original swamp, 131, 132
East Kolkata Wetlands organizational
development, 144
equality, 145
recognition and awards, 145
training, 145, 170
East Kolkata Wetlands organizations, 131
Calcutta Port Trust (CPT), 131, 138,
139, 147
Mudialy Fishermans Cooperative Society
(MFCS), 131, 132, 141, 146, 149
West Bengal, Department of Fisheries,
132, 137
East Kolkata Wetlands plant community
changes, 133, 134
Ghosh, A. K. and S. Chattopadhyay, 133,
134, 145
East Kolkata Wetlands present plant
communities, 134
amphibious community, 135
macrophytic plants, 135
phytoplankton, 133, 134
remnant swamp, 135
upland and raised dikes, 135
East Kolkata Wetlands present use activities,
136
fishery, 136, 137, 141
nature park, 129, 131, 132, 135
plantations, 133, 136, 158
East Kolkata Wetlands protection controversy
Alipore Court, Kolkata, 147
health movement groups, 147
High Court of Kolkata, 147, 148
Kolkata International Development
Project, 147
People United for Better Living in Calcutta
(PUBLIC), 146, 148, 149
Slim Group of Indonesia, 147
World Wildlife Fund of India, 149
East Kolkata Wetlands Threats, 137, 138, 140
reclaiming land, 138
solid waste disposal, 140
East Kolkata Wetlands, wetland management
issues, 142
aquatic species, 142, 144, 221, 246
vegetation and landscape, 143
water levels, 142, 143, 189
water quality, 141, 142
Ecological integrity, 10
Embankment plans for
Bucht, 28, 32
Dollart, 28, 30
316
Embankment plans for (cont.)
Friesland, 28, 29
Groningen, 28, 29
North Holland, 28
Tumlauer, 28
Ems estuary, 30, 31
Emulating flood flows, 93
Esbjerg Ministerial Declaration, 50
Europe, 1, 4, 8, 12, 14, 21, 73, 83, 250, 267,
301
European Commission (EC), 43, 85
bird directive, 40, 41, 43, 44, 45, 46
habitat directive, 40, 41, 43, 44, 52, 84
F
Fish Farmers Development Agency
(FFDA), 135
Floodplains, 2, 69, 71, 72, 96118
Indus River, 2
Nile River, 2
TigrusEuprates, 2
Frisian Wadden, 28, 31
G
Game Management Areas (GMAs), 103,
112, 115
German federal states (lande)
Bremen, 38
Hamburg, 32, 38
Lower Saxony, 32, 38
SchleswigHolstein, 32, 38
German Wadden, 29, 30, 32
Elbe, 31, 44
Lower Saxon, 31, 32, 38
SchleswigHolstein, 32, 35, 38
German Wadden stresses
large industrial centers, 32
large-scale embankments, 32
oil exploration, 32
Germany
National Park Act, 35
Giannitsa Lake, 67, 68, 79
Government of St. Lucia
fisheries management, 273
integrated coastal zone planning, 273, 293
sustainability planning, 273, 293
Grado Declaration, 57, 61
Great Lakes, 12, 179204, 301
Great Lakes Aquatic Network and Fund, 203
Great Lakes Coastal Wetlands, 15, 184, 199,
203, 303
emergent vegetation, 97, 182, 183, 184
fish and wildlife, 53, 184
invertebrates, 184
Index
phytoplankton/zooplankton, 144, 184
submergent vegetation, 184
waterfowl, 82, 184, 185
Great Lakes Current Wetland Threats
drainage, 189
fills, 189
global warming, 190
invasion of exotic species, 190
maintenance dredging, 190
non-point water pollution, 190
water level stabilization, 189
Great Lakes drainage basin, 179, 180, 181, 192
Great Lakes fish and wildlife studies
Botts, D., 184
Brazner, J. C. et al., 184
Chubb, S. L. and C. R. Liston, 184
Herdendorf, C. E. and S. M. Hartley, 182,
184, 186
Holmes, J. A., and T. H. Whillans, 184
Hook, T. O. et al., 184
Leach, J. H., 184, 190
Leslie, J. K. and C. A. Timmins, 184
Prince, H. H. et al., 184, 186
Stephenson, T. D., 184
Great Lakes Historical Wetland Threats, 187
dikes, 189
drainage, 188
dredging, 188
fills, 187
water level stabilization, 189
water pollution, 189
Great Lakes invertebrate studies
Burton, T. M. et al., 181, 184
Mackenzie, R. A. and J. L. Kaster, 184
McLaughlin, D. B. and H. J. Harris, 188
Great Lakes Legacy Act of 2005, 202
Great Lakes phytoplankton/zooplankton
studies
Booth, R. K., 184
Cardinale, B. J. et al., 184
Hwang, S. and R. Heath, 184
Klarer, D. M. and D. F. Mille, 184
Great Lakes Wetlands Conservation Action
Plan (GLWCAP), 197, 198, 199, 202,
204, 307
Ducks Unlimited Canada, 198
Environment Canada, 180, 182, 184, 198,
202, 307
The Federation of Ontario Naturalists, 197
Great Lakes Stewardship Fund, 199
implementation committee, 197
Nature Conservancy of Canada, 199
Index
NAWMP, Eastern Habitat Joint Venture,
199
Ontario Ministry of Natural Resources,
197, 198, 203
progress reports, 199
25-year strategic plan, 198
Great Lakes Wetlands Policy Consortium, 12,
179203, 307
Illinois, 179
Indiana, 179, 180, 196
Michigan, 179, 191
New York, 179, 182, 183, 188, 191
Ohio, 179, 180, 186
Ontario, 180, 184, 189, 191, 192, 196, 198
Wisconsin, 164, 179, 191
Great Lakes Wetlands Policy Consortium
creation, 12, 16, 179203, 307
Gail Gruenwald, 194, 196
Mott Foundation, 194, 196, 198
resource disadvantage, 194, 198
Stephen Brown, 194, 195, 198
think tank for policy, 194
Great Lakes Wetlands Policy Consortium
development, 194
incentives, 195, 196
international policy linkage, 195
meetings, 194, 195
public outreach, 195
regulatory issues, 195
Great Lakes Wetlands Policy Consortium
final report, 195
action agenda, 195, 197
recommendations, 195, 196
vision statement, 195, 303
wetland policy issues, 195
Great Lakes Wetlands Policy Consortium
impact, 196
Cam Davis, Lake Michigan Federation and
NWF, 196
Environment Canada, Canadian Wildlife
Service (CWS), 196
Nancy Patterson, Ontario Federation of
Naturalist and CWS, 196, 197, 198
National Wildlife Federation (NWF), 166,
196
Ontario, 184, 186, 196, 197
Wisconsin Wetlands program, 196
Great Lakes Wetlands Protection policies, 190
acquisition/securement, 192
Loftus, K. K., R. C. Smardon and B. A.
Potter, 191, 192, 193, 2015, 203
regulation, 106, 191
restoration, 192
317
tax incentives, 191
Great Lakes Wetlands research
assess wetland ecosystem health, 203
Great Lakes Coastal Wetlands Consortium,
203
Great lakes Wetlands resource, 181
forested wetlands, 181, 269
high water level fluctuation, 181
marshes, 181, 182, 269
shrub/scrub, 181, 184
wind and ice action, 181
Great Lakes Wetlands sources
Dodge, D. and R. Kavetsky, 183
Hecnar, S. J., 182
Maynard, L. and D. Wilcox, 183
Tilton, D. L. and Schwegler, B. R., 181,
182, 184, 186
Whillans, T. H., 184
Great Lakes wetland vegetation studies
Jean, M. and A. Bouchard, 184, 203
Keough, J. R. et al., 184
Klarer, D. M. and D. F. Mille, 184
Sager, P. E. et al., 184
Whyte, R. S. et al., 184
Greek Biotype Wetland Center, 85, 88
wetlands monitoring project, 88
Greek NGOs
ecological movement, 63
Greek Company for Environmental
Information and Education, 64
Greek (Hellenic) Ornithological Company,
63
Greek Society (for the Protection of the
Environment and Cultural Heritage), 63
Greek Society for the Protection of Nature,
63
other Pan-Hellenic associations, 63
Greek Ramsar listed wetlands, 58
Greek wetland conservation context, 57
Gulf of Mexico, 211, 220, 221, 224, 233, 248
H
Harvested wetland products, 126
fish culturing, 128, 132, 144
medicinal plants, 127
Mukherjee, R., 135, 145
supplemental vegetables, 127
Hula Valley, Israel, 5
Hydroelectric development, 16, 104, 107
I
India, 5, 93, 125149, 292
Inter-American Development Bank (IDB), 13,
268
318
International Crane Foundation, 16, 155, 163,
165, 174, 306, 307
International Union for the Conservation of
Nature (IUCN), 14, 43, 64, 86, 88, 93,
213, 268
International Water Resources Board (IWRB),
61, 80
International Wetland management principles
cross-training, 308
holistic wetland inventory/assessment, 308
human use values, 308
livelihood analysis, 308
Millennium Ecosystem Assessment
Project, 307
multiparty participatory process, 308
multiple use wetland management, 308
natural capitol, 308
participatory management, 307, 308
RAMSAR documents, 307
recognition, 308
ISYSA Yucatan Industrial Salt Society, 234
Itezhitezhi, 94, 103, 105, 106, 107, 110
J
Jamaica, 13
Jamaicas Black River Upper Morass, 13
Jones, T., 13
Joint Declaration on the Protection of the
Wadden Sea, 40, 44
Joint Ministerial Decision (JMD), 83
Greek Ministry of Agriculture, 83, 86
Greek Ministry of the Environment, 83
Greek Ministry of Industry, 83
K
Kadadu National Park, Australia, 171
Asian Wetlands Bureau, 171, 174
Australian Nature Conservation Agency,
171
Environmental Research Institute of the
Supervising Scientist (ERISS), 171
invasive Mimosa, 171
Jeremy Russell-Smith, 171
MacArthur Foundation, 171, 174
Max Finlayson, 171
Roger Jaensch, 173
Kafue Flats CBOs and NGOs
Southern African Development
Coordination Conference, 111
University of Zambia, 111, 304
WWF/IUCN Wetlands Program, 111
Kafue Flats ecology studies
Chabwela, K. N., 96, 100, 115
Chapman, D. W. et al., 96, 101, 111
Index
Ellenbroek, G. A., 96, 98, 99, 100, 111
Howard, G. W. and G. J. Williams, 96, 104,
111
Perera, N. P., 96, 98
Rees, W. A., 96, 104, 108, 111
Sayer, J. A. and L. P. van Lavieren, 98, 111
Sheppe, W. A. and T. O. Osborne, 96, 98,
100, 102, 108, 111
Kafue Flats fishing villages
twa tribe, 96, 116
Kafue flats floodplain ecology
birdlife, 96
carnivores, 96, 98
flood effects, 105
herbivores, 96, 97, 108
Kafue lechwe, 97, 103, 115
vegetation zones, 99
Kafue flats herdsmen
Ila tribe, 95
Tonga Tribe, 95, 117
Kafue flats human use
cattle, 95, 96
commercial fishing, 96, 101, 184
subsistence agriculture, 101
Kafue Flats human use studies
FAO, 100, 103, 104, 111
Jeffrey, R. C. V. and P. M. Chooye, 100
Jeffrey, R. C. V., 100
Lehmann, D. A., 100
Seyam, I. M. et al., 100
Kafue Flats integrated water management, 117,
118
computer models, 117
dam operation, 116, 117
legal/institutional framework, 117
mimic natural water flows, 117
monitoring, 117
private tourism companies, 117
sugar industry, 117, 118
Tonga Chiefdom, 117
Water Resources Action Program (WRAP),
118
ZAMA, 117
Zambian Ministry of Energy and Water,
117, 118
ZESCO, 117
Kafue Flats University and NGO research
Bell, R. H. V. et al., 98, 111
Chapman, D. W. et al., 96, 101, 111
Douthwaite, R. J. and L. P. Lavieren, 103,
111
Dudley, R. G. and R. J. Sculley, 101, 108,
111
Index
Handlos, D. M., 98, 111
Howard, G. W. and R. C. V. Jeffrey, 111
Muyanga, E. D. and P. M. Chipungu, 101,
111
Robinette, W. L. and G. E. T. Child, 98,
111
Kafue flats wetlands, 110
Kafue flats wildlife sanctuaries
Blue Lagoon National park, 96, 103, 116
Lochinvar National Park, 96, 103, 108, 117
Kafue Flats, Zambia, 16, 93118, 302, 304,
307
Kafue Gorge, 94, 105, 106
Kafue hydroelectric development sources
Schuster, R. H., 104, 108, 111
Scudder, T., 93, 104
Sheppe, W. A., 104, 111
Tiffen, M. and M. S. Mulele, 104, 116
Kafue National Park (KNP), 94, 103, 106, 109
natural heritage, 103
tourism, 103
wildlife preserves, 103, 227, 229
Kafue River, 93, 95, 96, 99, 101, 103, 104, 110
Kafue River hydroelectric development, 104
Itezhitezhi dam, 103, 105, 106, 109, 117
Kafue Gorge dam, 104, 106
Kafue Gorge Lower Power Station, 105
Kafue Gorge reservoir, 105, 107
SWECO (Swedish Water Engineering
Company), 104, 105, 106, 107
Kafue River other stresses, 110
copper mining effluent, 110
Kasonde, J., 110
metal accumulation, 110
Mwase, M. et al., 110
Norrgren, L. et al., 110
Kafue River water regulation, 105, 106
annual flooding regime, 106
duration of maximum discharge, 107
seasonal discharge variation, 106
Kafue Tripartite agreement with WWF plus,
117
Star of Africa, 117
Zambian Electricity Supply Company
(ZESCO), 117
Zambian Ministry of Energy and Water,
117, 118
Zambian Wildlife Authority (ZAMA), 116,
117, 302
Kampuchea, 153, 156
Kariba dam, 93
Kolkata Municipal Corporation, 129
dry flow channel, 129
319
Kulti Gong River, 129
storm flow channel, 129
L
Lakewide management Plans (LaMPs), 203
Large-scale wetland systems, 306
Latin American/Caribbean Region Actors,
267268
bilateral aid agencies, 268
Canada International Development Agency
(CIDA), 268
Conservation International, 268
International Financial Institutions, 268
NGO conservation organizations, 268
Organization of American States, 268
Organization for Economic Cooperation
and Development (OECD), 268
US Agency for International Development
(USAID), 268
Leiden Conference, 10
Lesser-developed countries (LDCs), 5, 14
Lower-Saxony Germany estuaries, 31
Dollart, 31, 42
East Frisian Wadden, 31
Jadebusen, 31
Leybucht, 31, 32, 43
Weser, 31, 44
M
Mangrove restoration projects
Barbados, 273, 278
St. Lucia, 273, 275, 278, 280
Trinidad and Tobago, 273
The Mankote mangrove, 267293
Caribbean, 267
Castro, G., 267
Directory of Neotropical Wetlands, 267
Freshwater Ecosystem Conservation, 268
Latin America, 267, 268
Latin American Caribbean Region (LAC),
267, 268
Santa Cruz Bolivia, 267
Wetland Conservation in Central America,
267
The Wetlands of South America, 267
Mankote mangrove case study sources
Geoghegan, T. and A. N. Smith, 288
Homer, F. et al., 273, 278
Hudson, B., 278, 292
Renard, Y., 278, 279, 291
Romulus, G., 278, 283
Samuel, N. and A. Smith, 278
Smith, A. and F. Berkes, 278, 286, 289,
290, 292
320
Mankote mangrove charcoal production
cooking fuel, 281
cooperative, 281
cottage industry, 280
early problems, 278
regeneration by coppicing, 280
Mankote mangrove current management,
285288
bird hunting, 286
guided tours, 285
internal evaluation, 285
motel/golf course development, 284
waste dumping, 286
Mankote mangrove ecology
beach vegetation, 274, 276
bird species, 275
fisheries, 275
mangrove ecology, 274
mangrove functions, 276
salt flat vegetation, 274
Mankote mangrove evaluations
Charles Carnegie, University of West
Indies, 283
Giles Romulus, 283
Ministry of Agriculture, 283, 291
Ministry of Community Development, 283
National Research and Development
Foundation, 283
Stephen Koester of Inter-American
Foundation, 284
Mankote mangrove formal partnership
Allen Smith of CANARI, 278
Bellevue Farmers Cooperative, 284, 285
ENCAMP, 283, 291
inter-American funding, 284
Koudmen (shared labor), 284
Matius Burt of CANARI, 278, 284
National Research and Development
Foundation, 283
Pierrot Youth Organization (PYO), 284
Sunshine Harvest Cooperative, 284
tree nursery, 284
Mankote mangrove geography
Antillean archipelago, 273
Windward islands, 273
Mankote mangrove history
conservation priority site, 279, 282
Eastern Caribbean Natural Area
Management Program (ENCAMP), 282
mosquito eradication, 279
US military, 278
youth agriculture project, 279
Yves Renard of CANARI, 278, 279
Index
Mankote mangrove legal/institutional
Barbados Programme of Action, 289
Biodiversity Convention, 289
Cartagena Convention, 289
Crown Lands Ordinance (1946), 289
Forest, Soil and Water Conservation
ordinance (1946), 288
Land Conservation and Improvement Act
(1992), 289
Trade of Endangered Species Convention,
289
Wildlife Protection Act (1980), 288
World Heritage Convention, 289
Mankote mangrove management/social
structure
co-management principles, 290
legitimacy, 291
lesson externalization, 292
Marine Reserve status, 288, 291
open access, 290
resource use right, 290, 293
security of tenure, 290
self-policing action, 291
Mankote mangrove, St. Lucia, 15, 267293,
301, 304, 307
Mankote mangrove scientific assessment
aerial photography, 289
biomass accounting, 289
communication, 290
Smith, A. H. and K. Berkes, 278
Mankote mangrove stakeholders
ACADG cutting rights, 283, 284, 285
National Development Corporation (NDC),
283, 288, 291
St. Lucia Department of Fisheries, 286
St. Lucia Ministry of Agriculture, 283
St. Lucia National Trust (SLNT), 288
Mankote mangrove Wetland management
alternative fuel wood plantation, 282
co-management, 284
community participation, 282
descriptive survey, 282
monitoring program, 282
Mato Grosso State Brazil, 13
Mediterranean region, 61
Mediterranean Sea, 15, 75, 79
MedWet (Mediterranean Wetland Forum), 57,
62, 87, 302
Mekong Delta history, 156
acid sulfate soils, 156, 158, 159, 166
Melaleuca forest, 156, 158, 162
Second Indochina War, 156
Index
Mekong Delta history sources
Doug, V. N. et al., 156
Duc, L. D. et al., 156, 164
Thanh, N. C., 156, 172, 173
Trong, N. X., 156
Mekong River, 153, 166, 167, 169, 172, 175
Mekong River Basin, 153, 172
globally near threatened species, 153
globally threatened species, 153
Mekong Wetlands, 153
Eastern Saurus Crane, 153, 160
migratory birds, 153
threats, 153, 154
Mekong wetlands fauna, 161
fish, 161
vertebrates, 161
Mekong wetlands flora, 157
mixed swamp forest, 157
natural wetland vegetation, 70, 158, 159
rice fields, 83, 158, 159, 162
Merida, 212, 219, 239, 244, 250, 251
Mexican Coastal Zone management (CZM),
213
coastal estuarine impacts, 215
coastal storms, 213
conflicting uses, 215
General Law on National Welfare and
Public Trust, 213
Independence Act of 1821, 213
Lazaro Cardenas, 213
Madrid Administration, 214
Mexican Institute for Renewable
Resources, 213
National sectoral planning, 214
rapid development, 214
Second Law of Forestry, 213
Mexican institution sources
Faust, B. B., 235, 236, 256, 258, 304
Fraga, J. et al., 215, 257
Mazzotti, F. J. et al., 257
Mumme, S. et al., 242, 256
Smardon, R. C. and B. B. Faust, 10, 243,
256, 258, 304
Mexican preserve development impacts, 253
bridges, 253
development on barrier islands, 254
exotic species, 255
Jauregui, E. et al., 254
solid waste and sewage, 254
water use, 255
Mexican preserve management, 239
article #4 Presidential decree, 239
federal ecological reserves, 240
321
National Wildlife Refuges, 239
Ramsar site declaration, 240
UNESCO biosphere reserves, 10, 240, 241
Mexican preserves historical use, 231
Mexican preserves institutional issues
inter-agency cooperation, 256
public participation, 258
resources and decision-making, 256
site data and planning, 257
Mexican preserves threats and management
issues
agricultural activities, 253
disturbance of wildlife, 251
estuarine ecological changes, 246
fish productivity, 245
GECE ecological group of Celestun, 250
Gold-Bouchot, G. et al., 247
infrastructure development, 252
Maria de Carmen, 251
resources demands, 252
salt industry operations, 248
tourism impacts, 250
vehicular use, 252
Mexican reserve management actors
CONABIO National Commission for
Knowledge and Use of Biodiversity,
241
DUMAC Ducks Unlimited of Mexico,
241, 244, 250, 252
Foxs administration, 241
Julia Corrabias, 243
PRONATURA Program for Nature, 215,
241, 244, 248, 250, 251, 252, 253
SEDESOL Secretariat for Social
Development, 240, 242
SEMARNAP Secretary of Environmental, Natural Resources and Fisheries,
214, 243, 247, 248, 249, 251, 256, 257,
259
SEMARNAT Secretariat for Natural
Resources, 241, 243
Mexican Reserve Management Institutions
Amigos de Sian Kaan, 211, 244
CICY El Centro de Investigacion
Cientfica de Yucatan, 244
CINVESTAV Merida Campus (Centro de
Investigacions y Estudios Avanzados),
215, 244, 247, 248, 250
CONAP National Commission for
Protected Natural Areas, 243
ECOSUR The College of the Southern
Border, 244
GEF Global Environmental Facility, 244
322
Mexican reserve management actors (cont.)
INE National Institute of Ecology, 242
Institute of Ecologa in Xalapa, Veracruz,
242, 244
LEEGEPA General Law for
Environmental Protection, 242,
243
Ministry of Health and Public Assistance,
242
president Zedillo administration, 243
priority regions, 243
PROFERA Federal Prosecutor for
Protection of the Environment, 242
protected area categories, 243, 244
SARAH Ministry of Agriculture and
Natural Resources, 242
SECTUR Ministry of Tourism, 214, 245
SEDUE Ministry for Urban Development
and Ecology, 242, 249
SEPES Ministry of Fisheries, 214,
242, 245
SINAP National System of Protected
Areas, 243
training needs, 244
UADY Autonomous University of
Yucatan, 244
Mexico, 5, 10, 11, 12, 192, 193, 202, 211259,
272, 301, 306, 307
Migratory birds, 29, 53, 73, 153, 220, 227
Military activities, 29, 32, 37, 51
Millennium Ecosystem Assessment, 2, 15,
307, 308
Millennium Wetland Assessment, 4
Modified hydrologic impact studies
Douthwaite, R. J., 96, 100, 103, 109, 111
Osborne, T. O., 96, 98, 100, 102, 108, 111
Osmun, 110
Modified hydrologic regime impacts, 107
altered flooding regime, 108
consumptive/non-consumptive uses, 109
fauna, 108
vegetation, 107
Mwanachingwala Conservation Area, 116, 117
wetland restoration, 117, 166
N
National Wetlands Policy Consortium,
117, 60
Natural gas, 30
Natural properties of an ecosystem, 9
Nature Complaint Board, 40
Nature reserve boundaries, 37
Neotropical edge, 211
Index
Netherlands
physical planning act, 36, 39
physical planning key decision (PKD), 36
Special Wadden Act, 35
New Axios Delta management issues
environmental education programs, 88
planting trees, 87
restoration projects, 87
New Zealand, 4
No net loss wetland policy, 11
Non-governmental organizations (NGOs), 14,
62, 146, 195, 203
Noord-Friesland Buitendijks, 29
North America, 1, 4, 11, 15, 180, 268, 306
North American Waterfowl Management Plan
(NAWMP), 12, 192, 199
North American Waterfowl Treaty (NAWT),
12, 202, 215, 256, 306
North Atlantic Flyway, 12, 307
North Sea, 21, 24, 30, 41, 42, 44
O
Ontario Wetlands Policy Statement of 1992,
198
P
Pantanal, South America, 14
Peoples Republic of China, 13
Periurban wetlands, 125, 148
Presidential decree for Protection, 83, 239
degrees of protection, 83
Principle of compensation, 42, 47
Progresso, 212, 253
R
Ramsar Bureau, Gland Switzerland, 8
Ramsar Convention, 5, 6, 7, 8, 10, 38, 41, 45,
50, 51, 58, 60, 61, 89
Ramsar meetings, 9, 308
Brisbane, Australia, 10, 86
Kampala, Uganda, 10
Kushiro, Japan, 10, 86
Regina, Canada, 9
San Jose, Costa Rica, 10
Valencia, Spain, 10
Reclamation of salt marshes, 12, 21, 77
Lauwerzee, 21
Zuiderzee, 21
Red Alert Project of WWF Greece, 84
detect and monitoring of threats, 85
methodology, 88
raise public awareness, 85, 87
standard of work, 88
take action to avert threats, 85
Index
Regional Caribbean Programs, 268
Caribbean Coastal Marine Productivity
Program (CARICOMP), 268
Society for the Conservation and Study of
Caribbean Birds, 268
WBI-National Strategies for Sustainable
Development, 269
Wildlife Without Borders, 268
Republic of Zambia, 93, 116
Ra Celestun, 211, 214, 215, 220, 244
Ra Celestun current use
Ejidos, 238
fish flour industry, 239
fishing, 238
salt industry, 238
tourism, 239
Ra Celestun fauna, 230
mammals, 231
reptiles, 231
resident and migratory birds, 230
shorebirds, 230
Ra Celestun/Ra Lagartos case study, 215
climate, 215216
geomorphology, 216
Northern Yucatan hydrology, 216217
Ra Celestun description, 220
Ra Lagartos description, 219
Ra Celestun/Ra Lagartos case study sources
Andrews, J. M. et al., 215, 220, 227, 228,
233, 234, 235, 236, 238, 239, 244, 245,
246, 248, 250, 252, 253, 255, 259
Cole, L. J., 217, 222
Conroy, M., 215
Fraga, J. et al., 215
Moan, S., 215, 218, 219, 222, 236, 251,
271
ParksWatch, 215
Wilson, E. M., 215, 216, 217, 218, 219,
222, 232
Ra Celestun/Ra Lagartos fish, 232
Ra Celestun/Ra Lagartos hydrology, 221
salinity, 221, 222, 224, 227, 246, 248
water input, 221, 222, 247
water temperature, 222, 246
Ra Celestun vegetation, 219, 224
coastal dune, 220, 224
flooded scrub forest, 224, 225
macrobenthos, 226
mangrove, 223, 224, 225, 247
old scrub forest, 226
petene, 217, 220, 222, 224
Trejo, A., 225
Ra Lagartos, 218, 219, 220, 222, 234
323
Ra Lagartos current use, 232
agriculture/farming, 236
cattle ranching, 236
fishing, 232
other industries, 236
residential growth, 237
salt processing, 234
tourism, 235
Ra Lagartos fauna, 226
birds, 227
mammals, 226
migratory birds, 227
primary productivity, 227
reptiles, 227
Sprunt, A. et al., 221, 222, 223, 224, 226,
227, 233, 234, 235, 240, 254, 256
Ra Lagartos, Mexico, 15, 218, 219, 220, 221,
222, 226, 227, 234, 235, 254, 271
Ra Lagartos vegetation, 226
glycophytic forest, 224
halophytic mangrove, 223
haloxerophytic dune, 223
Riverine modified wetland systems
Cameroon, 93
Phongolo floodplain, 93
South Africa, 93
Zambezi River, 93, 94, 118
S
St. Lawrence River, 12, 182, 184
St. Lucia government capacity for
environmental science, 293
integrated coastal zone planning, 273, 293
integrated project development, 293
natural resources dependent livelihood, 293
sustainability planning, 273, 293
Salt marsh remains
Halligen, SchleswigHolstein, 27, 32
SchleswigHolstein area, 27, 28, 32
Halligen islands, 27, 32
Wanderdunen (bare dune land), 32
Warften mounds, 32
SchleswigHolstein islands, 32
Amrum, 32
National Parks, 32, 38
Pellworm, 32
special zones, 32
Sylt, 32, 33
SchleswigHolstein method, 26, 27
Seal resorts
Esbjerg, Denmark, 26, 34, 36
Norden, Germany, 26
324
Seal resorts (cont.)
Pieterburen, Netherlands, 26
Texel Island, Netherlands, 26, 27, 29
Seals, 21, 25, 29, 30, 43, 52
SEMIP Ministry of Industry and Mining,
234, 245
Small wetlands systems, 12, 301
South China Sea, 153
Southeast Asia, 5, 93, 163, 165
South Sumatra/Central Kalimantan, 13
Stakeholder roles
Batisse, M., 304, 305
big international NGOs, 304
community based organizations (CBOs),
13, 131, 278, 304, 308
government policies, 110, 111, 112, 301
local residents, 15, 61, 145, 175, 258, 259,
304, 305, 306
McNeeley, J. A., 304, 305, 308
national/regional NGOs, 15, 203, 211,
215, 304, 305, 308
quasigovernmental, 301
Smardon, R. C. and B. B. Faust, 256, 258,
304
UNESCO, 10, 304, 305
Stichting Groningen Landschap (Foundation of
the Groningen Landscape), 31
Stockwell, L. T., 9
Sub-Saharan Africa, 93
Summer plodder, 26, 44
Sustainable utilization, 9, 14, 112, 113, 149
Sweden, 12
T
Thermaikos gulf, 65, 66, 76, 79, 81, 88
Thessaloniki Plain, 66, 76, 77, 81
Thessaloniki Plain reclamation, 81
opportunity cost, 81
Tip of the Mitt Watershed Council, 193, 196
Tizimin, 212
Tourism, 29, 59, 117, 212, 213, 214, 235, 238,
239, 250, 272
Tram Chim early restoration, 161
Moui Nhe, Dong Thap province, 162, 164,
166, 167
Plain of Reeds, 161, 162, 167, 168, 169
research needs, 166
Tram Chim hydrologic implementation
install water gates, 168
mimic hydrology, 169
National Preserve (1991), 170, 172
prescribed burning, 170
vegetation management, 170
Index
Tram Chim hydrologic restoration, 169, 174
Beilfuss, R. D. and J. A. Brazen, 167, 168
overbank flooding, 167
overload sheet flow, 167
quantitative measurements, 167168
restoration model, 168
seasonal monsoon rainfall, 167
Tram Chim Management Meeting (1991),
165167
conflicting management goals, 166
Jeb Barzen of ICF, 166
negotiations, 166, 174
parallel logic, 167
probing discussion, 166
Tram Chim management plan actors
International Sarus Crane and Wetlands
Workshop, 165
local leadership, 167
Mekong River Commission, 166, 170, 172,
174
University of Can Tho, 165
University of Hanoi, 164, 165, 166, 174
University of Ho Chi Minh City, 165
Tram Chim monitoring and evaluation, 170
collaborative training, 174
Tram Chim National Park threats, 172, 187
exotic species, 174, 190, 255
local livelihood encroachment, 173
Prime Minister Decision No. 253/QD-TTg,
172
rice farm pollution, 173
water level changes, 173
Tram Trim National Park, 16, 307
Tran Trim Nature Preserve, Vietnam, 1516
Trebon Basin, Czech Republic, 10
Trilateral Government Wadden Sea
Conference, 42, 54
Trilateral Wadden Sea Plan, 45
common policy and management, 45, 47
geographic range, 46
guiding principle, 46
management principles, 46
targets, 45, 47, 48
trilateral conservation area, 46
Tri-national wetlands management, 192
Tripartite Management Plan, 16
Turner, K., 13
U
UNESCO biosphere reserves, 10, 304
US Clean Water Act (CWA), 11, 203
US Supreme Court wetland cases
Rapanos vs. US, 12
Index
SWANCC, 11, 12
US vs. Riverside Bayview Homes, 11
US wetland agencies
Bill Clinton administration, 11
George W. Bush administration, 11
Natural Resources Conservation Service
(NRCS), 202, 303
Soil Conservation Service (SCS), 11
US Army Corps of Engineers (USACOE),
11, 191
USDI Fish and Wildlife Service (FWS),
202
V
Valladolid, 212
van der Zweip, K., 3637
Vector borne diseases, 4, 155
eastern equine encephalitis, 4
malaria, 155
schistosomiasis, 4
West Nile virus, 4, 155
Vereniging tot Behoud van Natuurmonument
(Society for the Preservation of Natural
Resources), 31
Vietnam, 13, 16, 125, 153175, 301, 307
W
Wadden Islands, 21, 27, 28, 29
Wadden landscape features
dunes, 26, 27, 33
embankments, 26
islands, 26, 28, 29
salt marshes, 26
Wadden Sea boundaries, 21
Wadden Sea fisheries
anchovy, 22, 238
brown shrimp, 22
cockles, 23, 24, 25, 51
flounder, 22
mussels, 22, 23, 24, 51, 74
oysters, 22, 24, 74
Whelks, 23
Zuiderzee herring, 22
Wadden Sea, Netherlands, Germany and
Denmark, 16, 21, 42, 306307
Wadden Sea NGOs, 50, 54
Schutzstation Wattenmeer, 35
Wadden Society, 51
World Wildlife Fund (WWF) Wattenmeerstelle, 35, 50, 88
Wadden Sea physical attributes
biodiversity, 25
bird abundance, 24
fish density, 24
325
tidal variation, 24
Wolff, W. J., 25
Wadden Sea research
ecosystem models, 53
monitoring pollutants, 53
shorebird surveys, 52
vegetation plot research, 53
Wadden Sea researchers
Bakker, J. P. et al., 26, 53
Brouns, J. J., 53
Meekes, H. T., 53, 554
Van der Brink, P. J. and B. J. Kater, 53
Wadden Sea stresses
disturbance of benthic species, 25
eutrophication, 23, 76, 79, 259, 274
increased turbidity, 23, 24
Wastewater treatment wetlands
China, 125
Ho Chi Min City, Vietnam, 125, 165
Laos PDR, 125
Phnom Penh, Cambodia, 125
Water pollution, 8, 25, 30, 43, 58, 189
Water sportsmen, 29
West Bengal, 126, 128, 131, 132, 139, 140,
141, 146, 147
Western Palearctic migratory species, 43, 53
Wetland and Waterbird Working Group
(WWWG), 164, 166, 174
first crane workshop, 164165
Ngo Quoc Thang of Tan Nong, 164
US field trips, 165166
Wetland functions, 2, 11, 14, 85, 89, 117, 199,
200, 307308
Wetlands
estuaries and lagoons, 1
fens and bogs, 1, 181
floodplain wetlands, 1, 93, 171, 307
lake edge wetlands, 1, 186
mangroves, 1, 17, 271, 272273, 293
man-made wetlands, 1, 133
marshes, 1, 2, 12, 30, 53, 66, 67, 79, 82,
181
nipa/tidal freshwater swamp forest, 1
peatlands, 1
Wetlands International, 14, 15, 174, 215, 267,
268, 308
Wetlands of International Importance, 5, 8, 38,
41, 267
Wetland stress and loss, 3, 5, 271
Wetland system management innovation
cooperative processes, 306307
multiple use management plans, 307
Wise use, 9, 12, 42, 62, 117, 172, 306, 307
326
World Bank (WB), 13, 149, 215, 241, 243,
256, 268, 269, 301
World Heritage List, 42
Worldwide extent of wetlands, 3
World Wildlife Fund (WWF), 14, 35, 50, 88,
149, 267, 268, 292, 307
sponsorship, 5051, 57, 111, 149, 292
WWF Greece, 57, 84, 86, 87, 89, 304
WWF-IUCN-University of Thessaloniki
Action Plan, 16
WWF-Zambia financial arrangements, 114
central government funds, 114
statutory government revenues, 114
Wildlife Conservation Revolving Fund,
112, 114
WWF-international, 114
WWF-Zambian NGO roles, 116
WWF- Zambian project results, 115
finance, 114, 115
fisheries, 115
hydrologic alteration impacts, 79, 116
Index
Kafue Lechwe population, 115
local population movement, 115, 116
off takes of wildlife, 115
WWF-Zambia Wetlands Program
Administrative Management Design Policy,
112
Community Development Units, 113
Department of National Parks and Wildlife
Service (Zambia), 112
Local Administration Act of 1980, 112
National Conservation Strategy, 111
wetlands management authorities, 113, 114
wetlands management units, 113
Y
Yucatan peninsula, 2, 8, 211259, 271
Z
Zambia, 13, 16, 93118, 304
Zeeland flood, 28